]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/gnus.texi
*** empty log message ***
[gnu-emacs] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @copying
10 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12
13 @quotation
14 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
15 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
16 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
17 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
18 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
19 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
20 License'' in the Emacs manual.
21
22 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
23 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
24 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
25
26 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
27 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
28 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
29 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
30 @end quotation
31 @end copying
32
33 @iftex
34 @iflatex
35 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
36 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
37 \usepackage{pagestyle}
38 \usepackage{epsfig}
39 \usepackage{pixidx}
40 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
41
42 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
43 \else
44 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
45 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
46 \pdfcompresslevel=9
47 \fi
48
49 \makeindex
50 \begin{document}
51
52 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
53 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.11}
54 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
55 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
56
57 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
58
59 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
60 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
61 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
62 \else
63 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
64 \fi
65 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
70
71 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
78 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
95
96 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
98 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
99 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
100 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
101 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
104 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
109
110 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
111 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
112 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
113 }
114
115 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
116
117 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
118 {\mbox{}}
119 }
120
121 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
122 \gnusdimen 0pt
123
124 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
125 \gnuscleardoublepage
126 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
127 \chapter{#2}
128 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
129 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
130 \thispagestyle{empty}
131 \hspace*{-2cm}
132 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
133 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
134 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
135 \end{picture}
136 \clearpage
137 }
138
139 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
140 \begin{figure}
141 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
142 #3
143 \end{picture}
144 \caption{#1}
145 \end{figure}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
149 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
157 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
161 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
162 }
163
164 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
165
166 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
167 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
168 \section{#1}
169 }
170
171 \newenvironment{codelist}%
172 {\begin{list}{}{
173 }
174 }{\end{list}}
175
176 \newenvironment{asislist}%
177 {\begin{list}{}{
178 }
179 }{\end{list}}
180
181 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
182 {\begin{list}{}{
183 \labelwidth=0cm
184 }
185 }{\end{list}}
186
187 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
188 {\begin{list}{}{
189 }
190 }{\end{list}}
191
192 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
193 {\begin{list}{}{
194 }
195 }{\end{list}}
196
197 \newenvironment{samplist}%
198 {\begin{list}{}{
199 }
200 }{\end{list}}
201
202 \newenvironment{varlist}%
203 {\begin{list}{}{
204 }
205 }{\end{list}}
206
207 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
208 {\begin{list}{}{
209 }
210 }{\end{list}}
211
212 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
213 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
214 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
215
216 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
217 {
218 {
219 \ifodd\count0
220 {
221 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
222 }
223 \else
224 {
225 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
226 }
227 }
228 \fi
229 }
230 }
231 {
232 \ifodd\count0
233 \mbox{} \hfill
234 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
235 \else
236 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
237 \hfill \mbox{}
238 \fi
239 }
240
241 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
242 {
243 {
244 \ifodd\count0
245 {
246 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
247 }
248 \else
249 {
250 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
251 }
252 \fi
253 }
254 }
255 {
256 \ifodd\count0
257 \mbox{} \hfill
258 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
259 \else
260 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
261 \hfill \mbox{}
262 \fi
263 }
264
265 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
266 {
267 {
268 \ifodd\count0
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
271 }
272 \else
273 {
274 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
275 }
276 \fi
277 }
278 }
279 {
280 \ifodd\count0
281 \mbox{} \hfill
282 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
283 \else
284 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
285 \hfill \mbox{}
286 \fi
287 }
288
289 \pagenumbering{roman}
290 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
291
292 @end iflatex
293 @end iftex
294
295 @iftex
296 @iflatex
297
298 \begin{titlepage}
299 {
300
301 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
302 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
303 \parindent=0cm
304 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
305
306 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \vfill
309 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
310 \vfill
311 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
312 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
313 \newpage
314 }
315
316 \mbox{}
317 \vfill
318
319 \thispagestyle{empty}
320
321 @c @insertcopying
322 \newpage
323 \end{titlepage}
324 @end iflatex
325 @end iftex
326
327 @ifnottex
328 @insertcopying
329 @end ifnottex
330
331 @dircategory Emacs
332 @direntry
333 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
334 @end direntry
335 @iftex
336 @finalout
337 @end iftex
338 @setchapternewpage odd
339
340
341
342 @titlepage
343 @title Gnus Manual
344
345 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
346 @page
347 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
348 @insertcopying
349 @end titlepage
350
351
352 @node Top
353 @top The Gnus Newsreader
354
355 @ifinfo
356
357 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
358 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
359 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
360 luck.
361
362 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
363 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.11.
364
365 @end ifinfo
366
367 @iftex
368
369 @iflatex
370 \tableofcontents
371 \gnuscleardoublepage
372 @end iflatex
373
374 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
375 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
376
377 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
378 being accused of plagiarism:
379
380 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
381 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
382 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
383 can even read news with it!
384
385 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
386 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
387 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
388 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
389 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
390 the program.
391
392 @end iftex
393
394 @menu
395 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
396 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
397 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
398 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
399 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
400 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
401 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
402 * Various:: General purpose settings.
403 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
404 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
405 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
406 * Key Index:: Key Index.
407
408 Other related manuals
409
410 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
411 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
412 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
413 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
414
415 @detailmenu
416 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
417
418 Starting Gnus
419
420 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
421 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
422 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
423 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
424 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
425 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
426 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
427 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
428 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
429 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
430 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
431
432 New Groups
433
434 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
435 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
436 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
437
438 Group Buffer
439
440 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
441 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
442 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
443 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
444 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
445 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
446 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
447 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
448 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
449 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
450 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
451 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
452 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
453 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
454 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
455 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
456 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
457
458 Group Buffer Format
459
460 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
461 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
462 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
463
464 Group Topics
465
466 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
467 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
468 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
469 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
470 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
471
472 Misc Group Stuff
473
474 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
475 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
476 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
477 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
478 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
479
480 Summary Buffer
481
482 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
483 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
484 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
485 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
486 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
487 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
488 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
489 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
490 * Threading:: How threads are made.
491 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
492 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
493 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
494 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
495 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
496 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
497 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
498 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
499 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
500 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
501 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
502 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
503 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
504 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
505 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
506 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
507 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
508 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
509 or reselecting the current group.
510 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
511 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
512 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
513 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
514
515 Summary Buffer Format
516
517 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
518 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
519 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
520 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
521
522 Choosing Articles
523
524 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
525 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
526
527 Reply, Followup and Post
528
529 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
530 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
531 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
532 * Canceling and Superseding::
533
534 Marking Articles
535
536 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
537 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
538 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
539 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
540 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
541 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
542
543 Threading
544
545 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
546 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
547
548 Customizing Threading
549
550 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
551 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
552 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
553 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
554
555 Decoding Articles
556
557 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
558 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
559 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
560 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
561 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
562 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
563
564 Decoding Variables
565
566 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
567 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
568 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
569
570 Article Treatment
571
572 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
573 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
574 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
575 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
576 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
577 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
578 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
579 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
580 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
581 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
582 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
583
584 Alternative Approaches
585
586 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
587 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
588
589 Various Summary Stuff
590
591 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
592 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
593 * Summary Generation Commands::
594 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
595
596 Article Buffer
597
598 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
599 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
600 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
601 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
602 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
603
604 Composing Messages
605
606 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
607 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
608 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
609 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
610 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
611 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
612 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
613 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
614 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
615
616 Select Methods
617
618 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
619 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
620 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
621 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
622 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
623 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
624 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
625 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
626
627 Server Buffer
628
629 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
630 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
631 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
632 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
633 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
634 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
635 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
636
637 Getting News
638
639 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
640 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
641
642 @acronym{NNTP}
643
644 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
645 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
646 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
647
648 Getting Mail
649
650 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
651 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
652 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
653 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
654 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
655 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
656 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
657 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
658 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
659 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
660 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
661 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
662 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
663
664 Mail Sources
665
666 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
667 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
668 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
669
670 Choosing a Mail Back End
671
672 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
673 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
674 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
675 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
676 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
677 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
678 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
679
680 Browsing the Web
681
682 * Archiving Mail::
683 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
684 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
685 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
686 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
687 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
688 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
689
690 @acronym{IMAP}
691
692 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
693 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
694 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
695 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
696 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
697 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
698
699 Other Sources
700
701 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
702 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
703 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
704 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
705 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
706
707 Document Groups
708
709 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
710
711 SOUP
712
713 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
714 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
715 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
716
717 Combined Groups
718
719 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
720 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
721
722 Gnus Unplugged
723
724 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
725 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
726 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
727 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
728 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
729 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
730 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
731 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
732 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
733 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
734 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
735 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
736 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
737
738 Agent Categories
739
740 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
741 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
742 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
743
744 Agent Commands
745
746 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
747 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
748 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
749
750 Scoring
751
752 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
753 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
754 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
755 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
756 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
757 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
758 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
759 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
760 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
761 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
762 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
763 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
764 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
765 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
766 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
767 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
768 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
769
770 GroupLens
771
772 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
773 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
774 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
775 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
776
777 Advanced Scoring
778
779 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
780 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
781 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
782
783 Various
784
785 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
786 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
787 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
788 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
789 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
790 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
791 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
792 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
793 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
794 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
795 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
796 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
797 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
798 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
799 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
800 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
801 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
802 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
803 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
804 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
805 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
806
807 Formatting Variables
808
809 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
810 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
811 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
812 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
813 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
814 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
815 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
816 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
817
818 Image Enhancements
819
820 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
821 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
822 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
823 meant to be shown.
824 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
825 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
826
827 Thwarting Email Spam
828
829 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
830 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
831 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
832 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
833
834 Spam Package
835
836 * Spam Package Introduction::
837 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
838 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
839 * Spam and Ham Processors::
840 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
841 * Spam Back Ends::
842 * Extending the Spam package::
843 * Spam Statistics Package::
844
845 Spam Statistics Package
846
847 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
848 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
849 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
850
851 Appendices
852
853 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
854 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
855 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
856 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
857 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
858 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
859 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
860 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
861 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
862
863 History
864
865 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
866 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
867 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
868 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
869 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
870 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
871 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
872 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
873 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
874
875 New Features
876
877 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
878 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
879 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
880 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
881 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
882 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
883
884 Customization
885
886 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
887 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
888 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
889 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
890
891 Gnus Reference Guide
892
893 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
894 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
895 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
896 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
897 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
898 * Group Info:: The group info format.
899 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
900 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
901 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
902
903 Back End Interface
904
905 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
906 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
907 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
908 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
909 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
910 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
911
912 Various File Formats
913
914 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
915 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
916
917 Emacs for Heathens
918
919 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
920 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
921
922 @end detailmenu
923 @end menu
924
925 @node Starting Up
926 @chapter Starting Gnus
927 @cindex starting up
928
929 If you are haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs
930 for Heathens} first.
931
932 @kindex M-x gnus
933 @findex gnus
934 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
935 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
936 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
937 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
938 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
939 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
940
941 @findex gnus-other-frame
942 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
943 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
944 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
945
946 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
947 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
948 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
949
950 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
951 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
952
953 @menu
954 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
955 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
956 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
957 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
958 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
959 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
960 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
961 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
962 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
963 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
964 @end menu
965
966
967 @node Finding the News
968 @section Finding the News
969 @cindex finding news
970
971 @vindex gnus-select-method
972 @c @head
973 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
974 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
975 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
976 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
977 foreign groups.
978
979 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
980 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
981
982 @lisp
983 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
984 @end lisp
985
986 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
987
988 @lisp
989 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
990 @end lisp
991
992 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
993 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
994 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
995 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
996
997 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
998 @cindex NNTPSERVER
999 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1000 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1001 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1002 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1003 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1004 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1005 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1006
1007 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1008 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1009 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1010 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1011
1012 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1013 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1014 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1015 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1016 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1017 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1018 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1019 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1020 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1021 server.)
1022
1023 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1024 @kindex B (Group)
1025 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1026 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1027 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1028 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1029 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1030 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1031
1032 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1033 @c @head
1034 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1035 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1036 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1037 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1038 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1039 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1040 groups are.
1041
1042 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1043 you would typically set this variable to
1044
1045 @lisp
1046 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1047 @end lisp
1048
1049
1050 @node The First Time
1051 @section The First Time
1052 @cindex first time usage
1053
1054 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1055 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1056
1057 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1058 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1059 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1060 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1061 something useful.
1062
1063 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1064 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1065 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1066
1067 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1068 help you with most common problems.
1069
1070 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1071 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1072 special.
1073
1074
1075 @node The Server is Down
1076 @section The Server is Down
1077 @cindex server errors
1078
1079 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1080 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1081 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1082
1083 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1084 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1085 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1086 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1087 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1088 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1089 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1090
1091 @findex gnus-no-server
1092 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1093 @c @head
1094 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1095 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1096 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1097 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1098 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1099 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1100 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1101
1102
1103 @node Slave Gnusae
1104 @section Slave Gnusae
1105 @cindex slave
1106
1107 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1108 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1109 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1110 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1111
1112 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1113 @file{.newsrc} file.
1114
1115 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1116 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1117 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1118 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1119 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1120 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1121 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1122
1123 @findex gnus-slave
1124 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1125 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1126 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1127 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1128 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1129 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1130 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1131 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1132
1133 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1134 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1135
1136 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1137 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1138 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1139 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1140 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1141
1142
1143
1144 @node New Groups
1145 @section New Groups
1146 @cindex new groups
1147 @cindex subscription
1148
1149 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1150 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1151 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1152 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1153 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1154 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1155 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1156 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1157 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1158
1159 @menu
1160 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1161 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1162 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1163 @end menu
1164
1165
1166 @node Checking New Groups
1167 @subsection Checking New Groups
1168
1169 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1170 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1171 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1172 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1173 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1174 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1175 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1176 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1177 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1178 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1179
1180 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1181 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1182 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1183 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1184 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1185 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1186 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1187 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1188 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1189 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1190 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1191
1192 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1193 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1194 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1195 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1196 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1197 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1198
1199
1200 @node Subscription Methods
1201 @subsection Subscription Methods
1202
1203 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1204 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1205 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1206
1207 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1208 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1209
1210 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1211
1212 @table @code
1213
1214 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1215 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1216 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1217 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1218 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1219
1220 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1221 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1222 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1223 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1224
1225 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1226 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1227 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1228
1229 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1230 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1231 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1232 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1233 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1234 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1235 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1236 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1237 up. Or something like that.
1238
1239 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1240 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1241 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1242 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1243 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1244
1245 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1246 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1247 Kill all new groups.
1248
1249 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1250 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1251 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1252 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1253 topic parameter that looks like
1254
1255 @example
1256 "nnslashdot"
1257 @end example
1258
1259 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1260 that topic.
1261
1262 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1263 top-level topic.
1264
1265 @end table
1266
1267 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1268 A closely related variable is
1269 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1270 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1271 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1272 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1273 hierarchy or not.
1274
1275 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1276 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1277 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1278 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1279
1280
1281 @node Filtering New Groups
1282 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1283
1284 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1285 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1286 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1287
1288 @example
1289 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1290 @end example
1291
1292 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1293 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1294 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1295 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1296 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1297 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1298 subscribing these groups.
1299 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1300 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1301
1302 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1303 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1304 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1305 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1306 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1307 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1308 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1309 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1310
1311 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1312 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1313 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1314 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1315 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1316 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1317 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1318 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1319 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1320 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1321 @code{nil}.
1322
1323 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1324 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1325
1326
1327 @node Changing Servers
1328 @section Changing Servers
1329 @cindex changing servers
1330
1331 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1332 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1333 very flaky and you want to use another.
1334
1335 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1336 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1337
1338 @emph{Wrong!}
1339
1340 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1341 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1342 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1343 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1344 worthless.
1345
1346 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1347 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1348 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1349 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1350
1351 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1352 @findex gnus-change-server
1353 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1354 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1355 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1356 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1357 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1358
1359 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1360 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1361 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1362 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1363 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1364
1365 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1366 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1367 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1368 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1369 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1370 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1371
1372 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1373 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1374 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1375 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1376
1377 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1378 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1379 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1380 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1381 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1382 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1383 cache for all groups).
1384
1385
1386 @node Startup Files
1387 @section Startup Files
1388 @cindex startup files
1389 @cindex .newsrc
1390 @cindex .newsrc.el
1391 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1392
1393 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1394 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1395 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1396 read.
1397
1398 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1399 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1400 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1401 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1402 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1403 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1404 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1405
1406 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1407 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1408 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1409 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1410 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1411 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1412
1413 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1414 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1415 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1416 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1417 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1418 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1419 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1420 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1421 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1422 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1423 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1424 news reader.
1425
1426 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1427 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1428 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1429 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1430 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1431 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1432 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1433 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1434 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1435 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1436 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1437 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1438
1439 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1440 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1441 @vindex version-control
1442 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1443 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1444 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1445 If you want version control for this file, set
1446 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1447 @code{version-control} variable.
1448
1449 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1450 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1451 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1452 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1453 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1454 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1455 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1456 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1457 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1458 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1459
1460 @lisp
1461 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1462 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1463
1464 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1465 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1466 @end lisp
1467
1468 @vindex gnus-init-file
1469 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1470 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1471 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1472 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1473 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1474 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1475 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1476 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1477 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1478 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1479 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1480 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1481 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1482
1483
1484 @node Auto Save
1485 @section Auto Save
1486 @cindex dribble file
1487 @cindex auto-save
1488
1489 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1490 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1491 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1492 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1493 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1494 this file.
1495
1496 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1497 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1498 saved.
1499
1500 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1501 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1502 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1503
1504 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1505 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1506 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1507 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1508 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1509 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1510
1511 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1512 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1513 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1514
1515
1516 @node The Active File
1517 @section The Active File
1518 @cindex active file
1519 @cindex ignored groups
1520
1521 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1522 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1523 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1524
1525 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1526 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1527 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1528 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1529 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1530 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1531 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1532
1533 @c This variable is
1534 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1535 @c if you set it to anything else.
1536
1537 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1538 @c @head
1539 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1540 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1541 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1542
1543 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1544 you actually subscribe to.
1545
1546 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1547 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1548 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1549 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1550
1551 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1552 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1553 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1554 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1555 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1556 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1557
1558 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1559 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1560 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1561 variable.
1562
1563 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1564 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1565 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1566 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1567 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1568 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1569
1570 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1571 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1572
1573 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1574 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1575
1576 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1577 secondary select methods.
1578
1579
1580 @node Startup Variables
1581 @section Startup Variables
1582
1583 @table @code
1584
1585 @item gnus-load-hook
1586 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1587 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1588 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1589 times you start Gnus.
1590
1591 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1592 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1593 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1594
1595 @item gnus-startup-hook
1596 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1597 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1598
1599 @item gnus-started-hook
1600 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1601 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1602 successfully.
1603
1604 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1605 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1606 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1607 generating the group buffer.
1608
1609 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1610 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1611 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1612 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1613 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1614 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1615 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1616 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1617
1618 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1619 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1620 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1621 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1622 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1623 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1624
1625 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1626 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1627 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1628
1629 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1630 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1631 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1632
1633 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1634 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1635 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1636 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1637
1638 @end table
1639
1640
1641 @node Group Buffer
1642 @chapter Group Buffer
1643 @cindex group buffer
1644
1645 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1646 @c
1647 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1648 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1649 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1650 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1651 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1652 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1653 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1654 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1655 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1656 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1657 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1658 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1659 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1660 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1661 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1662 @c human rights at 9...
1663
1664
1665 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1666 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1667 long as Gnus is active.
1668
1669 @iftex
1670 @iflatex
1671 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1672 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1673 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1674 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1675 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1676 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1677 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1678 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1679 }
1680 @end iflatex
1681 @end iftex
1682
1683 @menu
1684 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1685 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1686 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1687 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1688 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1689 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1690 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1691 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1692 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1693 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1694 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1695 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1696 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1697 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1698 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1699 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1700 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1701 @end menu
1702
1703
1704 @node Group Buffer Format
1705 @section Group Buffer Format
1706
1707 @menu
1708 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1709 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1710 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1711 @end menu
1712
1713 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1714 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1715 available in Emacs.
1716
1717 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1718 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1719 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1720 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1721 Emacs version.
1722
1723 @node Group Line Specification
1724 @subsection Group Line Specification
1725 @cindex group buffer format
1726
1727 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1728 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1729
1730 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1731
1732 @example
1733 25: news.announce.newusers
1734 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1735 @end example
1736
1737 Quite simple, huh?
1738
1739 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1740 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1741 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1742 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1743
1744 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1745 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1746 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1747 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1748 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1749 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1750
1751 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1752
1753 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1754 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1755 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1756 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1757 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1758
1759 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1760 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1761 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1762
1763 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1764
1765 @table @samp
1766
1767 @item M
1768 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1769
1770 @item S
1771 Whether the group is subscribed.
1772
1773 @item L
1774 Level of subscribedness.
1775
1776 @item N
1777 Number of unread articles.
1778
1779 @item I
1780 Number of dormant articles.
1781
1782 @item T
1783 Number of ticked articles.
1784
1785 @item R
1786 Number of read articles.
1787
1788 @item U
1789 Number of unseen articles.
1790
1791 @item t
1792 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1793 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1794
1795 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1796 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1797 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1798 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1799 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1800 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1801 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1802 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1803
1804 @item y
1805 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1806
1807 @item i
1808 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1809
1810 @item g
1811 Full group name.
1812
1813 @item G
1814 Group name.
1815
1816 @item C
1817 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1818 comment element in the group parameters.
1819
1820 @item D
1821 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1822 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1823 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1824 command.
1825
1826 @item o
1827 @samp{m} if moderated.
1828
1829 @item O
1830 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1831
1832 @item s
1833 Select method.
1834
1835 @item B
1836 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1837
1838 @item n
1839 Select from where.
1840
1841 @item z
1842 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1843 used.
1844
1845 @item P
1846 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1847
1848 @item c
1849 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1850 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1851 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1852 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1853 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1854
1855 @item m
1856 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1857 @cindex %
1858 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1859 the group lately.
1860
1861 @item p
1862 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1863
1864 @item d
1865 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1866 Timestamp}).
1867
1868 @item u
1869 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1870 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1871 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1872 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1873 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1874 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1875 specifier.
1876 @end table
1877
1878 @cindex *
1879 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1880 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1881 group, or a bogus native group.
1882
1883
1884 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1885 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1886 @cindex group mode line
1887
1888 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1889 The mode line can be changed by setting
1890 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1891 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1892
1893 @table @samp
1894 @item S
1895 The native news server.
1896 @item M
1897 The native select method.
1898 @end table
1899
1900
1901 @node Group Highlighting
1902 @subsection Group Highlighting
1903 @cindex highlighting
1904 @cindex group highlighting
1905
1906 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1907 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1908 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1909 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1910 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1911
1912 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1913 background is dark:
1914
1915 @lisp
1916 (cond (window-system
1917 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1918 (defface my-group-face-1
1919 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1920 (defface my-group-face-2
1921 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1922 "Second group face")
1923 (defface my-group-face-3
1924 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1925 (defface my-group-face-4
1926 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1927 (defface my-group-face-5
1928 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1929
1930 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1931 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1932 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1933 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1934 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1935 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1936 @end lisp
1937
1938 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1939
1940 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1941 include:
1942
1943 @table @code
1944 @item group
1945 The group name.
1946 @item unread
1947 The number of unread articles in the group.
1948 @item method
1949 The select method.
1950 @item mailp
1951 Whether the group is a mail group.
1952 @item level
1953 The level of the group.
1954 @item score
1955 The score of the group.
1956 @item ticked
1957 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1958 @item total
1959 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1960 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1961 @item topic
1962 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1963 topic being inserted.
1964 @end table
1965
1966 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1967 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1968 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1969
1970 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1971 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1972 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1973 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1974 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1975
1976
1977 @node Group Maneuvering
1978 @section Group Maneuvering
1979 @cindex group movement
1980
1981 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1982 expected, hopefully.
1983
1984 @table @kbd
1985
1986 @item n
1987 @kindex n (Group)
1988 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1989 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1990 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1991
1992 @item p
1993 @itemx DEL
1994 @kindex DEL (Group)
1995 @kindex p (Group)
1996 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1997 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1998 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1999
2000 @item N
2001 @kindex N (Group)
2002 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2003 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2004
2005 @item P
2006 @kindex P (Group)
2007 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2008 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2009
2010 @item M-n
2011 @kindex M-n (Group)
2012 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2013 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2014 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2015
2016 @item M-p
2017 @kindex M-p (Group)
2018 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2019 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2020 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2021 @end table
2022
2023 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2024
2025 @table @kbd
2026
2027 @item j
2028 @kindex j (Group)
2029 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2030 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2031 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2032 like living groups.
2033
2034 @item ,
2035 @kindex , (Group)
2036 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2037 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2038 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2039
2040 @item .
2041 @kindex . (Group)
2042 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2043 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2044 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2045 @end table
2046
2047 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2048 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2049 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2050 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2051 is @code{t}.
2052
2053
2054 @node Selecting a Group
2055 @section Selecting a Group
2056 @cindex group selection
2057
2058 @table @kbd
2059
2060 @item SPACE
2061 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2062 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2063 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2064 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2065 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2066 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2067 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2068 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2069 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2070 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2071
2072 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2073 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2074 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2075
2076 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2077 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2078 ones.
2079
2080 @item RET
2081 @kindex RET (Group)
2082 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2083 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2084 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2085 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2086 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2087 entry.
2088
2089 @item M-RET
2090 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2091 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2092 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2093 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2094 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2095 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2096 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2097 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2098 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2099 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2100
2101 @item M-SPACE
2102 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2103 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2104 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2105 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2106 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2107
2108 @item C-M-RET
2109 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2110 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2111 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2112 doing any processing of its contents
2113 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2114 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2115 manner will have no permanent effects.
2116
2117 @end table
2118
2119 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2120 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2121 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2122 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2123 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2124 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2125 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2126 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2127 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2128 most recently will be fetched.
2129
2130 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2131 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2132 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2133 newsgroups.
2134
2135 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2136 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2137 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2138 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2139 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2140 Which article this is is controlled by the
2141 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2142 variable is:
2143
2144 @table @code
2145
2146 @item unread
2147 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2148
2149 @item first
2150 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2151
2152 @item unseen
2153 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2154
2155 @item unseen-or-unread
2156 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2157 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2158 unread article.
2159
2160 @item best
2161 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2162
2163 @end table
2164
2165 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2166 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2167
2168 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2169 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2170 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2171 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2172 selected.
2173
2174
2175 @node Subscription Commands
2176 @section Subscription Commands
2177 @cindex subscription
2178
2179 @table @kbd
2180
2181 @item S t
2182 @itemx u
2183 @kindex S t (Group)
2184 @kindex u (Group)
2185 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2186 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2187 Toggle subscription to the current group
2188 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2189
2190 @item S s
2191 @itemx U
2192 @kindex S s (Group)
2193 @kindex U (Group)
2194 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2195 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2196 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2197 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2198
2199 @item S k
2200 @itemx C-k
2201 @kindex S k (Group)
2202 @kindex C-k (Group)
2203 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2204 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2205 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2206
2207 @item S y
2208 @itemx C-y
2209 @kindex S y (Group)
2210 @kindex C-y (Group)
2211 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2212 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2213
2214 @item C-x C-t
2215 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2216 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2217 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2218 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2219 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2220
2221 @item S w
2222 @itemx C-w
2223 @kindex S w (Group)
2224 @kindex C-w (Group)
2225 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2226 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2227
2228 @item S z
2229 @kindex S z (Group)
2230 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2231 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2232
2233 @item S C-k
2234 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2235 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2236 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2237 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2238 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2239 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2240 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2241 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2242 @file{.newsrc} file.
2243
2244 @end table
2245
2246 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2247
2248
2249 @node Group Data
2250 @section Group Data
2251
2252 @table @kbd
2253
2254 @item c
2255 @kindex c (Group)
2256 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2257 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2258 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2259 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2260 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2261 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2262 the group buffer.
2263
2264 @item C
2265 @kindex C (Group)
2266 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2267 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2268 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2269
2270 @item M-c
2271 @kindex M-c (Group)
2272 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2273 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2274 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2275
2276 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2277 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2278 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2279 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2280 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2281 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2282 caution.
2283
2284 @end table
2285
2286
2287 @node Group Levels
2288 @section Group Levels
2289 @cindex group level
2290 @cindex level
2291
2292 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2293 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2294 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2295 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2296 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2297
2298 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2299
2300 @table @kbd
2301
2302 @item S l
2303 @kindex S l (Group)
2304 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2305 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2306 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2307 prompted for a level.
2308 @end table
2309
2310 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2311 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2312 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2313 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2314 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2315 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2316 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2317 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2318 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2319 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2320 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2321 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2322 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2323 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2324 reasons of efficiency.
2325
2326 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2327 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2328
2329 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2330 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2331 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2332 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2333 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2334 groups are hidden, in a way.
2335
2336 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2337 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2338 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2339 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2340 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2341 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2342
2343 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2344 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2345 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2346 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2347 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2348 list of killed groups.)
2349
2350 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2351 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2352 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2353
2354 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2355 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2356 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2357 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2358 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2359 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2360 relevant valid ranges.
2361
2362 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2363 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2364 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2365 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2366 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2367 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2368 rest.
2369
2370 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2371 one with the best level.
2372
2373 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2374 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2375 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2376 by default.
2377
2378 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2379 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2380 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2381 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2382 listed.
2383
2384 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2385 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2386 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2387 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2388
2389 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2390 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2391 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2392 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2393 to 5. The default is 6.
2394
2395
2396 @node Group Score
2397 @section Group Score
2398 @cindex group score
2399 @cindex group rank
2400 @cindex rank
2401
2402 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2403 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2404 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2405 reason?
2406
2407 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2408 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2409 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2410 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2411 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2412 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2413 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2414 least significant part.))
2415
2416 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2417 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2418 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2419 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2420 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2421 action after each summary exit, you can add
2422 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2423 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2424 slow things down somewhat.
2425
2426
2427 @node Marking Groups
2428 @section Marking Groups
2429 @cindex marking groups
2430
2431 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2432 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2433 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2434 bidding on those groups.
2435
2436 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2437 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2438 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2439
2440 @table @kbd
2441
2442 @item #
2443 @kindex # (Group)
2444 @itemx M m
2445 @kindex M m (Group)
2446 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2447 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2448
2449 @item M-#
2450 @kindex M-# (Group)
2451 @itemx M u
2452 @kindex M u (Group)
2453 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2454 Remove the mark from the current group
2455 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2456
2457 @item M U
2458 @kindex M U (Group)
2459 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2460 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2461
2462 @item M w
2463 @kindex M w (Group)
2464 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2465 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2466
2467 @item M b
2468 @kindex M b (Group)
2469 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2470 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2471
2472 @item M r
2473 @kindex M r (Group)
2474 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2475 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2476 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2477 @end table
2478
2479 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2480
2481 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2482 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2483 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2484 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2485 the command to be executed.
2486
2487
2488 @node Foreign Groups
2489 @section Foreign Groups
2490 @cindex foreign groups
2491
2492 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2493 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2494 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2495 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2496 consulted.
2497
2498 @table @kbd
2499
2500 @item G m
2501 @kindex G m (Group)
2502 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2503 @cindex making groups
2504 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2505 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2506 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2507
2508 @item G M
2509 @kindex G M (Group)
2510 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2511 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2512 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2513
2514 @item G r
2515 @kindex G r (Group)
2516 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2517 @cindex renaming groups
2518 Rename the current group to something else
2519 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2520 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2521 on some back ends.
2522
2523 @item G c
2524 @kindex G c (Group)
2525 @cindex customizing
2526 @findex gnus-group-customize
2527 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2528
2529 @item G e
2530 @kindex G e (Group)
2531 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2532 @cindex renaming groups
2533 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2534 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2535
2536 @item G p
2537 @kindex G p (Group)
2538 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2539 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2540 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2541
2542 @item G E
2543 @kindex G E (Group)
2544 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2545 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2546 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2547
2548 @item G d
2549 @kindex G d (Group)
2550 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2551 @cindex nndir
2552 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2553 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2554
2555 @item G h
2556 @kindex G h (Group)
2557 @cindex help group
2558 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2559 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2560
2561 @item G a
2562 @kindex G a (Group)
2563 @cindex (ding) archive
2564 @cindex archive group
2565 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2566 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2567 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2568 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2569 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2570 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2571 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2572
2573 @item G k
2574 @kindex G k (Group)
2575 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2576 @cindex nnkiboze
2577 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2578 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2579 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2580 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2581
2582 @item G D
2583 @kindex G D (Group)
2584 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2585 @cindex nneething
2586 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2587 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2588 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2589
2590 @item G f
2591 @kindex G f (Group)
2592 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2593 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2594 @cindex nndoc
2595 Make a group based on some file or other
2596 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2597 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2598 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2599 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2600 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2601 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2602 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2603 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2604 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2605
2606 @item G u
2607 @kindex G u (Group)
2608 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2609 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2610 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2611 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2612
2613 @item G w
2614 @kindex G w (Group)
2615 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2616 @cindex Google
2617 @cindex nnweb
2618 @cindex gmane
2619 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2620 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2621 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2622 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2623 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2624 @xref{Web Searches}.
2625
2626 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2627 to a particular group by using a match string like
2628 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2629
2630 @item G R
2631 @kindex G R (Group)
2632 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2633 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2634 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2635 @xref{RSS}.
2636
2637 @item G DEL
2638 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2639 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2640 This function will delete the current group
2641 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2642 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2643 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2644 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2645 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2646
2647 @item G V
2648 @kindex G V (Group)
2649 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2650 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2651 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2652
2653 @item G v
2654 @kindex G v (Group)
2655 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2656 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2657 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2658 @end table
2659
2660 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2661 methods.
2662
2663 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2664 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2665 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2666 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2667 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2668 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2669 newsgroups.
2670
2671
2672 @node Group Parameters
2673 @section Group Parameters
2674 @cindex group parameters
2675
2676 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2677 Here's an example group parameter list:
2678
2679 @example
2680 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2681 (auto-expire . t))
2682 @end example
2683
2684 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2685 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2686 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2687 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2688
2689 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2690 is an alist of regexps and values.
2691
2692 The following group parameters can be used:
2693
2694 @table @code
2695 @item to-address
2696 @cindex to-address
2697 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2698
2699 @example
2700 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2701 @end example
2702
2703 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2704 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2705 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2706 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2707 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2708
2709 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2710 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2711 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2712 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2713 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2714 list address instead.
2715
2716 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2717
2718 @item to-list
2719 @cindex to-list
2720 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2721
2722 @example
2723 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2724 @end example
2725
2726 It is totally ignored
2727 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2728 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2729
2730 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2731 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2732 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2733 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2734 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2735
2736 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2737 @cindex mail list groups
2738 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2739 entering summary buffer.
2740
2741 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2742
2743 @anchor{subscribed}
2744 @item subscribed
2745 @cindex subscribed
2746 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2747 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2748 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2749 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2750 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2751 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2752 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2753 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2754
2755 @lisp
2756 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2757 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2758 @end lisp
2759
2760 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2761 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2762
2763 @item visible
2764 @cindex visible
2765 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2766 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2767 of whether it has any unread articles.
2768
2769 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2770 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2771
2772 @item broken-reply-to
2773 @cindex broken-reply-to
2774 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2775 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2776 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2777 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2778 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2779 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2780
2781 @item to-group
2782 @cindex to-group
2783 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2784 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2785
2786 @item newsgroup
2787 @cindex newsgroup
2788 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2789 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2790 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2791 news group.
2792
2793 @item gcc-self
2794 @cindex gcc-self
2795 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2796 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2797 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2798 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2799 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2800 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2801 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2802
2803 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2804 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2805 doesn't accept articles.
2806
2807 @item auto-expire
2808 @cindex auto-expire
2809 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2810 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2811 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2812
2813 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2814
2815 @item total-expire
2816 @cindex total-expire
2817 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2818 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2819 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2820 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2821 expiry.
2822
2823 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2824
2825 @item expiry-wait
2826 @cindex expiry-wait
2827 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2828 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2829 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2830 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2831 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2832 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2833 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2834
2835 @item expiry-target
2836 @cindex expiry-target
2837 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2838 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2839
2840 @item score-file
2841 @cindex score file group parameter
2842 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2843 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2844 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2845
2846 @item adapt-file
2847 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2848 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2849 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2850 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2851
2852 @item admin-address
2853 @cindex admin-address
2854 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2855 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2856 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2857 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2858
2859 @item display
2860 @cindex display
2861 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2862 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2863
2864 @table @code
2865 @item all
2866 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2867
2868 @item an integer
2869 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2870 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2871
2872 @item default
2873 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2874 ticked articles.
2875
2876 @item an array
2877 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2878
2879 Here are some examples:
2880
2881 @table @code
2882 @item [unread]
2883 Display only unread articles.
2884
2885 @item [not expire]
2886 Display everything except expirable articles.
2887
2888 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2889 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2890 responded to.
2891 @end table
2892
2893 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2894 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2895 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2896 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2897 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2898
2899 @end table
2900
2901 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2902 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2903 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2904
2905 @item comment
2906 @cindex comment
2907 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2908 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2909 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2910
2911 @item charset
2912 @cindex charset
2913 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2914 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2915 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2916
2917 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2918
2919 @item ignored-charsets
2920 @cindex ignored-charset
2921 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2922 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2923 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2924
2925 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2926
2927 @item posting-style
2928 @cindex posting-style
2929 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2930 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2931 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2932 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2933 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2934
2935 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2936 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2937 like this in the group parameters:
2938
2939 @example
2940 (posting-style
2941 (name "Funky Name")
2942 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2943 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2944 @end example
2945
2946 @item post-method
2947 @cindex post-method
2948 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2949 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2950
2951 @item banner
2952 @cindex banner
2953 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2954 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
2955 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2956 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2957 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2958
2959 @item sieve
2960 @cindex sieve
2961 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2962 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2963 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2964 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2965
2966 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
2967 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2968 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2969 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2970
2971 @example
2972 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
2973 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
2974 @}
2975 @end example
2976
2977 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
2978 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
2979
2980 @item (agent parameters)
2981 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
2982 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
2983 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
2984 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
2985 minimize the configuration effort.
2986
2987 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2988 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2989 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2990 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2991 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2992 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2993 @code{eval}ed there.
2994
2995 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
2996 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
2997 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
2998 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
2999 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3000 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3001 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3002 @file{~/.gnus} file:
3003
3004 @lisp
3005 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3006 @end lisp
3007
3008 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3009 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3010 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3011
3012 @example
3013 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3014 @end example
3015
3016 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3017 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3018 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3019 into the group parameters for the group.
3020
3021 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3022 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3023 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3024 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3025 @code{(ding)} form.
3026
3027 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3028 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3029 following is added to a group parameter
3030
3031 @lisp
3032 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3033 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3034 @end lisp
3035
3036 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3037 expired.
3038
3039 @end table
3040
3041 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3042 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3043 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3044 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3045 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3046
3047 @vindex gnus-parameters
3048 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3049 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3050 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3051 For example:
3052
3053 @lisp
3054 (setq gnus-parameters
3055 '(("mail\\..*"
3056 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3057 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3058 (gnus-summary-line-format
3059 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3060 (gcc-self . t)
3061 (display . all))
3062
3063 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3064 (to-group . "\\1"))
3065
3066 ("mail\\.me"
3067 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3068
3069 ("list\\..*"
3070 (total-expire . t)
3071 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3072 @end lisp
3073
3074 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3075 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3076
3077 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3078 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3079 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3080 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3081 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3082 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3083 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3084 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3085 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3086 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3087 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3088 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3089
3090
3091 @node Listing Groups
3092 @section Listing Groups
3093 @cindex group listing
3094
3095 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3096
3097 @table @kbd
3098
3099 @item l
3100 @itemx A s
3101 @kindex A s (Group)
3102 @kindex l (Group)
3103 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3104 List all groups that have unread articles
3105 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3106 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3107 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3108 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3109 groups).
3110
3111 @item L
3112 @itemx A u
3113 @kindex A u (Group)
3114 @kindex L (Group)
3115 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3116 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3117 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3118 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3119 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3120 unsubscribed groups).
3121
3122 @item A l
3123 @kindex A l (Group)
3124 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3125 List all unread groups on a specific level
3126 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3127 with no unread articles.
3128
3129 @item A k
3130 @kindex A k (Group)
3131 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3132 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3133 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3134 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3135 from the server.
3136
3137 @item A z
3138 @kindex A z (Group)
3139 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3140 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3141
3142 @item A m
3143 @kindex A m (Group)
3144 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3145 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3146 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3147
3148 @item A M
3149 @kindex A M (Group)
3150 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3151 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3152
3153 @item A A
3154 @kindex A A (Group)
3155 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3156 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3157 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3158 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3159 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3160 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3161 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3162 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3163
3164 @item A a
3165 @kindex A a (Group)
3166 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3167 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3168 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3169
3170 @item A d
3171 @kindex A d (Group)
3172 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3173 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3174 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3175
3176 @item A c
3177 @kindex A c (Group)
3178 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3179 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3180
3181 @item A ?
3182 @kindex A ? (Group)
3183 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3184 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3185
3186 @item A /
3187 @kindex A / (Group)
3188 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3189 List groups limited within the current selection
3190 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3191
3192 @item A f
3193 @kindex A f (Group)
3194 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3195 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3196
3197 @item A p
3198 @kindex A p (Group)
3199 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3200 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3201
3202 @end table
3203
3204 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3205 @cindex visible group parameter
3206 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3207 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3208 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3209 get the same effect.
3210
3211 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3212 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3213 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3214 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3215 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3216
3217
3218 @node Sorting Groups
3219 @section Sorting Groups
3220 @cindex sorting groups
3221
3222 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3223 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3224 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3225 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3226 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3227 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3228 include:
3229
3230 @table @code
3231
3232 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3233 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3234 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3235
3236 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3237 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3238 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3239
3240 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3241 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3242 Sort by group level.
3243
3244 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3245 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3246 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3247
3248 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3249 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3250 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3251 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3252
3253 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3254 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3255 Sort by number of unread articles.
3256
3257 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3258 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3259 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3260
3261 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3262 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3263 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3264
3265
3266 @end table
3267
3268 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3269 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3270 the last one.
3271
3272
3273 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3274 some sorting criteria:
3275
3276 @table @kbd
3277 @item G S a
3278 @kindex G S a (Group)
3279 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3280 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3281 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3282
3283 @item G S u
3284 @kindex G S u (Group)
3285 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3286 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3287 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3288
3289 @item G S l
3290 @kindex G S l (Group)
3291 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3292 Sort the group buffer by group level
3293 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3294
3295 @item G S v
3296 @kindex G S v (Group)
3297 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3298 Sort the group buffer by group score
3299 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3300
3301 @item G S r
3302 @kindex G S r (Group)
3303 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3304 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3305 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3306
3307 @item G S m
3308 @kindex G S m (Group)
3309 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3310 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3311 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3312
3313 @item G S n
3314 @kindex G S n (Group)
3315 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3316 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3317 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3318
3319 @end table
3320
3321 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3322 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3323
3324 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3325 commands will sort in reverse order.
3326
3327 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3328
3329 @table @kbd
3330 @item G P a
3331 @kindex G P a (Group)
3332 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3333 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3334 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3335
3336 @item G P u
3337 @kindex G P u (Group)
3338 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3339 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3340 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3341
3342 @item G P l
3343 @kindex G P l (Group)
3344 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3345 Sort the groups by group level
3346 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3347
3348 @item G P v
3349 @kindex G P v (Group)
3350 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3351 Sort the groups by group score
3352 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3353
3354 @item G P r
3355 @kindex G P r (Group)
3356 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3357 Sort the groups by group rank
3358 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3359
3360 @item G P m
3361 @kindex G P m (Group)
3362 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3363 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3364 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3365
3366 @item G P n
3367 @kindex G P n (Group)
3368 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3369 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3370 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3371
3372 @item G P s
3373 @kindex G P s (Group)
3374 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3375 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3376
3377 @end table
3378
3379 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3380 move groups around.
3381
3382
3383 @node Group Maintenance
3384 @section Group Maintenance
3385 @cindex bogus groups
3386
3387 @table @kbd
3388 @item b
3389 @kindex b (Group)
3390 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3391 Find bogus groups and delete them
3392 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3393
3394 @item F
3395 @kindex F (Group)
3396 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3397 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3398 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3399 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3400 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3401 zombies.
3402
3403 @item C-c C-x
3404 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3405 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3406 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3407 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3408 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3409 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3410
3411 @item C-c C-M-x
3412 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3413 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3414 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3415 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3416
3417 @end table
3418
3419
3420 @node Browse Foreign Server
3421 @section Browse Foreign Server
3422 @cindex foreign servers
3423 @cindex browsing servers
3424
3425 @table @kbd
3426 @item B
3427 @kindex B (Group)
3428 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3429 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3430 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3431 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3432 @end table
3433
3434 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3435 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3436 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3437 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3438
3439 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3440
3441 @table @kbd
3442 @item n
3443 @kindex n (Browse)
3444 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3445 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3446
3447 @item p
3448 @kindex p (Browse)
3449 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3450 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3451
3452 @item SPACE
3453 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3454 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3455 Enter the current group and display the first article
3456 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3457
3458 @item RET
3459 @kindex RET (Browse)
3460 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3461 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3462
3463 @item u
3464 @kindex u (Browse)
3465 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3466 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3467 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3468
3469 @item l
3470 @itemx q
3471 @kindex q (Browse)
3472 @kindex l (Browse)
3473 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3474 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3475
3476 @item d
3477 @kindex d (Browse)
3478 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3479 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3480
3481 @item ?
3482 @kindex ? (Browse)
3483 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3484 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3485 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3486 @end table
3487
3488
3489 @node Exiting Gnus
3490 @section Exiting Gnus
3491 @cindex exiting Gnus
3492
3493 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3494
3495 @table @kbd
3496 @item z
3497 @kindex z (Group)
3498 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3499 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3500 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3501 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3502
3503 @item q
3504 @kindex q (Group)
3505 @findex gnus-group-exit
3506 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3507 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3508
3509 @item Q
3510 @kindex Q (Group)
3511 @findex gnus-group-quit
3512 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3513 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3514 @end table
3515
3516 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3517 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3518 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3519 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3520 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3521 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3522 exiting Gnus.
3523
3524 Note:
3525
3526 @quotation
3527 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3528 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3529 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3530 plastic chair.
3531 @end quotation
3532
3533
3534 @node Group Topics
3535 @section Group Topics
3536 @cindex topics
3537
3538 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3539 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3540 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3541 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3542 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3543 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3544
3545 @iftex
3546 @iflatex
3547 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3548 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3549 }
3550 @end iflatex
3551 @end iftex
3552
3553 Here's an example:
3554
3555 @example
3556 Gnus
3557 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3558 3: comp.emacs
3559 2: alt.religion.emacs
3560 Naughty Emacs
3561 452: alt.sex.emacs
3562 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3563 Misc
3564 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3565 13: comp.sources.unix
3566 @end example
3567
3568 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3569 @kindex t (Group)
3570 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3571 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3572 is a toggling command.)
3573
3574 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3575 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3576 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3577 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3578 Hot and bothered?
3579
3580 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3581 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3582 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3583
3584 @lisp
3585 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3586 @end lisp
3587
3588 @menu
3589 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3590 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3591 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3592 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3593 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3594 @end menu
3595
3596
3597 @node Topic Commands
3598 @subsection Topic Commands
3599 @cindex topic commands
3600
3601 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3602 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3603 definitions slightly.
3604
3605 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3606 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3607 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3608 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3609 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3610 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3611
3612 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3613 the way you like.
3614
3615 @table @kbd
3616
3617 @item T n
3618 @kindex T n (Topic)
3619 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3620 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3621 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3622
3623 @item T TAB
3624 @itemx TAB
3625 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3626 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3627 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3628 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3629 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3630 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3631
3632 @item M-TAB
3633 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3634 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3635 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3636 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3637
3638 @end table
3639
3640 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3641 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3642 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3643 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3644
3645 @table @kbd
3646
3647 @item C-k
3648 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3649 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3650 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3651 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3652
3653 @item C-y
3654 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3655 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3656 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3657 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3658 before all groups.
3659
3660 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3661 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3662 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3663 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3664 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3665
3666 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3667 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3668
3669 @end table
3670
3671 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3672 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3673 key.
3674
3675 @table @kbd
3676
3677 @item RET
3678 @kindex RET (Topic)
3679 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3680 @itemx SPACE
3681 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3682 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3683 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3684 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3685 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3686 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3687
3688 @end table
3689
3690 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3691
3692 @table @kbd
3693
3694 @item T m
3695 @kindex T m (Topic)
3696 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3697 Move the current group to some other topic
3698 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3699 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3700
3701 @item T j
3702 @kindex T j (Topic)
3703 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3704 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3705
3706 @item T c
3707 @kindex T c (Topic)
3708 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3709 Copy the current group to some other topic
3710 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3711 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3712
3713 @item T h
3714 @kindex T h (Topic)
3715 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3716 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3717 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3718
3719 @item T s
3720 @kindex T s (Topic)
3721 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3722 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3723 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3724
3725 @item T D
3726 @kindex T D (Topic)
3727 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3728 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3729 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3730 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3731 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3732 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3733 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3734 topic.
3735
3736 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3737 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3738
3739 @item T M
3740 @kindex T M (Topic)
3741 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3742 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3743 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3744
3745 @item T C
3746 @kindex T C (Topic)
3747 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3748 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3749 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3750
3751 @item T H
3752 @kindex T H (Topic)
3753 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3754 Toggle hiding empty topics
3755 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3756
3757 @item T #
3758 @kindex T # (Topic)
3759 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3760 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3761 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3762 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3763
3764 @item T M-#
3765 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3766 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3767 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3768 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3769 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3770
3771 @item C-c C-x
3772 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3773 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3774 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3775 expiry process (if any)
3776 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3777
3778 @item T r
3779 @kindex T r (Topic)
3780 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3781 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3782
3783 @item T DEL
3784 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3785 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3786 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3787
3788 @item A T
3789 @kindex A T (Topic)
3790 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3791 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3792 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3793
3794 @item T M-n
3795 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3796 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3797 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3798
3799 @item T M-p
3800 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3801 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3802 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3803
3804 @item G p
3805 @kindex G p (Topic)
3806 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3807 @cindex group parameters
3808 @cindex topic parameters
3809 @cindex parameters
3810 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3811 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3812
3813 @end table
3814
3815
3816 @node Topic Variables
3817 @subsection Topic Variables
3818 @cindex topic variables
3819
3820 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3821 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3822
3823 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3824 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3825 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3826 Valid elements are:
3827
3828 @table @samp
3829 @item i
3830 Indentation.
3831 @item n
3832 Topic name.
3833 @item v
3834 Visibility.
3835 @item l
3836 Level.
3837 @item g
3838 Number of groups in the topic.
3839 @item a
3840 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3841 @item A
3842 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3843 @end table
3844
3845 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3846 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3847 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3848 The default is 2.
3849
3850 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3851 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3852
3853 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3854 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3855 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3856
3857
3858 @node Topic Sorting
3859 @subsection Topic Sorting
3860 @cindex topic sorting
3861
3862 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3863 commands:
3864
3865
3866 @table @kbd
3867 @item T S a
3868 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3869 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3870 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3871 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3872
3873 @item T S u
3874 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3875 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3876 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3877 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3878
3879 @item T S l
3880 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3881 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3882 Sort the current topic by group level
3883 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3884
3885 @item T S v
3886 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3887 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3888 Sort the current topic by group score
3889 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3890
3891 @item T S r
3892 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3893 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3894 Sort the current topic by group rank
3895 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3896
3897 @item T S m
3898 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3899 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3900 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3901 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3902
3903 @item T S e
3904 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3905 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3906 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3907 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3908
3909 @item T S s
3910 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3911 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3912 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3913 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3914 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3915
3916 @end table
3917
3918 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3919 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3920 sorting.
3921
3922
3923 @node Topic Topology
3924 @subsection Topic Topology
3925 @cindex topic topology
3926 @cindex topology
3927
3928 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3929
3930 @example
3931 @group
3932 Gnus
3933 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3934 3: comp.emacs
3935 2: alt.religion.emacs
3936 Naughty Emacs
3937 452: alt.sex.emacs
3938 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3939 Misc
3940 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3941 13: comp.sources.unix
3942 @end group
3943 @end example
3944
3945 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3946 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3947 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3948 follows:
3949
3950 @lisp
3951 (("Gnus" visible)
3952 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3953 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3954 (("Misc" visible)))
3955 @end lisp
3956
3957 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3958 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3959 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3960 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3961 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3962 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3963
3964 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3965 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3966 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3967
3968
3969 @node Topic Parameters
3970 @subsection Topic Parameters
3971 @cindex topic parameters
3972
3973 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
3974 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
3975 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
3976 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
3977 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
3978
3979 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3980 parameters:
3981
3982 @table @code
3983 @item subscribe
3984 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3985 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3986 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3987 topic.
3988
3989 @item subscribe-level
3990 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
3991 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
3992 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
3993
3994 @end table
3995
3996 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3997 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3998 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3999 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4000
4001 @example
4002 @group
4003 Gnus
4004 Emacs
4005 3: comp.emacs
4006 2: alt.religion.emacs
4007 452: alt.sex.emacs
4008 Relief
4009 452: alt.sex.emacs
4010 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4011 Misc
4012 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4013 13: comp.sources.unix
4014 452: alt.sex.emacs
4015 @end group
4016 @end example
4017
4018 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4019 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4020 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4021 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4022 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4023 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4024
4025 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4026 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4027 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4028 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4029 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4030
4031 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4032 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4033 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4034 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4035 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4036 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4037 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4038 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4039
4040
4041 @node Misc Group Stuff
4042 @section Misc Group Stuff
4043
4044 @menu
4045 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4046 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4047 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4048 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4049 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4050 @end menu
4051
4052 @table @kbd
4053
4054 @item v
4055 @kindex v (Group)
4056 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4057 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it key to some
4058 function or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4059
4060 @lisp
4061 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4062 (lambda ()
4063 (interactive)
4064 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4065 @end lisp
4066
4067 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4068 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4069
4070 @item ^
4071 @kindex ^ (Group)
4072 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4073 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4074 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4075
4076 @item a
4077 @kindex a (Group)
4078 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4079 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4080 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4081 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4082 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4083 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4084 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4085
4086 @item m
4087 @kindex m (Group)
4088 @findex gnus-group-mail
4089 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4090 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4091 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4092 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4093
4094 @item i
4095 @kindex i (Group)
4096 @findex gnus-group-news
4097 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4098 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4099 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4100
4101 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4102 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4103 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4104 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4105 for this to work though.
4106
4107 @end table
4108
4109 Variables for the group buffer:
4110
4111 @table @code
4112
4113 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4114 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4115 is called after the group buffer has been
4116 created.
4117
4118 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4119 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4120 is called after the group buffer is
4121 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4122 unnatural way.
4123
4124 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4125 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4126 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4127 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4128
4129 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4130 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4131 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4132 whether they are empty or not.
4133
4134 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4135 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4136 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4137 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4138
4139 For example:
4140 @lisp
4141 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4142 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4143 @end lisp
4144
4145 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4146 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4147 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4148 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4149 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4150 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4151 default is @code{nil}.
4152
4153 For example:
4154 @lisp
4155 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4156 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4157 @end lisp
4158
4159 @end table
4160
4161 @node Scanning New Messages
4162 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4163 @cindex new messages
4164 @cindex scanning new news
4165
4166 @table @kbd
4167
4168 @item g
4169 @kindex g (Group)
4170 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4171 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4172 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4173 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4174 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4175 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4176 back end(s).
4177
4178 @item M-g
4179 @kindex M-g (Group)
4180 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4181 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4182 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4183 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4184 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4185 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4186 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4187
4188 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4189 @cindex activating groups
4190 @item C-c M-g
4191 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4192 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4193
4194 @item R
4195 @kindex R (Group)
4196 @cindex restarting
4197 @findex gnus-group-restart
4198 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4199 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4200 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4201
4202 @end table
4203
4204 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4205 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4206
4207 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4208 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4209 news.
4210
4211
4212 @node Group Information
4213 @subsection Group Information
4214 @cindex group information
4215 @cindex information on groups
4216
4217 @table @kbd
4218
4219
4220 @item H f
4221 @kindex H f (Group)
4222 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4223 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4224 @cindex FAQ
4225 @cindex ange-ftp
4226 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4227 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4228 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4229 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4230 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4231 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4232 used for fetching the file.
4233
4234 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4235 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4236
4237 @item H c
4238 @kindex H c (Group)
4239 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4240 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4241 @cindex charter
4242 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4243 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4244 prefix argument.
4245
4246 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4247 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4248 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4249
4250 @item H C
4251 @kindex H C (Group)
4252 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4253 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4254 @cindex control message
4255 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4256 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4257 group if given a prefix argument.
4258
4259 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4260 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4261 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4262 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4263
4264 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4265 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4266 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4267
4268 @item H d
4269 @itemx C-c C-d
4270 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4271 @kindex H d (Group)
4272 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4273 @cindex describing groups
4274 @cindex group description
4275 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4276 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4277 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4278
4279 @item M-d
4280 @kindex M-d (Group)
4281 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4282 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4283 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4284
4285 @item H v
4286 @itemx V
4287 @kindex V (Group)
4288 @kindex H v (Group)
4289 @cindex version
4290 @findex gnus-version
4291 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4292
4293 @item ?
4294 @kindex ? (Group)
4295 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4296 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4297
4298 @item C-c C-i
4299 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4300 @cindex info
4301 @cindex manual
4302 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4303 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4304 @end table
4305
4306
4307 @node Group Timestamp
4308 @subsection Group Timestamp
4309 @cindex timestamps
4310 @cindex group timestamps
4311
4312 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4313 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4314 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4315
4316 @lisp
4317 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4318 @end lisp
4319
4320 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4321
4322 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4323 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4324
4325 @lisp
4326 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4327 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4328 @end lisp
4329
4330 This will result in lines looking like:
4331
4332 @example
4333 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4334 0: custom 19961002T012713
4335 @end example
4336
4337 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4338 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4339 something like:
4340
4341 @lisp
4342 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4343 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4344 @end lisp
4345
4346 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4347 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4348 trick:
4349
4350 @lisp
4351 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4352 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4353 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4354 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4355 (if time
4356 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4357 "")))
4358 @end lisp
4359
4360
4361 @node File Commands
4362 @subsection File Commands
4363 @cindex file commands
4364
4365 @table @kbd
4366
4367 @item r
4368 @kindex r (Group)
4369 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4370 @vindex gnus-init-file
4371 @cindex reading init file
4372 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4373 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4374
4375 @item s
4376 @kindex s (Group)
4377 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4378 @cindex saving .newsrc
4379 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4380 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4381 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4382
4383 @c @item Z
4384 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4385 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4386 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4387
4388 @end table
4389
4390
4391 @node Sieve Commands
4392 @subsection Sieve Commands
4393 @cindex group sieve commands
4394
4395 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4396 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4397 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4398 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4399 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4400
4401 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4402 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4403 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4404 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4405 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4406 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4407 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4408 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4409 regenerate the Sieve script.
4410
4411 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4412 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4413 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4414 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4415 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4416 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4417 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4418 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4419 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4420 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4421
4422 @example
4423 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4424 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4425 stop;
4426 @}
4427 @end example
4428
4429 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4430
4431 @table @kbd
4432
4433 @item D g
4434 @kindex D g (Group)
4435 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4436 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4437 @cindex generating sieve script
4438 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4439 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4440
4441 @item D u
4442 @kindex D u (Group)
4443 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4444 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4445 @cindex updating sieve script
4446 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4447 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4448 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4449
4450 @end table
4451
4452
4453 @node Summary Buffer
4454 @chapter Summary Buffer
4455 @cindex summary buffer
4456
4457 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4458 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4459
4460 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4461 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4462
4463 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4464
4465 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4466 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4467 available in Emacs.
4468
4469 @kindex v (Summary)
4470 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4471 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it key to some
4472 function or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4473 @lisp
4474 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4475 @end lisp
4476
4477 @menu
4478 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4479 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4480 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4481 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4482 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4483 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4484 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4485 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4486 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4487 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4488 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4489 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4490 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4491 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4492 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4493 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4494 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4495 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4496 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4497 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4498 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4499 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4500 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4501 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4502 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4503 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4504 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4505 or reselecting the current group.
4506 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4507 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4508 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4509 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4510 @end menu
4511
4512
4513 @node Summary Buffer Format
4514 @section Summary Buffer Format
4515 @cindex summary buffer format
4516
4517 @iftex
4518 @iflatex
4519 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4520 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4521 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4522 }
4523 @end iflatex
4524 @end iftex
4525
4526 @menu
4527 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4528 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4529 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4530 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4531 @end menu
4532
4533 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4534 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4535 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4536 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4537 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4538 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4539 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4540 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4541 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4542 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4543 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4544
4545 @lisp
4546 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4547 'mail-extract-address-components)
4548 @end lisp
4549
4550 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4551 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4552 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4553 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4554
4555
4556 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4557 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4558
4559 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4560 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4561 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4562 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4563 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4564
4565 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4566 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4567 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4568 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4569 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4570 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4571
4572 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4573
4574 The following format specification characters and extended format
4575 specification(s) are understood:
4576
4577 @table @samp
4578 @item N
4579 Article number.
4580 @item S
4581 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4582 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4583 @item s
4584 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4585 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4586 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4587 @item F
4588 Full @code{From} header.
4589 @item n
4590 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4591 @item f
4592 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4593 From Newsgroups}).
4594 @item a
4595 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4596 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4597 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4598 may be more thorough.
4599 @item A
4600 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4601 the @code{a} spec.
4602 @item L
4603 Number of lines in the article.
4604 @item c
4605 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4606 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4607 @item k
4608 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4609 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4610 @item I
4611 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4612 @item B
4613 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4614 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4615
4616 @example
4617 >
4618 +->
4619 | +->
4620 | | \->
4621 | | \->
4622 | \->
4623 +->
4624 \->
4625 @end example
4626
4627 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4628 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4629 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4630 line-drawing glyphs.
4631 @table @code
4632 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4633 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4634 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4635 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4636
4637 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4638 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4639 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4640 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4641
4642 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4643 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4644 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4645 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4646
4647 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4648 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4649 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4650
4651 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4652 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4653 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4654
4655 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4656 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4657 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4658
4659 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4660 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4661 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4662
4663 @end table
4664
4665 @item T
4666 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4667 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4668 @item [
4669 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4670 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4671 @item ]
4672 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4673 for adopted articles.
4674 @item >
4675 One space for each thread level.
4676 @item <
4677 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4678 @item U
4679 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4680
4681 @item R
4682 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4683 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4684 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4685
4686 @item i
4687 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4688 @item z
4689 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4690 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4691 default level. If the difference between
4692 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4693 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4694 @item V
4695 Total thread score.
4696 @item x
4697 @code{Xref}.
4698 @item D
4699 @code{Date}.
4700 @item d
4701 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4702 @item o
4703 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4704 @item M
4705 @code{Message-ID}.
4706 @item r
4707 @code{References}.
4708 @item t
4709 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4710 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4711 @item e
4712 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4713 article has any children.
4714 @item P
4715 The line number.
4716 @item O
4717 Download mark.
4718 @item *
4719 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4720 @item &user-date;
4721 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4722 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4723 @item u
4724 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4725 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4726 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4727 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4728 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4729 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4730 @end table
4731
4732 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4733 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4734 There can only be one such area.
4735
4736 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4737 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4738 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4739 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4740 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4741 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4742
4743 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4744 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4745
4746 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4747
4748
4749 @node To From Newsgroups
4750 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4751 @cindex To
4752 @cindex Newsgroups
4753
4754 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4755 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4756 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4757 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4758 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4759
4760 @enumerate
4761 @item
4762 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4763 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4764 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4765 instance:
4766
4767 @lisp
4768 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4769 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4770 @end lisp
4771
4772 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4773 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4774
4775 @item
4776 @findex gnus-extra-header
4777 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4778 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4779 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4780
4781 @example
4782 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4783 @end example
4784
4785 @item
4786 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4787 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4788 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4789 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4790 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4791 headers are used instead.
4792
4793 @end enumerate
4794
4795 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4796 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4797 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4798 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4799 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4800 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4801 regeneration.
4802
4803 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4804 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4805 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4806 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4807
4808 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4809 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4810
4811 @lisp
4812 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4813 '(To Newsgroups))
4814 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4815 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4816 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4817 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4818 "Your Name Here")
4819 @end lisp
4820
4821 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4822 to fit your needs.)
4823
4824 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4825 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4826 support:
4827
4828 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4829 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4830 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4831
4832 @example
4833 Newsgroups:full
4834 @end example
4835
4836 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4837 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4838
4839
4840 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4841 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4842
4843 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4844 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4845 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4846 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4847
4848 Here are the elements you can play with:
4849
4850 @table @samp
4851 @item G
4852 Group name.
4853 @item p
4854 Unprefixed group name.
4855 @item A
4856 Current article number.
4857 @item z
4858 Current article score.
4859 @item V
4860 Gnus version.
4861 @item U
4862 Number of unread articles in this group.
4863 @item e
4864 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4865 summary buffer.
4866 @item Z
4867 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4868 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4869 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4870 and no unselected ones.
4871 @item g
4872 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4873 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4874 @item S
4875 Subject of the current article.
4876 @item u
4877 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4878 @item s
4879 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4880 @item d
4881 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4882 @item t
4883 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4884 @item r
4885 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4886 @item E
4887 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4888 @end table
4889
4890
4891 @node Summary Highlighting
4892 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4893
4894 @table @code
4895
4896 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4897 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4898 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4899 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4900 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4901
4902 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4903 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4904 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4905 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4906
4907 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4908 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4909 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4910 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4911
4912 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4913 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4914 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4915 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4916 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4917 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4918 to something like
4919 @lisp
4920 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4921 ((> score default) . bold))
4922 @end lisp
4923 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4924 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4925 @end table
4926
4927
4928 @node Summary Maneuvering
4929 @section Summary Maneuvering
4930 @cindex summary movement
4931
4932 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4933 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4934
4935 None of these commands select articles.
4936
4937 @table @kbd
4938 @item G M-n
4939 @itemx M-n
4940 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4941 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4942 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4943 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4944 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4945
4946 @item G M-p
4947 @itemx M-p
4948 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4949 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4950 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4951 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4952 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4953
4954 @item G g
4955 @kindex G g (Summary)
4956 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4957 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4958 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4959 @end table
4960
4961 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4962 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4963 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4964 to the group buffer.
4965
4966 Variables related to summary movement:
4967
4968 @table @code
4969
4970 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4971 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4972 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4973 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4974 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4975 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4976 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4977 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
4978 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
4979 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
4980 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
4981 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
4982 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
4983 @pxref{Group Levels}.
4984
4985 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4986 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4987 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4988 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4989 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4990 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4991 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4992
4993 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4994
4995 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4996 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4997 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4998 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4999 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5000
5001 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5002 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5003 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5004 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5005 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5006 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5007 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5008 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5009 threads.
5010
5011 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5012 the given number of lines from the top.
5013
5014 @end table
5015
5016
5017 @node Choosing Articles
5018 @section Choosing Articles
5019 @cindex selecting articles
5020
5021 @menu
5022 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5023 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5024 @end menu
5025
5026
5027 @node Choosing Commands
5028 @subsection Choosing Commands
5029
5030 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5031 and they all select and display an article.
5032
5033 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5034 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5035
5036 @table @kbd
5037 @item SPACE
5038 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5039 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5040 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5041 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5042
5043 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5044 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5045 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5046
5047 @item G n
5048 @itemx n
5049 @kindex n (Summary)
5050 @kindex G n (Summary)
5051 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5052 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5053 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5054
5055 @item G p
5056 @itemx p
5057 @kindex p (Summary)
5058 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5059 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5060 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5061
5062 @item G N
5063 @itemx N
5064 @kindex N (Summary)
5065 @kindex G N (Summary)
5066 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5067 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5068
5069 @item G P
5070 @itemx P
5071 @kindex P (Summary)
5072 @kindex G P (Summary)
5073 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5074 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5075
5076 @item G C-n
5077 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5078 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5079 Go to the next article with the same subject
5080 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5081
5082 @item G C-p
5083 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5084 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5085 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5086 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5087
5088 @item G f
5089 @itemx .
5090 @kindex G f (Summary)
5091 @kindex . (Summary)
5092 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5093 Go to the first unread article
5094 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5095
5096 @item G b
5097 @itemx ,
5098 @kindex G b (Summary)
5099 @kindex , (Summary)
5100 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5101 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5102 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5103 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5104
5105 @item G l
5106 @itemx l
5107 @kindex l (Summary)
5108 @kindex G l (Summary)
5109 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5110 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5111
5112 @item G o
5113 @kindex G o (Summary)
5114 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5115 @cindex history
5116 @cindex article history
5117 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5118 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5119 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5120 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5121 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5122 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5123
5124 @item G j
5125 @itemx j
5126 @kindex j (Summary)
5127 @kindex G j (Summary)
5128 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5129 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5130 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5131
5132 @end table
5133
5134
5135 @node Choosing Variables
5136 @subsection Choosing Variables
5137
5138 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5139
5140 @table @code
5141 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5142 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5143 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5144 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5145 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5146 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5147
5148 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5149 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5150 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5151 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5152 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5153 hook will do so.
5154
5155 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5156 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5157 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5158 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5159 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5160 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5161 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5162 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5163 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5164 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5165 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5166 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5167 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5168 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5169
5170 @end table
5171
5172
5173 @node Paging the Article
5174 @section Scrolling the Article
5175 @cindex article scrolling
5176
5177 @table @kbd
5178
5179 @item SPACE
5180 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5181 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5182 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5183 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5184 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5185
5186 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5187 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5188 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5189 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5190 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5191 what is considered uninteresting with
5192 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5193 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5194
5195 @item DEL
5196 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5197 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5198 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5199
5200 @item RET
5201 @kindex RET (Summary)
5202 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5203 Scroll the current article one line forward
5204 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5205
5206 @item M-RET
5207 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5208 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5209 Scroll the current article one line backward
5210 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5211
5212 @item A g
5213 @itemx g
5214 @kindex A g (Summary)
5215 @kindex g (Summary)
5216 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5217 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5218 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5219 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5220 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5221 the way it came from the server.
5222
5223 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5224 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5225 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5226
5227 @lisp
5228 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5229 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5230 (2 . big5)))
5231 @end lisp
5232
5233 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5234
5235 @item A <
5236 @itemx <
5237 @kindex < (Summary)
5238 @kindex A < (Summary)
5239 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5240 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5241 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5242
5243 @item A >
5244 @itemx >
5245 @kindex > (Summary)
5246 @kindex A > (Summary)
5247 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5248 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5249
5250 @item A s
5251 @itemx s
5252 @kindex A s (Summary)
5253 @kindex s (Summary)
5254 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5255 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5256 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5257
5258 @item h
5259 @kindex h (Summary)
5260 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5261 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5262
5263 @end table
5264
5265
5266 @node Reply Followup and Post
5267 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5268
5269 @menu
5270 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5271 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5272 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5273 * Canceling and Superseding::
5274 @end menu
5275
5276
5277 @node Summary Mail Commands
5278 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5279 @cindex mail
5280 @cindex composing mail
5281
5282 Commands for composing a mail message:
5283
5284 @table @kbd
5285
5286 @item S r
5287 @itemx r
5288 @kindex S r (Summary)
5289 @kindex r (Summary)
5290 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5291 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5292 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5293 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5294 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5295
5296 @item S R
5297 @itemx R
5298 @kindex R (Summary)
5299 @kindex S R (Summary)
5300 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5301 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5302 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5303 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5304 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5305
5306 @item S w
5307 @kindex S w (Summary)
5308 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5309 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5310 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5311 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5312 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5313 present, that's used instead.
5314
5315 @item S W
5316 @kindex S W (Summary)
5317 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5318 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5319 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5320 the process/prefix convention.
5321
5322 @item S v
5323 @kindex S v (Summary)
5324 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5325 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5326 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5327 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5328 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5329 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5330
5331 @item S V
5332 @kindex S V (Summary)
5333 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5334 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5335 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5336 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5337
5338 @item S B r
5339 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5340 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5341 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5342 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5343 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5344 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5345 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5346 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5347
5348 @item S B R
5349 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5350 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5351 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5352 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5353 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5354
5355 @item S o m
5356 @itemx C-c C-f
5357 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5358 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5359 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5360 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5361 Forward the current article to some other person
5362 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5363 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5364 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5365 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5366 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5367 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5368 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5369 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5370 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5371 section.
5372
5373 @item S m
5374 @itemx m
5375 @kindex m (Summary)
5376 @kindex S m (Summary)
5377 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5378 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5379 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5380 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5381 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5382
5383 @item S i
5384 @itemx i
5385 @kindex i (Summary)
5386 @kindex S i (Summary)
5387 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5388 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5389 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5390 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5391
5392 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5393 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5394 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5395 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5396 for this to work though.
5397
5398 @item S D b
5399 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5400 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5401 @cindex bouncing mail
5402 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5403 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5404 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5405 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5406 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5407 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5408 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5409 very well fail, though.
5410
5411 @item S D r
5412 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5413 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5414 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5415 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5416 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5417 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5418 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5419 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5420 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5421 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5422
5423 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5424 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5425 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5426 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5427 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5428
5429 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5430 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5431
5432 @item S D e
5433 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5434 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5435
5436 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5437 if it were a new message before resending.
5438
5439 @item S O m
5440 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5441 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5442 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5443 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5444 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5445
5446 @item S M-c
5447 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5448 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5449 @cindex crossposting
5450 @cindex excessive crossposting
5451 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5452 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5453
5454 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5455 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5456 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5457 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5458 command understands the process/prefix convention
5459 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5460
5461 @end table
5462
5463 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5464 Manual}, for more information.
5465
5466
5467 @node Summary Post Commands
5468 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5469 @cindex post
5470 @cindex composing news
5471
5472 Commands for posting a news article:
5473
5474 @table @kbd
5475 @item S p
5476 @itemx a
5477 @kindex a (Summary)
5478 @kindex S p (Summary)
5479 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5480 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5481 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5482 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5483 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5484
5485 @item S f
5486 @itemx f
5487 @kindex f (Summary)
5488 @kindex S f (Summary)
5489 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5490 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5491 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5492
5493 @item S F
5494 @itemx F
5495 @kindex S F (Summary)
5496 @kindex F (Summary)
5497 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5498 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5499 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5500 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5501 process/prefix convention.
5502
5503 @item S n
5504 @kindex S n (Summary)
5505 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5506 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5507 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5508
5509 @item S N
5510 @kindex S N (Summary)
5511 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5512 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5513 message through mail and include the original message
5514 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5515 the process/prefix convention.
5516
5517 @item S o p
5518 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5519 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5520 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5521 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5522 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5523 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5524 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5525 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5526 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5527 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5528 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5529 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5530 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5531
5532 @item S O p
5533 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5534 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5535 @cindex digests
5536 @cindex making digests
5537 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5538 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5539 process/prefix convention.
5540
5541 @item S u
5542 @kindex S u (Summary)
5543 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5544 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5545 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5546 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5547 @end table
5548
5549 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5550 Manual}, for more information.
5551
5552
5553 @node Summary Message Commands
5554 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5555
5556 @table @kbd
5557 @item S y
5558 @kindex S y (Summary)
5559 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5560 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5561 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5562 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5563 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5564
5565 @end table
5566
5567
5568 @node Canceling and Superseding
5569 @subsection Canceling Articles
5570 @cindex canceling articles
5571 @cindex superseding articles
5572
5573 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5574 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5575
5576 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5577
5578 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5579 @kindex C (Summary)
5580 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5581 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5582 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5583 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5584 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5585 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5586
5587 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5588 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5589 question.
5590
5591 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5592 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5593 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5594
5595 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5596 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5597 message, Message Manual}).
5598
5599 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5600 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5601 your original article.
5602
5603 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5604 @kindex S (Summary)
5605 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5606 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5607 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5608 usual way.
5609
5610 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5611 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5612 have posted almost the same article twice.
5613
5614 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5615 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5616 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5617 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5618 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5619 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5620 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5621 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5622 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5623 canceled/superseded.
5624
5625 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5626
5627 @node Delayed Articles
5628 @section Delayed Articles
5629 @cindex delayed sending
5630 @cindex send delayed
5631
5632 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5633 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5634 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5635 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5636
5637 @lisp
5638 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5639 @end lisp
5640
5641 @findex gnus-delay-article
5642 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5643 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5644 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5645 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5646
5647 @itemize @bullet
5648 @item
5649 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5650 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5651 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5652 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5653
5654 @item
5655 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5656 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5657 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5658
5659 @item
5660 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5661 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5662 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5663 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5664 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5665 that means a time tomorrow.
5666 @end itemize
5667
5668 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5669 couple of variables:
5670
5671 @table @code
5672 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5673 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5674 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5675 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5676
5677 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5678 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5679 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5680 formats described above.
5681
5682 @item gnus-delay-group
5683 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5684 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5685 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5686 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5687
5688 @item gnus-delay-header
5689 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5690 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5691 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5692 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5693 @end table
5694
5695 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5696 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5697 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5698 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5699 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5700
5701 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5702 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5703 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5704 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5705 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5706 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5707 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5708
5709 @table @code
5710 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5711 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5712 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5713 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5714 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5715 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5716 argument is ignored.
5717
5718 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5719 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5720 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5721 @end table
5722
5723
5724 @node Marking Articles
5725 @section Marking Articles
5726 @cindex article marking
5727 @cindex article ticking
5728 @cindex marks
5729
5730 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5731
5732 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5733 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5734 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5735
5736 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5737
5738 @ifinfo
5739 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5740 @end ifinfo
5741
5742 @menu
5743 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5744 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5745 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5746 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5747 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5748 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5749 @end menu
5750
5751
5752 @node Unread Articles
5753 @subsection Unread Articles
5754
5755 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5756 other.
5757
5758 @table @samp
5759 @item !
5760 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5761 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5762
5763 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5764 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5765 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5766 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5767 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5768 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5769 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5770
5771 @item ?
5772 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5773 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5774
5775 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5776 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5777 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5778 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5779 messages.
5780
5781 @item SPACE
5782 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5783 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5784
5785 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5786 @end table
5787
5788
5789 @node Read Articles
5790 @subsection Read Articles
5791 @cindex expirable mark
5792
5793 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5794
5795 @table @samp
5796
5797 @item r
5798 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5799 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5800 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5801
5802 @item R
5803 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5804 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5805
5806 @item O
5807 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5808 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5809 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5810
5811 @item K
5812 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5813 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5814
5815 @item X
5816 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5817 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5818
5819 @item Y
5820 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5821 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5822
5823 @item C
5824 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5825 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5826
5827 @item G
5828 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5829 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5830
5831 @item F
5832 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5833 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5834
5835 @item Q
5836 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5837 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5838 Threading}.
5839
5840 @item M
5841 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5842 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5843 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5844
5845 @end table
5846
5847 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5848 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5849
5850 One more special mark, though:
5851
5852 @table @samp
5853 @item E
5854 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5855 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5856
5857 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5858 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5859 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5860 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5861 any time.
5862 @end table
5863
5864
5865 @node Other Marks
5866 @subsection Other Marks
5867 @cindex process mark
5868 @cindex bookmarks
5869
5870 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5871 read or not.
5872
5873 @itemize @bullet
5874
5875 @item
5876 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5877 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5878 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5879 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5880 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5881
5882 @item
5883 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5884 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5885 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5886 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5887
5888 @item
5889 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5890 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5891 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5892
5893 @item
5894 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5895 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5896 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5897
5898 @item
5899 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5900 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5901 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5902 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5903
5904 @item
5905 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5906 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5907 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5908 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5909 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5910 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5911
5912 @item
5913 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5914 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5915 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5916 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5917
5918 @item
5919 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5920 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5921 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5922 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5923 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5924 use.)
5925
5926 @item
5927 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5928 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5929 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5930 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5931 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5932 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5933
5934 @item
5935 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5936 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5937 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5938 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5939 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5940 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5941 use.)
5942
5943 @item
5944 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5945 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5946 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5947 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5948 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5949
5950 @item
5951 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5952 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5953 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5954 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5955 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5956 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5957
5958 @end itemize
5959
5960 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5961 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5962 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5963
5964 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5965 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5966 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5967
5968
5969 @node Setting Marks
5970 @subsection Setting Marks
5971 @cindex setting marks
5972
5973 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5974
5975 @table @kbd
5976 @item M c
5977 @itemx M-u
5978 @kindex M c (Summary)
5979 @kindex M-u (Summary)
5980 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5981 @cindex mark as unread
5982 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5983 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5984 article as unread.
5985
5986 @item M t
5987 @itemx !
5988 @kindex ! (Summary)
5989 @kindex M t (Summary)
5990 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5991 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5992 @xref{Article Caching}.
5993
5994 @item M ?
5995 @itemx ?
5996 @kindex ? (Summary)
5997 @kindex M ? (Summary)
5998 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5999 Mark the current article as dormant
6000 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6001
6002 @item M d
6003 @itemx d
6004 @kindex M d (Summary)
6005 @kindex d (Summary)
6006 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6007 Mark the current article as read
6008 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6009
6010 @item D
6011 @kindex D (Summary)
6012 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6013 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6014 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6015
6016 @item M k
6017 @itemx k
6018 @kindex k (Summary)
6019 @kindex M k (Summary)
6020 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6021 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6022 and then select the next unread article
6023 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6024
6025 @item M K
6026 @itemx C-k
6027 @kindex M K (Summary)
6028 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6029 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6030 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6031 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6032
6033 @item M C
6034 @kindex M C (Summary)
6035 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6036 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6037 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6038
6039 @item M C-c
6040 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6041 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6042 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6043 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6044
6045 @item M H
6046 @kindex M H (Summary)
6047 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6048 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6049 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6050
6051 @item M h
6052 @kindex M h (Summary)
6053 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6054 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6055 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6056
6057 @item C-w
6058 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6059 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6060 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6061 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6062
6063 @item M V k
6064 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6065 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6066 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6067 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6068
6069 @item M e
6070 @itemx E
6071 @kindex M e (Summary)
6072 @kindex E (Summary)
6073 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6074 Mark the current article as expirable
6075 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6076
6077 @item M b
6078 @kindex M b (Summary)
6079 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6080 Set a bookmark in the current article
6081 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6082
6083 @item M B
6084 @kindex M B (Summary)
6085 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6086 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6087 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6088
6089 @item M V c
6090 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6091 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6092 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6093 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6094
6095 @item M V u
6096 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6097 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6098 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6099 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6100
6101 @item M V m
6102 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6103 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6104 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6105 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6106 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6107 @end table
6108
6109 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6110 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6111 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6112 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6113 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6114 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6115 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6116 The default is @code{t}.
6117
6118
6119 @node Generic Marking Commands
6120 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6121
6122 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6123 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6124 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6125 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6126 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6127 well.
6128
6129 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6130 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6131 command should do.
6132
6133 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6134 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6135 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6136 to list in this manual.
6137
6138 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6139 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6140 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6141 article, you could say something like:
6142
6143 @lisp
6144 @group
6145 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6146 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6147 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6148 @end group
6149 @end lisp
6150
6151 @noindent
6152 or
6153
6154 @lisp
6155 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6156 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6157 @end lisp
6158
6159
6160 @node Setting Process Marks
6161 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6162 @cindex setting process marks
6163
6164 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6165 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6166 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6167 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6168 commands into the cache. For more information,
6169 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6170
6171 @table @kbd
6172
6173 @item M P p
6174 @itemx #
6175 @kindex # (Summary)
6176 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6177 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6178 Mark the current article with the process mark
6179 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6180 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6181
6182 @item M P u
6183 @itemx M-#
6184 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6185 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6186 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6187 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6188
6189 @item M P U
6190 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6191 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6192 Remove the process mark from all articles
6193 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6194
6195 @item M P i
6196 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6197 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6198 Invert the list of process marked articles
6199 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6200
6201 @item M P R
6202 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6203 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6204 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6205 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6206
6207 @item M P G
6208 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6209 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6210 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6211 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6212
6213 @item M P r
6214 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6215 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6216 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6217
6218 @item M P g
6219 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6220 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6221 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6222
6223 @item M P t
6224 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6225 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6226 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6227 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6228
6229 @item M P T
6230 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6231 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6232 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6233 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6234
6235 @item M P v
6236 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6237 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6238 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6239 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6240
6241 @item M P s
6242 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6243 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6244 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6245
6246 @item M P S
6247 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6248 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6249 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6250 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6251
6252 @item M P a
6253 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6254 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6255 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6256
6257 @item M P b
6258 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6259 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6260 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6261 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6262
6263 @item M P k
6264 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6265 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6266 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6267 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6268
6269 @item M P y
6270 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6271 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6272 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6273 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6274
6275 @item M P w
6276 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6277 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6278 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6279 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6280
6281 @end table
6282
6283 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6284 set process marks based on article body contents.
6285
6286
6287 @node Limiting
6288 @section Limiting
6289 @cindex limiting
6290
6291 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6292 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6293 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6294 buffer.
6295
6296 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6297 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6298 additional articles.
6299
6300 @table @kbd
6301
6302 @item / /
6303 @itemx / s
6304 @kindex / / (Summary)
6305 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6306 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6307 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6308 matching articles.
6309
6310 @item / a
6311 @kindex / a (Summary)
6312 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6313 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6314 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6315 matching articles.
6316
6317 @item / x
6318 @kindex / x (Summary)
6319 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6320 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6321 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6322 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6323 matching articles.
6324
6325 @item / u
6326 @itemx x
6327 @kindex / u (Summary)
6328 @kindex x (Summary)
6329 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6330 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6331 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6332 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6333 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6334
6335 @item / m
6336 @kindex / m (Summary)
6337 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6338 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6339 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6340
6341 @item / t
6342 @kindex / t (Summary)
6343 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6344 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6345 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6346 articles younger than that number of days.
6347
6348 @item / n
6349 @kindex / n (Summary)
6350 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6351 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
6352 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
6353 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6354
6355 @item / w
6356 @kindex / w (Summary)
6357 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6358 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6359 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6360 the stack.
6361
6362 @item / .
6363 @kindex / . (Summary)
6364 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6365 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6366 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6367
6368 @item / v
6369 @kindex / v (Summary)
6370 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6371 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6372 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6373
6374 @item / p
6375 @kindex / p (Summary)
6376 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6377 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6378 group parameter predicate
6379 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6380 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6381
6382 @item / E
6383 @itemx M S
6384 @kindex M S (Summary)
6385 @kindex / E (Summary)
6386 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6387 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6388 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6389
6390 @item / D
6391 @kindex / D (Summary)
6392 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6393 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6394 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6395
6396 @item / *
6397 @kindex / * (Summary)
6398 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6399 Include all cached articles in the limit
6400 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6401
6402 @item / d
6403 @kindex / d (Summary)
6404 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6405 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6406 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6407
6408 @item / M
6409 @kindex / M (Summary)
6410 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6411 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6412
6413 @item / T
6414 @kindex / T (Summary)
6415 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6416 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6417
6418 @item / c
6419 @kindex / c (Summary)
6420 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6421 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6422 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6423
6424 @item / C
6425 @kindex / C (Summary)
6426 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6427 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6428 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6429 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6430
6431 @item / N
6432 @kindex / N (Summary)
6433 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6434 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6435 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6436
6437 @item / o
6438 @kindex / o (Summary)
6439 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6440 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6441 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6442
6443 @end table
6444
6445
6446 @node Threading
6447 @section Threading
6448 @cindex threading
6449 @cindex article threading
6450
6451 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6452 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6453 hierarchical fashion.
6454
6455 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6456 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6457 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6458 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6459 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6460 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6461 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6462
6463 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6464
6465 @table @dfn
6466 @item root
6467 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6468
6469 @item thread
6470 A tree-like article structure.
6471
6472 @item sub-thread
6473 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6474
6475 @item loose threads
6476 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6477 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6478 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6479 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6480 called loose threads.
6481
6482 @item thread gathering
6483 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6484
6485 @item sparse threads
6486 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6487 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6488
6489 @end table
6490
6491
6492 @menu
6493 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6494 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6495 @end menu
6496
6497
6498 @node Customizing Threading
6499 @subsection Customizing Threading
6500 @cindex customizing threading
6501
6502 @menu
6503 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6504 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6505 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6506 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6507 @end menu
6508
6509
6510 @node Loose Threads
6511 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6512 @cindex <
6513 @cindex >
6514 @cindex loose threads
6515
6516 @table @code
6517 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6518 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6519 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6520 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6521 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6522 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6523
6524 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6525 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6526 There are four possible values:
6527
6528 @iftex
6529 @iflatex
6530 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6531 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6532 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6533 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6534 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6535 }
6536 @end iflatex
6537 @end iftex
6538
6539 @cindex adopting articles
6540
6541 @table @code
6542
6543 @item adopt
6544 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6545 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6546 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6547 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6548
6549 @item dummy
6550 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6551 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6552 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6553 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6554 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6555 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6556 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6557 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6558 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6559 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6560
6561 @item empty
6562 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6563 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6564 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6565 Buffer Format}).)
6566
6567 @item none
6568 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6569 display them after one another.
6570
6571 @item nil
6572 Don't gather loose threads.
6573 @end table
6574
6575 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6576 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6577 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6578 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6579 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6580 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6581 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6582 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6583 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6584 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6585 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6586
6587 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6588 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6589 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6590 Matching}).
6591
6592 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6593 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6594 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6595 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6596 simplification is used.
6597
6598 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6599 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6600 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6601 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6602
6603 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6604 @lisp
6605 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6606 (concat
6607 "\\`\\[?\\("
6608 (mapconcat
6609 'identity
6610 '("looking"
6611 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6612 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6613 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6614 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6615 ;; ...
6616 )
6617 "\\|")
6618 "\\)\\s *\\("
6619 (mapconcat 'identity
6620 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6621 "\\|")
6622 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6623 @end lisp
6624
6625 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6626 subjects.
6627
6628 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6629 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6630 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6631 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6632 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6633 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6634
6635 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6636
6637 @table @code
6638 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6639 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6640 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6641
6642 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6643 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6644 Simplify fuzzily.
6645
6646 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6647 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6648 Remove excessive whitespace.
6649
6650 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6651 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6652 Remove all whitespace.
6653 @end table
6654
6655 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6656
6657
6658 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6659 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6660 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6661 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6662 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6663 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6664 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6665 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6666
6667 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6668 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6669 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6670 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6671 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6672 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6673 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6674 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6675 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6676 cholera:
6677
6678 @table @code
6679 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6680 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6681 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6682 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6683
6684 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6685 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6686 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6687 @end table
6688
6689 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6690 something like:
6691
6692 @lisp
6693 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6694 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6695 @end lisp
6696
6697 @end table
6698
6699
6700 @node Filling In Threads
6701 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6702
6703 @table @code
6704 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6705 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6706 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6707 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6708 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6709 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6710 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6711 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6712 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6713 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6714 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6715 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6716 do about that.
6717
6718 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6719 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6720 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6721
6722 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6723 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6724 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6725 newsgroups.
6726
6727 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6728 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6729 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6730 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6731 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6732 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6733 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6734 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6735 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6736 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6737 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6738 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6739 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6740 @code{nil} by default.
6741
6742 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6743 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6744 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6745 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6746 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6747 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6748 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6749
6750 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6751 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6752 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6753
6754 @end table
6755
6756
6757 @node More Threading
6758 @subsubsection More Threading
6759
6760 @table @code
6761 @item gnus-show-threads
6762 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6763 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6764 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6765 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6766 slower and more awkward.
6767
6768 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6769 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6770 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6771 generated.
6772
6773 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6774 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6775 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6776
6777 Here's an example:
6778
6779 @lisp
6780 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6781 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6782 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6783 @end lisp
6784
6785 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6786 unread, but you get my drift.)
6787
6788
6789 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6790 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6791 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6792 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6793 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6794 threads are expunged.
6795
6796 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6797 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6798 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6799 will be hidden.
6800
6801 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6802 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6803 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6804 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6805 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6806 result in a new thread.
6807
6808 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6809 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6810 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6811 The default is 4.
6812
6813 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6814 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6815 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6816 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6817 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6818 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6819 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6820 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6821 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6822 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6823 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6824
6825 @end table
6826
6827
6828 @node Low-Level Threading
6829 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6830
6831 @table @code
6832
6833 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6834 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6835 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6836
6837 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6838 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6839 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6840 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6841 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6842 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6843 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6844 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6845 meaningful. Here's one example:
6846
6847 @lisp
6848 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6849
6850 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6851 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6852 (when (string-match
6853 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6854 (mail-header-set-id
6855 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6856 header))))
6857 @end lisp
6858
6859 @end table
6860
6861
6862 @node Thread Commands
6863 @subsection Thread Commands
6864 @cindex thread commands
6865
6866 @table @kbd
6867
6868 @item T k
6869 @itemx C-M-k
6870 @kindex T k (Summary)
6871 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6872 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6873 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6874 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6875 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6876 articles instead.
6877
6878 @item T l
6879 @itemx C-M-l
6880 @kindex T l (Summary)
6881 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6882 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6883 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6884 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6885
6886 @item T i
6887 @kindex T i (Summary)
6888 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6889 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6890 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6891
6892 @item T #
6893 @kindex T # (Summary)
6894 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6895 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6896 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6897
6898 @item T M-#
6899 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6900 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6901 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6902 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6903
6904 @item T T
6905 @kindex T T (Summary)
6906 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6907 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6908
6909 @item T s
6910 @kindex T s (Summary)
6911 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6912 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6913 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6914
6915 @item T h
6916 @kindex T h (Summary)
6917 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6918 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6919
6920 @item T S
6921 @kindex T S (Summary)
6922 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6923 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6924
6925 @item T H
6926 @kindex T H (Summary)
6927 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6928 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6929
6930 @item T t
6931 @kindex T t (Summary)
6932 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6933 Re-thread the current article's thread
6934 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6935 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6936
6937 @item T ^
6938 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6939 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6940 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6941 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6942
6943 @end table
6944
6945 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6946 understand the numeric prefix.
6947
6948 @table @kbd
6949
6950 @item T n
6951 @kindex T n (Summary)
6952 @itemx C-M-f
6953 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6954 @itemx M-down
6955 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6956 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6957 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6958
6959 @item T p
6960 @kindex T p (Summary)
6961 @itemx C-M-b
6962 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6963 @itemx M-up
6964 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6965 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6966 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6967
6968 @item T d
6969 @kindex T d (Summary)
6970 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
6971 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
6972
6973 @item T u
6974 @kindex T u (Summary)
6975 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
6976 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
6977
6978 @item T o
6979 @kindex T o (Summary)
6980 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
6981 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
6982 @end table
6983
6984 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
6985 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
6986 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
6987 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
6988 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
6989 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
6990 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
6991 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
6992 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
6993 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
6994 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
6995 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
6996 Matching}).
6997
6998
6999 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7000 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7001
7002 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7003 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7004 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7005 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7006 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7007 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7008 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7009 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7010 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7011 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7012 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7013 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7014 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7015 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7016
7017 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7018 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7019 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7020 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7021 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7022 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7023 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7024 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7025
7026 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7027 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7028 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
7029
7030 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7031 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7032 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7033 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7034 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7035 ascending article order.
7036
7037 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7038 by number, you could do something like:
7039
7040 @lisp
7041 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7042 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7043 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7044 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7045 @end lisp
7046
7047 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7048 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7049 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7050 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7051 which the articles arrived.
7052
7053 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7054 say something like:
7055
7056 @lisp
7057 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7058 '((lambda (t1 t2)
7059 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7060 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7061 @end lisp
7062
7063 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7064 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7065 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7066 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7067 tickles your fancy.
7068
7069 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7070 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7071 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7072 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7073 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7074 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7075 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7076 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7077 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7078 variable. It is very similar to the
7079 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7080 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7081 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7082 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7083 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7084 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7085 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7086
7087 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7088 say something like:
7089
7090 @lisp
7091 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7092 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7093 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7094 @end lisp
7095
7096
7097
7098 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7099 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7100 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7101 @cindex article pre-fetch
7102 @cindex pre-fetch
7103
7104 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7105 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7106 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7107 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7108 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7109
7110 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7111 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7112
7113 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7114 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7115 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7116 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7117 connection is blocked.
7118
7119 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7120 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7121 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7122 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7123
7124 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7125 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7126 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7127 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7128 extra connection.
7129
7130 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7131 you really want to.
7132
7133 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7134 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7135 happen automatically.
7136
7137 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7138 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7139 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7140 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7141 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7142 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7143 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7144
7145 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7146 @findex gnus-async-read-p
7147 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7148 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7149 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7150 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7151 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which
7152 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7153 article data structure as the only parameter.
7154
7155 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7156 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7157
7158 @lisp
7159 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7160 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7161 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7162 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7163 100)))
7164
7165 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7166 @end lisp
7167
7168 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7169 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7170 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7171
7172 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7173 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7174 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7175 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7176
7177 @table @code
7178 @item read
7179 Remove articles when they are read.
7180
7181 @item exit
7182 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7183 @end table
7184
7185 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7186
7187 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7188 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7189 @c from the next group.
7190
7191
7192 @node Article Caching
7193 @section Article Caching
7194 @cindex article caching
7195 @cindex caching
7196
7197 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7198 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7199 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7200 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7201 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7202
7203 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7204
7205 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7206 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7207 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7208 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7209 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7210 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7211 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7212 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7213
7214 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7215 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7216 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7217 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7218 as dormant, and don't worry.
7219
7220 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7221
7222 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7223 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7224 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7225 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7226 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7227 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7228 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7229 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7230 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7231 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7232
7233 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7234 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7235 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7236 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7237 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7238 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7239 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7240 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7241 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7242 not then be downloaded by this command.
7243
7244 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7245 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7246 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7247 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7248 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7249 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7250
7251 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7252 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7253 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7254 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7255 variables, the group is not cached.
7256
7257 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7258 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7259 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7260 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7261 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7262 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7263 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7264 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7265 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7266 file.
7267
7268 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7269 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7270 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7271 where, isn't that cool?
7272
7273 @node Persistent Articles
7274 @section Persistent Articles
7275 @cindex persistent articles
7276
7277 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7278 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7279 useful in my opinion.
7280
7281 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7282 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7283 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7284 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7285 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7286 the expiry going on at the news server.
7287
7288 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7289 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7290 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7291
7292 @table @kbd
7293
7294 @item *
7295 @kindex * (Summary)
7296 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7297 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7298
7299 @item M-*
7300 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7301 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7302 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7303 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7304 article.
7305 @end table
7306
7307 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7308
7309 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7310 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7311 interested in persistent articles:
7312
7313 @lisp
7314 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7315 @end lisp
7316
7317
7318 @node Article Backlog
7319 @section Article Backlog
7320 @cindex backlog
7321 @cindex article backlog
7322
7323 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7324 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7325 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7326 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7327 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7328 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7329 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7330 increase memory usage some.
7331
7332 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7333 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7334 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7335 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7336 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7337 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7338 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7339
7340 The default value is 20.
7341
7342
7343 @node Saving Articles
7344 @section Saving Articles
7345 @cindex saving articles
7346
7347 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7348 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7349 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7350 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7351 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7352
7353 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7354 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7355 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7356
7357 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7358 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7359 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7360
7361 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7362 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7363 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7364 deleted before saving.
7365
7366 @table @kbd
7367
7368 @item O o
7369 @itemx o
7370 @kindex O o (Summary)
7371 @kindex o (Summary)
7372 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7373 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7374 Save the current article using the default article saver
7375 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7376
7377 @item O m
7378 @kindex O m (Summary)
7379 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7380 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7381 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7382
7383 @item O r
7384 @kindex O r (Summary)
7385 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7386 Save the current article in Rmail format
7387 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7388
7389 @item O f
7390 @kindex O f (Summary)
7391 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7392 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7393 Save the current article in plain file format
7394 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7395
7396 @item O F
7397 @kindex O F (Summary)
7398 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7399 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7400 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7401
7402 @item O b
7403 @kindex O b (Summary)
7404 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7405 Save the current article body in plain file format
7406 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7407
7408 @item O h
7409 @kindex O h (Summary)
7410 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7411 Save the current article in mh folder format
7412 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7413
7414 @item O v
7415 @kindex O v (Summary)
7416 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7417 Save the current article in a VM folder
7418 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7419
7420 @item O p
7421 @itemx |
7422 @kindex O p (Summary)
7423 @kindex | (Summary)
7424 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7425 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7426 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7427 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7428 complete headers in the piped output.
7429
7430 @item O P
7431 @kindex O P (Summary)
7432 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7433 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7434 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7435 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7436 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7437 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7438 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7439
7440 @end table
7441
7442 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7443 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7444 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7445 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7446 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7447 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7448 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7449 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7450 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7451 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7452 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7453 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7454 files.
7455
7456
7457 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7458 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7459 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7460 functions below, or you can create your own.
7461
7462 @table @code
7463
7464 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7465 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7466 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7467 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7468 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7469 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7470 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7471
7472 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7473 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7474 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7475 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7476 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7477 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7478
7479 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7480 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7481 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7482 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7483 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7484 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7485 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7486
7487 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7488 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7489 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7490 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7491 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7492 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7493
7494 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7495 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7496 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7497 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7498 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7499
7500 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7501 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7502 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7503 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7504 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7505 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7506
7507 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7508 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7509 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7510 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7511 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7512 @cindex rcvstore
7513 @cindex MH folders
7514 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7515 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7516 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7517 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7518 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7519
7520 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7521 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7522 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7523 reader to use this setting.
7524 @end table
7525
7526 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7527
7528 @table @code
7529 @item :decode
7530 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7531 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7532 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7533 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file}, and
7534 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7535
7536 @item :function
7537 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7538 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7539 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7540 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7541 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7542 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7543
7544 @item :headers
7545 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7546 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7547 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7548 headers should be saved.
7549 @end table
7550
7551 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7552 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7553 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7554 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7555 default.
7556
7557 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7558 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7559 available functions that generate names:
7560
7561 @table @code
7562
7563 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7564 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7565 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7566
7567 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7568 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7569 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7570
7571 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7572 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7573 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7574
7575 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7576 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7577 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7578
7579 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7580 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7581 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7582 @end table
7583
7584 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7585 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7586 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7587 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7588 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7589 like:
7590
7591 @lisp
7592 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7593 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7594 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7595 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7596 @end lisp
7597
7598 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7599 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7600 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7601 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7602 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7603 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7604 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7605 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7606 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7607
7608 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7609 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7610 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7611 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7612
7613 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7614 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7615 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7616 name.
7617
7618 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7619 lots of mail groups called things like
7620 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7621 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7622 following will do just that:
7623
7624 @lisp
7625 (defun my-save-name (group)
7626 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7627 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7628
7629 (setq gnus-split-methods
7630 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7631 (my-save-name)))
7632 @end lisp
7633
7634
7635 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7636 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7637 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7638 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7639 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7640 all the files in the top level directory
7641 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7642 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7643 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7644 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7645
7646 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7647 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7648 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7649 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7650 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7651 for kill files.
7652
7653 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7654 a spool, you could
7655
7656 @lisp
7657 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7658 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7659 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7660 @end lisp
7661
7662 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7663 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7664 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7665 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7666
7667
7668 @node Decoding Articles
7669 @section Decoding Articles
7670 @cindex decoding articles
7671
7672 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7673 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7674
7675 @menu
7676 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7677 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7678 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7679 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7680 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7681 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7682 @end menu
7683
7684 @cindex series
7685 @cindex article series
7686 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7687 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7688 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7689 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7690 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7691
7692 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7693 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7694 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7695
7696 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7697 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7698 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7699
7700 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7701 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7702 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7703
7704
7705 @node Uuencoded Articles
7706 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7707 @cindex uudecode
7708 @cindex uuencoded articles
7709
7710 @table @kbd
7711
7712 @item X u
7713 @kindex X u (Summary)
7714 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7715 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7716 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7717
7718 @item X U
7719 @kindex X U (Summary)
7720 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7721 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7722 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7723
7724 @item X v u
7725 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7726 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7727 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7728
7729 @item X v U
7730 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7731 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7732 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7733 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7734
7735 @end table
7736
7737 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7738 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7739 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7740 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7741 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7742
7743 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7744 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7745 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7746 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7747 @kbd{X u}.
7748
7749 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7750 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7751 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7752 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7753 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7754 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7755 off.
7756
7757
7758 @node Shell Archives
7759 @subsection Shell Archives
7760 @cindex unshar
7761 @cindex shell archives
7762 @cindex shared articles
7763
7764 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7765 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7766 some commands to deal with these:
7767
7768 @table @kbd
7769
7770 @item X s
7771 @kindex X s (Summary)
7772 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7773 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7774
7775 @item X S
7776 @kindex X S (Summary)
7777 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7778 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7779
7780 @item X v s
7781 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7782 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7783 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7784
7785 @item X v S
7786 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7787 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7788 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7789 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7790 @end table
7791
7792
7793 @node PostScript Files
7794 @subsection PostScript Files
7795 @cindex PostScript
7796
7797 @table @kbd
7798
7799 @item X p
7800 @kindex X p (Summary)
7801 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7802 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7803
7804 @item X P
7805 @kindex X P (Summary)
7806 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7807 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7808 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7809
7810 @item X v p
7811 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7812 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7813 View the current PostScript series
7814 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7815
7816 @item X v P
7817 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7818 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7819 View and save the current PostScript series
7820 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7821 @end table
7822
7823
7824 @node Other Files
7825 @subsection Other Files
7826
7827 @table @kbd
7828 @item X o
7829 @kindex X o (Summary)
7830 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7831 Save the current series
7832 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7833
7834 @item X b
7835 @kindex X b (Summary)
7836 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7837 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7838 doesn't really work yet.
7839 @end table
7840
7841
7842 @node Decoding Variables
7843 @subsection Decoding Variables
7844
7845 Adjective, not verb.
7846
7847 @menu
7848 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7849 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7850 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7851 @end menu
7852
7853
7854 @node Rule Variables
7855 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7856 @cindex rule variables
7857
7858 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7859 variables are of the form
7860
7861 @lisp
7862 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7863 '(regexp2 command2)
7864 ...)
7865 @end lisp
7866
7867 @table @code
7868
7869 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7870 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7871 @cindex sox
7872 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7873 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7874 say something like:
7875 @lisp
7876 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7877 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7878 @end lisp
7879
7880 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7881 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7882 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7883 user and default view rules.
7884
7885 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7886 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7887 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7888 archives.
7889 @end table
7890
7891
7892 @node Other Decode Variables
7893 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7894
7895 @table @code
7896 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7897
7898 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7899 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7900 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7901 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7902 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7903
7904 @table @code
7905
7906 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7907 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7908 View the file.
7909
7910 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7911 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7912 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7913 @end table
7914
7915 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7916 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7917 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7918 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7919 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7920 time.
7921
7922 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7923 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7924 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7925
7926 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7927 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7928 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7929 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7930 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7931 kludgey.
7932
7933 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7934 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7935 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7936
7937 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7938 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7939 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7940 looking for files to display.
7941
7942 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7943 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7944 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7945 after viewing it.
7946
7947 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7948 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7949 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7950 rules.
7951
7952 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7953 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7954 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7955 unpacking commands.
7956
7957 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7958 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7959 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7960 from articles.
7961
7962 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7963 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7964 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7965 decoded articles as unread.
7966
7967 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7968 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7969 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
7970 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
7971
7972 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7973 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
7974 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
7975
7976 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7977 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
7978 @cindex metamail
7979 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
7980 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
7981 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
7982 @code{metamail} for viewing.
7983
7984 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7985 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
7986 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
7987 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
7988 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
7989 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
7990 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
7991 simply dropped them.
7992
7993 @end table
7994
7995
7996 @node Uuencoding and Posting
7997 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
7998
7999 @table @code
8000
8001 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8002 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8003 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8004 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8005 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8006 for you when you post the article.
8007
8008 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8009 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8010 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8011 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8012
8013 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8014 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8015 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8016 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8017 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8018 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8019 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8020
8021 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8022 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8023 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8024 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8025 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8026 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8027 Default is @code{t}.
8028
8029 @end table
8030
8031
8032 @node Viewing Files
8033 @subsection Viewing Files
8034 @cindex viewing files
8035 @cindex pseudo-articles
8036
8037 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8038 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8039 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8040 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8041 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8042 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8043 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8044
8045 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8046 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8047 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8048 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8049
8050 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8051 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8052 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8053
8054 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8055 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8056 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8057 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8058 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8059
8060 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8061 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8062 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8063 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8064 a list of parameters to that command.
8065
8066 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8067 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8068 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8069
8070 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8071 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8072 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8073
8074
8075 @node Article Treatment
8076 @section Article Treatment
8077
8078 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8079 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8080 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8081 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8082 these articles easier.
8083
8084 @menu
8085 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8086 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8087 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8088 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8089 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8090 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8091 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8092 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8093 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8094 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8095 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8096 @end menu
8097
8098
8099 @node Article Highlighting
8100 @subsection Article Highlighting
8101 @cindex highlighting
8102
8103 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8104 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8105
8106 @table @kbd
8107
8108 @item W H a
8109 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8110 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8111 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8112 Do much highlighting of the current article
8113 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8114 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8115
8116 @item W H h
8117 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8118 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8119 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8120 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8121 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8122 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8123 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8124 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8125 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8126 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8127 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8128 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8129
8130 @item W H c
8131 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8132 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8133 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8134
8135 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8136
8137 @table @code
8138 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8139
8140 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8141 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
8142 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8143
8144 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8145 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8146 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8147
8148 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8149 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8150 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8151 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8152 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8153 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8154
8155 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8156 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8157 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8158
8159 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8160 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8161 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8162
8163 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8164 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8165 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8166 that it's a citation.
8167
8168 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8169 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8170 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8171
8172 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8173 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8174 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8175
8176 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8177 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8178 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8179 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8180
8181 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8182 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8183 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8184 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8185 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8186 is @code{t}.
8187
8188 @end table
8189
8190
8191 @item W H s
8192 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8193 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8194 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8195 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8196 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8197 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8198 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8199 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8200 default.
8201
8202 @end table
8203
8204 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8205
8206
8207 @node Article Fontisizing
8208 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8209 @cindex emphasis
8210 @cindex article emphasis
8211
8212 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8213 @kindex W e (Summary)
8214 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8215 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8216 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8217 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8218
8219 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8220 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8221 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8222 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8223 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8224 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8225 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8226 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8227 highlighting.
8228
8229 @lisp
8230 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8231 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8232 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8233 @end lisp
8234
8235 @cindex slash
8236 @cindex asterisk
8237 @cindex underline
8238 @cindex /
8239 @cindex *
8240
8241 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8242 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8243 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8244 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8245 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8246 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8247 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8248 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8249 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8250 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8251 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8252 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8253 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8254
8255 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8256 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8257 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8258 say something like:
8259
8260 @lisp
8261 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8262 @end lisp
8263
8264 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8265
8266 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8267 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8268 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8269 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8270
8271 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8272
8273
8274 @node Article Hiding
8275 @subsection Article Hiding
8276 @cindex article hiding
8277
8278 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8279 too much cruft in most articles.
8280
8281 @table @kbd
8282
8283 @item W W a
8284 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8285 @findex gnus-article-hide
8286 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8287 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8288 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8289
8290 @item W W h
8291 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8292 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8293 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8294 Headers}.
8295
8296 @item W W b
8297 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8298 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8299 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8300 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8301
8302 @item W W s
8303 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8304 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8305 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8306 Signature}.
8307
8308 @item W W l
8309 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8310 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8311 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8312 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8313 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8314 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8315 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8316 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8317
8318 @table @code
8319
8320 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8321 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8322 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8323 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8324
8325 @end table
8326
8327 @item W W P
8328 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8329 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8330 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8331 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8332
8333 @item W W B
8334 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8335 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8336 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8337 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8338 @cindex banner
8339 @cindex OneList
8340 @cindex stripping advertisements
8341 @cindex advertisements
8342 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8343 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8344 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8345 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8346 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8347 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8348 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8349 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8350 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8351 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8352 used.
8353
8354 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8355 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8356 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8357
8358 @table @code
8359
8360 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8361 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8362 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8363 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8364 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8365 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8366 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8367 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8368 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8369 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8370 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8371
8372 @lisp
8373 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8374 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8375 @end lisp
8376
8377 @end table
8378
8379 @item W W c
8380 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8381 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8382 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8383 customizing the hiding:
8384
8385 @table @code
8386
8387 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8388 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8389 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8390 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8391 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8392 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8393 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8394 specs are valid:
8395
8396 @table @samp
8397 @item b
8398 Starting point of the hidden text.
8399 @item e
8400 Ending point of the hidden text.
8401 @item l
8402 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8403 @item n
8404 Number of lines of hidden text.
8405 @end table
8406
8407 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8408 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8409 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8410 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8411 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8412
8413 @end table
8414
8415 @item W W C-c
8416 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8417 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8418
8419 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8420 following two variables:
8421
8422 @table @code
8423 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8424 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8425 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8426 50), hide the cited text.
8427
8428 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8429 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8430 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8431 is hidden.
8432 @end table
8433
8434 @item W W C
8435 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8436 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8437 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8438 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8439 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8440 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8441
8442 @end table
8443
8444 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8445 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8446 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8447
8448 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8449 citation customization.
8450
8451 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8452 automatically.
8453
8454
8455 @node Article Washing
8456 @subsection Article Washing
8457 @cindex washing
8458 @cindex article washing
8459
8460 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8461 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8462
8463 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8464 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8465 Cleaner, perhaps.
8466
8467 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8468 articles by default.
8469
8470 @table @kbd
8471
8472 @item C-u g
8473 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8474 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8475 the server.
8476
8477 @item g
8478 Force redisplaying of the current article
8479 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8480 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8481 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8482 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8483
8484 @item W l
8485 @kindex W l (Summary)
8486 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8487 Remove page breaks from the current article
8488 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8489 delimiters.
8490
8491 @item W r
8492 @kindex W r (Summary)
8493 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8494 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8495 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8496 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8497 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8498 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8499
8500 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8501 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8502 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8503 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8504
8505 @item W m
8506 @kindex W m (Summary)
8507 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8508 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8509
8510 @item W t
8511 @item t
8512 @kindex W t (Summary)
8513 @kindex t (Summary)
8514 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8515 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8516 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8517
8518 @item W v
8519 @kindex W v (Summary)
8520 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8521 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8522 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8523
8524 @item W o
8525 @kindex W o (Summary)
8526 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8527 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8528
8529 @item W d
8530 @kindex W d (Summary)
8531 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8532 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8533 @cindex Smartquotes
8534 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8535 @cindex Latin 1
8536 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8537 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8538 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8539 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8540 interactively.
8541
8542 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8543 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8544 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8545 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8546
8547 @item W Y f
8548 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8549 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8550 @cindex Outlook Express
8551 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8552 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8553 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8554
8555 @item W Y u
8556 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8557 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8558 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8559 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8560 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8561 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8562 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8563 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8564 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8565 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8566
8567 @item W Y a
8568 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8569 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8570 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8571 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8572
8573 @item W Y c
8574 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8575 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8576 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8577 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8578
8579 @item W w
8580 @kindex W w (Summary)
8581 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8582 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8583
8584 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8585 when filling.
8586
8587 @item W Q
8588 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8589 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8590 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8591
8592 @item W C
8593 @kindex W C (Summary)
8594 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8595 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8596 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8597
8598 @item W c
8599 @kindex W c (Summary)
8600 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8601 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8602 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8603 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8604 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8605
8606 @item W q
8607 @kindex W q (Summary)
8608 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8609 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8610 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8611 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8612 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8613 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8614 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8615 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8616 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8617
8618 @item W 6
8619 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8620 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8621 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8622 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8623 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8624 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8625 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8626 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8627
8628 @item W Z
8629 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8630 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8631 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8632 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8633 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8634
8635 @item W u
8636 @kindex W u (Summary)
8637 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8638 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8639 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8640 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8641 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8642
8643 @item W h
8644 @kindex W h (Summary)
8645 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8646 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8647 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8648 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8649
8650 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
8651 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
8652 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
8653
8654 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8655 The default is to use the function specified by
8656 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8657 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8658 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8659 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8660 can use include:
8661
8662 @table @code
8663 @item w3
8664 Use Emacs/W3.
8665
8666 @item w3m
8667 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8668
8669 @item w3m-standalone
8670 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
8671
8672 @item links
8673 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8674
8675 @item lynx
8676 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8677
8678 @item html2text
8679 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8680
8681 @end table
8682
8683 @item W b
8684 @kindex W b (Summary)
8685 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8686 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8687 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8688
8689 @item W B
8690 @kindex W B (Summary)
8691 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8692 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8693 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8694
8695 @item W p
8696 @kindex W p (Summary)
8697 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8698 Verify a signed control message
8699 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8700 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8701 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8702 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8703 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8704 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8705
8706 @item W s
8707 @kindex W s (Summary)
8708 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8709 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8710 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8711 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8712
8713 @item W a
8714 @kindex W a (Summary)
8715 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8716 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8717 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8718
8719 @item W E l
8720 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8721 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8722 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8723 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8724
8725 @item W E m
8726 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8727 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8728 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8729 lines with a single empty line.
8730 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8731
8732 @item W E t
8733 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8734 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8735 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8736 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8737
8738 @item W E a
8739 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8740 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8741 Do all the three commands above
8742 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8743
8744 @item W E A
8745 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8746 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8747 Remove all blank lines
8748 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8749
8750 @item W E s
8751 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8752 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8753 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8754 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8755
8756 @item W E e
8757 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8758 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8759 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8760 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8761
8762 @end table
8763
8764 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8765
8766
8767 @node Article Header
8768 @subsection Article Header
8769
8770 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8771
8772 @table @kbd
8773
8774 @item W G u
8775 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8776 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8777 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8778
8779 @item W G n
8780 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8781 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8782 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8783 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8784
8785 @item W G f
8786 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8787 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8788 Fold all the message headers
8789 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8790
8791 @item W E w
8792 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8793 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8794 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8795 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8796
8797 @end table
8798
8799
8800 @node Article Buttons
8801 @subsection Article Buttons
8802 @cindex buttons
8803
8804 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8805 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8806 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8807 button on these references.
8808
8809 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8810 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8811 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8812 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8813 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8814
8815 @table @code
8816
8817 @item gnus-button-alist
8818 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8819 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8820
8821 @lisp
8822 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8823 @end lisp
8824
8825 @table @var
8826
8827 @item regexp
8828 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8829 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8830 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8831 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8832 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8833
8834 @item button-par
8835 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8836 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8837 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8838
8839 @item use-p
8840 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8841 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8842 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8843 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8844 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8845
8846 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8847
8848 @item function
8849 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8850
8851 @item data-par
8852 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8853 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8854
8855 @end table
8856
8857 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8858
8859 @lisp
8860 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8861 @end lisp
8862
8863 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8864 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8865 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8866 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8867 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8868
8869 @lisp
8870 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8871 @end lisp
8872
8873 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8874 @end table
8875
8876 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8877
8878 @table @code
8879 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8880 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8881
8882 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8883
8884 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8885 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8886 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8887 default values of the variables above.
8888
8889 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8890
8891 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8892 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8893 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8894 argument with a string naming the man page.
8895
8896 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8897
8898 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8899 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8900 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8901
8902 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8903 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8904 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8905 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8906 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8907 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8908 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8909 @code{ask}, always query the user what do do. If it is a function, this
8910 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8911 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8912 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8913 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8914
8915 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8916 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8917 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8918 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8919 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8920 string is invalid.
8921
8922 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8923 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8924 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8925 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8926
8927 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8928
8929 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8930 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8931 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8932 argument, the string naming the URL.
8933
8934 @item gnus-ctan-url
8935 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8936 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8937 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8938
8939 @c Misc stuff
8940
8941 @item gnus-article-button-face
8942 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8943 Face used on buttons.
8944
8945 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8946 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8947 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8948
8949 @end table
8950
8951 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8952
8953
8954 @node Article Button Levels
8955 @subsection Article button levels
8956 @cindex button levels
8957 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
8958 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
8959 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
8960 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
8961 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
8962 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
8963 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
8964 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
8965
8966 @lisp
8967 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
8968 (setq gnus-parameters
8969 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
8970 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
8971 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
8972 @end lisp
8973
8974 @table @code
8975
8976 @item gnus-button-browse-level
8977 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
8978 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
8979 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
8980 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
8981 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
8982
8983 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
8984 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
8985 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
8986 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
8987 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
8988 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
8989 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
8990 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
8991 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
8992 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
8993 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
8994 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
8995 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
8996
8997 @item gnus-button-man-level
8998 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
8999 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9000 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9001
9002 @item gnus-button-message-level
9003 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9004 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9005 Related variables and functions include
9006 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9007 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9008 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9009 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9010
9011 @item gnus-button-tex-level
9012 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
9013 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
9014 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
9015 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
9016 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
9017 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
9018
9019 @end table
9020
9021
9022 @node Article Date
9023 @subsection Article Date
9024
9025 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9026 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9027 when the article was sent.
9028
9029 @table @kbd
9030
9031 @item W T u
9032 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9033 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9034 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9035 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9036
9037 @item W T i
9038 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9039 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9040 @cindex ISO 8601
9041 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9042 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9043
9044 @item W T l
9045 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9046 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9047 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9048
9049 @item W T p
9050 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9051 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9052 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9053 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9054
9055 @item W T s
9056 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9057 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9058 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9059 @findex format-time-string
9060 Display the date using a user-defined format
9061 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9062 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9063 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9064 for a list of possible format specs.
9065
9066 @item W T e
9067 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9068 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9069 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9070 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9071 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9072 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9073
9074 @example
9075 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9076 @end example
9077
9078 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
9079 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
9080 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
9081 replace it.
9082
9083 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
9084 into wonderful absurdities.
9085
9086 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
9087
9088 @lisp
9089 (gnus-start-date-timer)
9090 @end lisp
9091
9092 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
9093 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9094 command.
9095
9096 @item W T o
9097 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9098 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9099 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9100 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9101 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9102 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9103 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9104
9105 @end table
9106
9107 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9108 preferred format automatically.
9109
9110
9111 @node Article Display
9112 @subsection Article Display
9113 @cindex picons
9114 @cindex x-face
9115 @cindex smileys
9116
9117 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9118 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9119
9120 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9121 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9122
9123 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9124 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9125
9126 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9127 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9128
9129 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9130 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9131
9132 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9133 they'll be removed.
9134
9135 @table @kbd
9136 @item W D x
9137 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9138 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9139 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9140 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9141
9142 @item W D d
9143 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9144 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9145 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9146 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9147
9148 @item W D s
9149 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9150 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9151 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9152
9153 @item W D f
9154 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9155 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9156 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9157
9158 @item W D m
9159 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9160 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9161 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9162 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9163
9164 @item W D n
9165 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9166 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9167 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9168 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9169
9170 @item W D D
9171 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9172 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9173 Remove all images from the article buffer
9174 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9175
9176 @end table
9177
9178
9179
9180 @node Article Signature
9181 @subsection Article Signature
9182 @cindex signatures
9183 @cindex article signature
9184
9185 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9186 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9187 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9188 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9189 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9190 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9191 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9192 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9193 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9194
9195 @lisp
9196 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9197 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9198 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9199 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9200 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9201 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9202 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9203 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9204 @end lisp
9205
9206 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9207 positives.
9208
9209 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9210 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9211 signature when displaying articles.
9212
9213 @enumerate
9214 @item
9215 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9216 that integer.
9217 @item
9218 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9219 than that number.
9220 @item
9221 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9222 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9223 @item
9224 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9225 in question is not a signature.
9226 @end enumerate
9227
9228 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9229 listed above. Here's an example:
9230
9231 @lisp
9232 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9233 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9234 @end lisp
9235
9236 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9237 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9238 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9239 signature after all.
9240
9241
9242 @node Article Miscellanea
9243 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9244
9245 @table @kbd
9246 @item A t
9247 @kindex A t (Summary)
9248 @findex gnus-article-babel
9249 Translate the article from one language to another
9250 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9251
9252 @end table
9253
9254
9255 @node MIME Commands
9256 @section MIME Commands
9257 @cindex MIME decoding
9258 @cindex attachments
9259 @cindex viewing attachments
9260
9261 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9262 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9263
9264 @table @kbd
9265 @item b
9266 @itemx K v
9267 @kindex b (Summary)
9268 @kindex K v (Summary)
9269 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9270
9271 @item K o
9272 @kindex K o (Summary)
9273 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9274
9275 @item K c
9276 @kindex K c (Summary)
9277 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9278
9279 @item K e
9280 @kindex K e (Summary)
9281 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9282
9283 @item K i
9284 @kindex K i (Summary)
9285 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9286
9287 @item K |
9288 @kindex K | (Summary)
9289 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9290 @end table
9291
9292 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9293 the same manner:
9294
9295 @table @kbd
9296 @item K b
9297 @kindex K b (Summary)
9298 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9299 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9300 parts.
9301
9302 @item K m
9303 @kindex K m (Summary)
9304 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9305 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9306 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9307 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9308 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9309
9310 @item X m
9311 @kindex X m (Summary)
9312 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9313 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9314 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9315 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9316
9317 @item M-t
9318 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9319 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9320 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9321 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9322
9323 @item W M w
9324 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9325 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9326 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9327 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9328
9329 @item W M c
9330 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9331 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9332 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9333 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9334
9335 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9336 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9337 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9338 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9339 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9340 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9341
9342 @item W M v
9343 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9344 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9345 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9346 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9347
9348 @end table
9349
9350 Relevant variables:
9351
9352 @table @code
9353 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9354 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9355 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9356 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9357 @code{nil}.
9358
9359 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9360
9361 @lisp
9362 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9363 '("text/x-vcard"))
9364 @end lisp
9365
9366 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9367 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9368 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9369 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9370 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9371 default is @code{nil}.
9372
9373 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9374 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9375 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9376 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9377 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9378 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9379 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}.
9380
9381 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9382 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9383 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9384 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9385 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9386 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9387 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9388 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9389
9390 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9391 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9392 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9393 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9394 displayed. This variable overrides
9395 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9396 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9397 is @code{nil}.
9398
9399 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9400 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9401 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9402
9403 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9404 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9405 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9406 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9407 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9408
9409 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9410 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9411 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9412 default value is @code{nil}.
9413
9414 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9415 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9416 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9417 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9418 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9419 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9420 save all jpegs into some directory).
9421
9422 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9423
9424 @lisp
9425 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9426 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9427 (with-temp-buffer
9428 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9429 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9430 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9431 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9432 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9433 @end lisp
9434
9435 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9436 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9437 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9438
9439 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9440 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9441 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9442
9443 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9444 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9445 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9446
9447 If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9448 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9449 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9450 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9451 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9452
9453 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9454 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9455 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9456 overrides @code{nil} values of
9457 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9458 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9459
9460 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9461 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9462 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9463 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9464
9465 Ready-made functions include@*
9466 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9467 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9468 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9469 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9470 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9471 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9472 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9473 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9474 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9475 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9476 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9477 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9478
9479 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9480 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9481
9482 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9483 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9484 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9485
9486 @lisp
9487 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9488 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9489 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9490 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9491 @end lisp
9492
9493 @noindent
9494 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9495
9496 @end table
9497
9498
9499 @node Charsets
9500 @section Charsets
9501 @cindex charsets
9502
9503 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9504 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9505 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9506 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9507 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9508 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9509 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9510
9511 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9512 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9513 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9514 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9515
9516 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9517 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9518 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9519 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9520 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9521 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9522 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9523 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9524 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9525
9526 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9527 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9528 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9529 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9530 quoted-printable header encoding.
9531
9532 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9533 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9534 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9535
9536 @table @var
9537 @item test
9538 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9539 variable to query,
9540 @item header
9541 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9542 means encode all charsets),
9543 @item body-list
9544 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9545 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9546 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9547 @end table
9548
9549 @cindex Russian
9550 @cindex koi8-r
9551 @cindex koi8-u
9552 @cindex iso-8859-5
9553 @cindex coding system aliases
9554 @cindex preferred charset
9555
9556 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9557 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9558 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9559
9560 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9561
9562 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9563 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9564
9565 @lisp
9566 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9567 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9568 @end lisp
9569
9570 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9571 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9572
9573 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9574
9575 @lisp
9576 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9577 @end lisp
9578
9579 This will almost do the right thing.
9580
9581 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9582 something like
9583
9584 @lisp
9585 (codepage-setup 1251)
9586 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9587 @end lisp
9588
9589
9590 @node Article Commands
9591 @section Article Commands
9592
9593 @table @kbd
9594
9595 @item A P
9596 @cindex PostScript
9597 @cindex printing
9598 @kindex A P (Summary)
9599 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9600 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9601 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9602 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9603 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9604 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9605
9606 @end table
9607
9608
9609 @node Summary Sorting
9610 @section Summary Sorting
9611 @cindex summary sorting
9612
9613 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9614 can't really see why you'd want that.
9615
9616 @table @kbd
9617
9618 @item C-c C-s C-n
9619 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9620 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9621 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9622
9623 @item C-c C-s C-a
9624 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9625 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9626 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9627
9628 @item C-c C-s C-s
9629 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9630 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9631 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9632
9633 @item C-c C-s C-d
9634 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9635 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9636 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9637
9638 @item C-c C-s C-l
9639 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9640 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9641 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9642
9643 @item C-c C-s C-c
9644 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9645 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9646 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9647
9648 @item C-c C-s C-i
9649 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9650 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9651 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9652
9653 @item C-c C-s C-r
9654 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9655 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9656 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9657
9658 @item C-c C-s C-o
9659 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9660 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9661 Sort using the default sorting method
9662 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9663 @end table
9664
9665 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9666 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9667 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9668 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9669 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9670 Commands}).
9671
9672
9673 @node Finding the Parent
9674 @section Finding the Parent
9675 @cindex parent articles
9676 @cindex referring articles
9677
9678 @table @kbd
9679 @item ^
9680 @kindex ^ (Summary)
9681 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9682 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9683 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9684 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9685 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9686 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9687 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9688 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9689 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9690
9691 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9692 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9693 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9694 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9695 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9696 article.
9697
9698 @item A R (Summary)
9699 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9700 @kindex A R (Summary)
9701 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9702 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9703
9704 @item A T (Summary)
9705 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9706 @kindex A T (Summary)
9707 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9708 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9709 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9710 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9711 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9712 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9713 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9714
9715 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9716 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9717 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9718 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9719 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9720 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9721
9722 @item M-^ (Summary)
9723 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9724 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9725 @cindex Message-ID
9726 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9727 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
9728 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
9729 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
9730 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
9731 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9732
9733 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
9734 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
9735 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
9736 @end table
9737
9738 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9739 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9740 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9741 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9742 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9743 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9744 necessary.
9745
9746 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9747 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9748 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9749 match.
9750
9751 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9752 then ask Google if that fails:
9753
9754 @lisp
9755 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9756 '(current
9757 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9758 @end lisp
9759
9760 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9761 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9762 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9763 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9764 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9765 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9766 not support this at all.
9767
9768
9769 @node Alternative Approaches
9770 @section Alternative Approaches
9771
9772 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9773 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9774
9775 @menu
9776 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9777 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9778 @end menu
9779
9780
9781 @node Pick and Read
9782 @subsection Pick and Read
9783 @cindex pick and read
9784
9785 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9786 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9787 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9788 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9789
9790 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9791 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9792 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9793 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9794 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9795 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9796
9797 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9798
9799 @table @kbd
9800 @item .
9801 @kindex . (Pick)
9802 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9803 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9804 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9805 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9806 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9807 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9808 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9809 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9810
9811 @item SPACE
9812 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9813 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9814 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9815 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9816
9817 @item u
9818 @kindex u (Pick)
9819 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9820 Unpick the thread or article
9821 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9822 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9823 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9824 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9825 the thread or article at that line.
9826
9827 @item RET
9828 @kindex RET (Pick)
9829 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9830 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9831 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9832 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9833 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9834 will still be visible when you are reading.
9835
9836 @end table
9837
9838 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9839 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9840 which is mapped to the same function
9841 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9842
9843 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9844
9845 @lisp
9846 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9847 @end lisp
9848
9849 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9850 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9851
9852 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9853 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9854 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9855
9856 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9857 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9858 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9859 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9860 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9861 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9862 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9863
9864
9865 @node Binary Groups
9866 @subsection Binary Groups
9867 @cindex binary groups
9868
9869 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9870 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9871 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9872 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9873 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9874 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9875 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9876
9877 @kindex g (Binary)
9878 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9879 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9880 command, when you have turned on this mode
9881 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9882
9883 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9884 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9885
9886
9887 @node Tree Display
9888 @section Tree Display
9889 @cindex trees
9890
9891 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9892 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9893 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9894 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9895 in the tree buffer.
9896
9897 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9898
9899 @table @code
9900 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9901 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9902 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9903
9904 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9905 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9906 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9907 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9908 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9909
9910 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9911 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9912 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9913 default is @code{modeline}.
9914
9915 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9916 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9917 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9918 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9919 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9920 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9921 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9922
9923 Valid specs are:
9924
9925 @table @samp
9926 @item n
9927 The name of the poster.
9928 @item f
9929 The @code{From} header.
9930 @item N
9931 The number of the article.
9932 @item [
9933 The opening bracket.
9934 @item ]
9935 The closing bracket.
9936 @item s
9937 The subject.
9938 @end table
9939
9940 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9941
9942 Variables related to the display are:
9943
9944 @table @code
9945 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9946 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9947 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9948 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
9949 @example
9950 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9951 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
9952 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
9953 @end example
9954 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9955
9956 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9957 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9958 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9959 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9960
9961 @end table
9962
9963 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9964 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9965 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
9966 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
9967 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
9968 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
9969 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
9970 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
9971 other windows displayed next to it.
9972
9973 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
9974 at all times:
9975
9976 @lisp
9977 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
9978 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
9979 @end lisp
9980
9981 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
9982 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
9983 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
9984 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
9985 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
9986 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
9987 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
9988
9989 @end table
9990
9991 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
9992
9993 @example
9994 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
9995 | \[Jan]
9996 | \[odd]-[Eri]
9997 | \(***)-[Eri]
9998 | \[odd]-[Paa]
9999 \[Bjo]
10000 \[Gun]
10001 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10002 @end example
10003
10004 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10005
10006 @example
10007 @group
10008 @{***@}
10009 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10010 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10011 |--\-----\-----\ |
10012 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10013 | | |--\
10014 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10015 |
10016 [Paa]
10017 @end group
10018 @end example
10019
10020 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10021 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10022 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10023
10024 @lisp
10025 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10026 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10027 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10028 (gnus-add-configuration
10029 '(article
10030 (vertical 1.0
10031 (horizontal 0.25
10032 (summary 0.75 point)
10033 (tree 1.0))
10034 (article 1.0))))
10035 @end lisp
10036
10037 @xref{Window Layout}.
10038
10039
10040 @node Mail Group Commands
10041 @section Mail Group Commands
10042 @cindex mail group commands
10043
10044 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10045 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10046
10047 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10048 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10049
10050 @table @kbd
10051
10052 @item B e
10053 @kindex B e (Summary)
10054 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10055 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10056 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10057 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10058 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10059
10060 @item B C-M-e
10061 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10062 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10063 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10064 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10065 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10066 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10067
10068 @item B DEL
10069 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10070 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10071 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10072 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10073 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10074 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10075
10076 @item B m
10077 @kindex B m (Summary)
10078 @cindex move mail
10079 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10080 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10081 Move the article from one mail group to another
10082 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10083 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10084
10085 @item B c
10086 @kindex B c (Summary)
10087 @cindex copy mail
10088 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10089 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10090 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10091 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10092 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10093
10094 @item B B
10095 @kindex B B (Summary)
10096 @cindex crosspost mail
10097 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10098 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10099 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10100 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10101 be properly updated.
10102
10103 @item B i
10104 @kindex B i (Summary)
10105 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10106 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10107 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10108 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10109
10110 @item B I
10111 @kindex B I (Summary)
10112 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10113 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10114 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10115 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10116
10117 @item B r
10118 @kindex B r (Summary)
10119 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10120 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10121 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10122 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10123 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10124 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10125 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10126 (which is the default).
10127
10128 @item B w
10129 @itemx e
10130 @kindex B w (Summary)
10131 @kindex e (Summary)
10132 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10133 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10134 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10135 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10136 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10137 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10138 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10139
10140 @item B q
10141 @kindex B q (Summary)
10142 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10143 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10144 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10145 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10146
10147 @item B t
10148 @kindex B t (Summary)
10149 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10150 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10151 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10152
10153 @item B p
10154 @kindex B p (Summary)
10155 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10156 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10157 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10158 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10159 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10160 article from your news server (or rather, from
10161 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10162 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10163 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10164 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10165 just not have arrived yet.
10166
10167 @item K E
10168 @kindex K E (Summary)
10169 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10170 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10171 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10172 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10173 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10174
10175 @end table
10176
10177 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10178 @cindex moving articles
10179 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10180 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10181 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10182 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10183 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10184 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10185 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10186
10187 @lisp
10188 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10189 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10190 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10191 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10192 @end lisp
10193
10194
10195 @node Various Summary Stuff
10196 @section Various Summary Stuff
10197
10198 @menu
10199 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10200 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10201 * Summary Generation Commands::
10202 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10203 @end menu
10204
10205 @table @code
10206 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10207 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10208 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10209 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10210 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10211 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10212
10213 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10214 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10215 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10216 current article.
10217
10218 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10219 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10220 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10221
10222 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10223 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10224 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10225 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10226 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10227 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10228 have been set.
10229
10230 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10231 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10232 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10233 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10234 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10235
10236 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10237 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10238 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10239 generated.
10240
10241 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10242 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10243 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10244 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10245 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10246 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10247 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10248 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10249 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10250 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10251
10252 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10253 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10254 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10255 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10256 list of articles to be selected.
10257
10258 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10259 the list in one particular group:
10260
10261 @lisp
10262 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10263 (if (string= group "some.group")
10264 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10265 articles))
10266 @end lisp
10267
10268 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10269 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10270 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10271 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10272 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10273 buffer is active.
10274
10275 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10276 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10277 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10278 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10279 variable will be used instead.
10280
10281 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10282 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10283 buffers. For example:
10284
10285 @lisp
10286 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10287 '(message-use-followup-to
10288 (gnus-visible-headers .
10289 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10290 @end lisp
10291
10292 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10293 @end table
10294
10295
10296 @node Summary Group Information
10297 @subsection Summary Group Information
10298
10299 @table @kbd
10300
10301 @item H f
10302 @kindex H f (Summary)
10303 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10304 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10305 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10306 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10307 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10308 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10309 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10310 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10311 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10312
10313 @item H d
10314 @kindex H d (Summary)
10315 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10316 Give a brief description of the current group
10317 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10318 rereading the description from the server.
10319
10320 @item H h
10321 @kindex H h (Summary)
10322 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10323 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10324 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10325
10326 @item H i
10327 @kindex H i (Summary)
10328 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10329 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10330 @end table
10331
10332
10333 @node Searching for Articles
10334 @subsection Searching for Articles
10335
10336 @table @kbd
10337
10338 @item M-s
10339 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10340 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10341 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10342 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10343
10344 @item M-r
10345 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10346 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10347 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10348 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10349
10350 @item &
10351 @kindex & (Summary)
10352 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10353 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10354 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10355 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10356 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10357 search backward instead.
10358
10359 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10360 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10361
10362 @item M-&
10363 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10364 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10365 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10366 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10367 @end table
10368
10369 @node Summary Generation Commands
10370 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10371
10372 @table @kbd
10373
10374 @item Y g
10375 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10376 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10377 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10378
10379 @item Y c
10380 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10381 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10382 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10383 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10384
10385 @item Y d
10386 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10387 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10388 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10389 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10390
10391 @end table
10392
10393
10394 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10395 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10396
10397 @table @kbd
10398
10399 @item A D
10400 @itemx C-d
10401 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10402 @kindex A D (Summary)
10403 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10404 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10405 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10406 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10407 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10408 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10409 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10410 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10411 fashion.
10412
10413 @item C-M-d
10414 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10415 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10416 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10417 several documents into one biiig group
10418 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10419 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10420 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10421 command understands the process/prefix convention
10422 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10423
10424 @item C-t
10425 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10426 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10427 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10428 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10429 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10430 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10431
10432 @item =
10433 @kindex = (Summary)
10434 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10435 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10436 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10437
10438 @item C-M-e
10439 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10440 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10441 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10442 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10443
10444 @item C-M-a
10445 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10446 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10447 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10448 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10449
10450 @end table
10451
10452
10453 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10454 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10455 @cindex summary exit
10456 @cindex exiting groups
10457
10458 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10459 group and return you to the group buffer.
10460
10461 @table @kbd
10462
10463 @item Z Z
10464 @itemx Z Q
10465 @itemx q
10466 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10467 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10468 @kindex q (Summary)
10469 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10470 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10471 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10472 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10473 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10474 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10475 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10476 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10477 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10478 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10479 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10480 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10481
10482 @item Z E
10483 @itemx Q
10484 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10485 @kindex Q (Summary)
10486 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10487 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10488 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10489
10490 @item Z c
10491 @itemx c
10492 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10493 @kindex c (Summary)
10494 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10495 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10496 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10497 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10498
10499 @item Z C
10500 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10501 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10502 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10503 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10504
10505 @item Z n
10506 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10507 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10508 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10509 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10510
10511 @item Z R
10512 @itemx C-x C-s
10513 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10514 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10515 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10516 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10517 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10518 all articles, both read and unread.
10519
10520 @item Z G
10521 @itemx M-g
10522 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10523 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10524 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10525 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10526 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10527 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10528 articles, both read and unread.
10529
10530 @item Z N
10531 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10532 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10533 Exit the group and go to the next group
10534 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10535
10536 @item Z P
10537 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10538 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10539 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10540 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10541
10542 @item Z s
10543 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10544 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10545 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10546 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10547 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10548 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10549 @end table
10550
10551 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10552 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10553 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10554 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10555
10556 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10557 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10558 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10559 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10560 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10561 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10562 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10563 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10564 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10565 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10566 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10567 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10568
10569 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10570
10571 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10572 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10573 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10574 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10575 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10576 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10577 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10578 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10579 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10580
10581
10582 @node Crosspost Handling
10583 @section Crosspost Handling
10584
10585 @cindex velveeta
10586 @cindex spamming
10587 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10588 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10589 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10590 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10591 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10592 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10593 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
10594
10595 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10596 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10597 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10598 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10599 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10600
10601 @cindex cross-posting
10602 @cindex Xref
10603 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10604 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10605 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10606 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10607 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10608 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10609 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10610 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10611 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10612 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10613 the cross reference mechanism.
10614
10615 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10616 @cindex overview.fmt
10617 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10618 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10619 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10620 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10621 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10622 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10623 overview files.
10624
10625 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
10626 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10627 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10628 considerably.
10629
10630 C'est la vie.
10631
10632 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10633
10634
10635 @node Duplicate Suppression
10636 @section Duplicate Suppression
10637
10638 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10639 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10640 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10641 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10642 reasons.
10643
10644 @enumerate
10645 @item
10646 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10647 is evil and not very common.
10648
10649 @item
10650 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10651 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10652
10653 @item
10654 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10655 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10656
10657 @item
10658 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10659 @end enumerate
10660
10661 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10662 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10663
10664 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10665 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10666 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10667 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10668 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10669 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10670 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10671 once.
10672
10673 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10674 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10675 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10676 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10677 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10678 saw the article in.
10679
10680 @table @code
10681 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10682 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10683 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10684
10685 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10686 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10687 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10688 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10689 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10690 session are suppressed.
10691
10692 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10693 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10694 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10695 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10696
10697 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10698 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10699 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10700 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10701 @end table
10702
10703 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10704 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10705 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10706 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10707 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10708 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10709 to you to figure out, I think.
10710
10711 @node Security
10712 @section Security
10713
10714 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10715 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10716 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10717 things to work:
10718
10719 @enumerate
10720 @item
10721 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10722 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10723 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10724 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10725
10726 @item
10727 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10728 or newer is recommended.
10729
10730 @end enumerate
10731
10732 The variables that control security functionality on reading messages
10733 include:
10734
10735 @table @code
10736 @item mm-verify-option
10737 @vindex mm-verify-option
10738 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10739 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10740 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10741
10742 @item mm-decrypt-option
10743 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10744 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10745 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10746 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10747
10748 @item mml1991-use
10749 @vindex mml1991-use
10750 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10751 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10752 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10753 deprecated.
10754
10755 @item mml2015-use
10756 @vindex mml2015-use
10757 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10758 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10759 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10760 deprecated.
10761
10762 @end table
10763
10764 By default the buttons that display security information are not
10765 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
10766 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
10767 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
10768 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
10769 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
10770 how to customize these variables to always display security
10771 information.
10772
10773 @cindex snarfing keys
10774 @cindex importing PGP keys
10775 @cindex PGP key ring import
10776 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10777 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10778 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10779 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10780 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10781 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10782 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10783 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10784 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10785
10786 @example
10787 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10788 @end example
10789 @noindent
10790 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10791 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10792
10793 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
10794 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
10795 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10796
10797 @node Mailing List
10798 @section Mailing List
10799 @cindex mailing list
10800 @cindex RFC 2396
10801
10802 @kindex A M (summary)
10803 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10804 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10805 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10806 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10807 summary buffer.
10808
10809 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10810
10811 @table @kbd
10812
10813 @item C-c C-n h
10814 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10815 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10816 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10817
10818 @item C-c C-n s
10819 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10820 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10821 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10822
10823 @item C-c C-n u
10824 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10825 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10826 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10827 field exists.
10828
10829 @item C-c C-n p
10830 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10831 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10832 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10833
10834 @item C-c C-n o
10835 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10836 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10837 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10838
10839 @item C-c C-n a
10840 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10841 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10842 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10843
10844 @end table
10845
10846
10847 @node Article Buffer
10848 @chapter Article Buffer
10849 @cindex article buffer
10850
10851 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10852 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10853 tell Gnus otherwise.
10854
10855 @menu
10856 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10857 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10858 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10859 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10860 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10861 @end menu
10862
10863
10864 @node Hiding Headers
10865 @section Hiding Headers
10866 @cindex hiding headers
10867 @cindex deleting headers
10868
10869 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10870 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10871
10872 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10873 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10874 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10875 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10876 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10877 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10878 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10879 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10880 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10881
10882 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10883
10884 @table @code
10885
10886 @item gnus-visible-headers
10887 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10888 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10889 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10890 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10891
10892 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10893 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10894
10895 @lisp
10896 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10897 @end lisp
10898
10899 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10900 remain visible.
10901
10902 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10903 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10904 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10905 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10906 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10907 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10908
10909 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10910 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10911
10912 @lisp
10913 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10914 @end lisp
10915
10916 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10917 be removed.
10918
10919 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10920 variable will have no effect.
10921
10922 @end table
10923
10924 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10925 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10926 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10927 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10928 the headers are to be displayed.
10929
10930 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10931 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10932
10933 @lisp
10934 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10935 @end lisp
10936
10937 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10938 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10939
10940 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10941 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10942 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10943 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10944 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10945 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10946 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10947 from sight.
10948
10949 These conditions are:
10950 @table @code
10951 @item empty
10952 Remove all empty headers.
10953 @item followup-to
10954 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10955 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10956 @item reply-to
10957 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
10958 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
10959 parameter is set.
10960 @item newsgroups
10961 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10962 name.
10963 @item to-address
10964 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10965 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
10966 @item to-list
10967 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
10968 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10969 @item cc-list
10970 Remove the @code{CC} header if it only contains the address identical to
10971 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
10972 @item date
10973 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
10974 old.
10975 @item long-to
10976 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
10977 @item many-to
10978 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
10979 @end table
10980
10981 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
10982
10983 @lisp
10984 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
10985 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
10986 @end lisp
10987
10988 This is also the default value for this variable.
10989
10990
10991 @node Using MIME
10992 @section Using MIME
10993 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
10994
10995 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
10996 while people stand around yawning.
10997
10998 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
10999 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11000
11001 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11002 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11003 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11004
11005 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11006 @findex gnus-display-mime
11007 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11008 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11009 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11010 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11011
11012 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11013 @acronym{MIME} button:
11014
11015 @table @kbd
11016 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11017 @item RET (Article)
11018 @kindex RET (Article)
11019 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11020 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11021 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11022 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11023 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11024 object is displayed inline.
11025
11026 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11027 @item M-RET (Article)
11028 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11029 @itemx v (Article)
11030 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11031 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11032
11033 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11034 @item t (Article)
11035 @kindex t (Article)
11036 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11037 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11038
11039 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11040 @item C (Article)
11041 @kindex C (Article)
11042 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11043 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11044
11045 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11046 @item o (Article)
11047 @kindex o (Article)
11048 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11049 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11050
11051 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11052 @item C-o (Article)
11053 @kindex C-o (Article)
11054 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11055 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11056 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11057 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11058 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11059 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11060
11061 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11062 @item d (Article)
11063 @kindex d (Article)
11064 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11065 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11066 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11067
11068 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11069 @item c (Article)
11070 @kindex c (Article)
11071 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11072 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11073 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11074 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11075 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11076
11077 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11078 @item p (Article)
11079 @kindex p (Article)
11080 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11081 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11082 @file{.mailcap} file.
11083
11084 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11085 @item i (Article)
11086 @kindex i (Article)
11087 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11088 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
11089 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11090 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11091 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11092 Article}).
11093
11094 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11095 @item E (Article)
11096 @kindex E (Article)
11097 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11098 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11099 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11100
11101 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11102 @item e (Article)
11103 @kindex e (Article)
11104 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11105 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11106
11107 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11108 @item | (Article)
11109 @kindex | (Article)
11110 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11111
11112 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11113 @item . (Article)
11114 @kindex . (Article)
11115 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11116 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11117
11118 @end table
11119
11120 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11121 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11122 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11123
11124 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11125 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11126 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11127 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11128 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11129 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11130 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11131 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11132 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11133
11134 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11135
11136 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11137
11138
11139 @node Customizing Articles
11140 @section Customizing Articles
11141 @cindex article customization
11142
11143 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11144 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11145 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11146 called automatically when you select the articles.
11147
11148 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11149 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11150 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11151 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11152
11153 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11154 for sensible values.
11155
11156 @enumerate
11157 @item
11158 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11159
11160 @item
11161 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11162
11163 @item
11164 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11165
11166 @item
11167 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11168
11169 @item
11170 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11171 than this number.
11172
11173 @item
11174 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11175 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11176 regexps in the list.
11177
11178 @item
11179 A list where the first element is not a string:
11180
11181 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11182 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11183 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11184
11185 @lisp
11186 (or last
11187 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11188 @end lisp
11189
11190 @end enumerate
11191
11192 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11193 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11194 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11195 considered to contain just a single part.
11196
11197 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11198 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11199 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11200 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11201 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11202 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11203 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11204
11205 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11206 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11207 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11208 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11209
11210 @table @code
11211 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11212 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11213
11214 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11215
11216 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11217 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11218 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11219 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11220 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11221 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11222 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11223 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11224 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11225 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11226
11227 @xref{Article Washing}.
11228
11229 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11230 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11231 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11232 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11233 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11234 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11235 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11236
11237 @xref{Article Date}.
11238
11239 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11240 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11241 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11242
11243 @xref{Picons}.
11244
11245 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11246
11247 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11248
11249 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11250 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11251 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11252
11253 @xref{Smileys}.
11254
11255 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11256
11257 @xref{X-Face}.
11258
11259 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11260
11261 @xref{Face}.
11262
11263 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11264 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11265 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11266 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11267 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11268 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11269 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11270 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11271 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11272 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11273
11274 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11275
11276 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11277 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11278 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11279
11280 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11281
11282 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11283 @item gnus-treat-translate
11284 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11285
11286 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11287 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11288 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11289 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11290
11291 @xref{Article Header}.
11292
11293
11294 @end table
11295
11296 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11297 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11298 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11299 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11300 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11301 everything.
11302
11303
11304 @node Article Keymap
11305 @section Article Keymap
11306
11307 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11308 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11309 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11310 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11311 buffer.
11312
11313 @kindex v (Article)
11314 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
11315 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it key to some
11316 function or better use it as a prefix key.
11317
11318 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11319
11320 @table @kbd
11321
11322 @item SPACE
11323 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11324 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11325 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11326 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11327
11328 @item DEL
11329 @kindex DEL (Article)
11330 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11331 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11332 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11333
11334 @item C-c ^
11335 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11336 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11337 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11338 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11339 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11340
11341 @item C-c C-m
11342 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11343 @findex gnus-article-mail
11344 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11345 given a prefix, include the mail.
11346
11347 @item s
11348 @kindex s (Article)
11349 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11350 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11351 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11352
11353 @item ?
11354 @kindex ? (Article)
11355 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11356 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11357 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11358
11359 @item TAB
11360 @kindex TAB (Article)
11361 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11362 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11363 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11364
11365 @item M-TAB
11366 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11367 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11368 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11369
11370 @item R
11371 @kindex R (Article)
11372 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11373 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11374 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11375 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11376 region.
11377
11378 @item F
11379 @kindex F (Article)
11380 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11381 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11382 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11383 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11384 region.
11385
11386
11387 @end table
11388
11389
11390 @node Misc Article
11391 @section Misc Article
11392
11393 @table @code
11394
11395 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11396 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11397 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11398 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11399 article buffer.
11400
11401 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11402 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11403 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11404 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11405 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11406
11407 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11408 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11409 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11410 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11411 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11412 the contents of the article buffer.
11413
11414 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11415 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11416 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11417
11418 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11419 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11420 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11421 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11422
11423 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11424 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11425 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11426 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11427
11428 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11429 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11430 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11431 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11432 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11433 with two extensions:
11434
11435 @table @samp
11436
11437 @item w
11438 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11439 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11440 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11441
11442 @table @samp
11443
11444 @item c
11445 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11446
11447 @item h
11448 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11449
11450 @item p
11451 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11452 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11453 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11454
11455 @item s
11456 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11457
11458 @item o
11459 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11460
11461 @item e
11462 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11463
11464 @end table
11465
11466 @item m
11467 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11468
11469 @end table
11470
11471 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11472
11473 @item gnus-break-pages
11474 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11475 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11476 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11477 paging will not be done.
11478
11479 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11480 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11481 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11482 (formfeed).
11483
11484 @cindex IDNA
11485 @cindex internationalized domain names
11486 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11487 @item gnus-use-idna
11488 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11489 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11490 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11491 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11492 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11493
11494 @end table
11495
11496
11497 @node Composing Messages
11498 @chapter Composing Messages
11499 @cindex composing messages
11500 @cindex messages
11501 @cindex mail
11502 @cindex sending mail
11503 @cindex reply
11504 @cindex followup
11505 @cindex post
11506 @cindex using gpg
11507 @cindex using s/mime
11508 @cindex using smime
11509
11510 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11511 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11512 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11513 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11514 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11515 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11516
11517 @menu
11518 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11519 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11520 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11521 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11522 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11523 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11524 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11525 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11526 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11527 @end menu
11528
11529 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11530 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11531
11532
11533 @node Mail
11534 @section Mail
11535
11536 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11537
11538 @table @code
11539 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11540 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11541 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11542 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11543 @code{nil} include all headers.
11544
11545 @item gnus-add-to-list
11546 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11547 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11548 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11549
11550 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11551 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11552 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
11553 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
11554 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
11555 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
11556 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
11557 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
11558
11559 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11560 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
11561
11562 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11563 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11564 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11565 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11566 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11567
11568 @end table
11569
11570
11571 @node Posting Server
11572 @section Posting Server
11573
11574 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11575 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11576
11577 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11578
11579 It can be quite complicated.
11580
11581 @vindex gnus-post-method
11582 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11583 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11584 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11585 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11586 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11587 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11588 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11589 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11590 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11591
11592 @lisp
11593 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11594 @end lisp
11595
11596 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11597 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11598 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11599 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11600
11601 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11602 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11603
11604 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11605 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11606 for posting.
11607
11608 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11609 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11610
11611 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11612 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11613 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11614 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11615 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11616 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11617 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11618 package correctly. An example:
11619
11620 @lisp
11621 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11622 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11623 @end lisp
11624
11625 To the thing similar to this, there is
11626 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11627 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11628 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11629
11630 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11631 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11632 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11633
11634 @node POP before SMTP
11635 @section POP before SMTP
11636 @cindex pop before smtp
11637 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11638 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11639
11640 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11641 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11642 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11643 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11644 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11645
11646 @lisp
11647 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11648 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11649 @end lisp
11650
11651 @noindent
11652 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11653 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11654 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11655 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11656 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11657 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11658 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11659 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11660
11661 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11662 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11663 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11664 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11665 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11666 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11667
11668 @lisp
11669 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11670 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11671 :password "secret"))
11672 @end lisp
11673
11674 @noindent
11675 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11676 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11677
11678 @lisp
11679 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11680 (lambda ()
11681 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11682 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11683 :password "secret")))
11684 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11685 @end lisp
11686
11687 @node Mail and Post
11688 @section Mail and Post
11689
11690 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11691 posting:
11692
11693 @table @code
11694 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11695 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11696 @cindex mailing lists
11697
11698 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11699 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11700 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11701 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11702 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11703 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11704 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11705 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11706 still a pain, though.
11707
11708 @item gnus-user-agent
11709 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11710 @cindex User-Agent
11711
11712 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11713 User-Agent header. It can be one of the symbols @code{gnus} (show only
11714 Gnus version), @code{emacs-gnus} (show only Emacs and Gnus versions),
11715 @code{emacs-gnus-config} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus system
11716 configuration), @code{emacs-gnus-type} (same as @code{emacs-gnus} plus
11717 system type) or a custom string. If you set it to a string, be sure to
11718 use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11719
11720 @end table
11721
11722 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11723 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11724 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11725
11726 @cindex ispell
11727 @findex ispell-message
11728 @lisp
11729 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11730 @end lisp
11731
11732 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11733 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11734
11735 @lisp
11736 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11737 (lambda ()
11738 (cond
11739 ((string-match
11740 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11741 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11742 (t
11743 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11744 @end lisp
11745
11746 Modify to suit your needs.
11747
11748
11749 @node Archived Messages
11750 @section Archived Messages
11751 @cindex archived messages
11752 @cindex sent messages
11753
11754 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11755 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11756 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11757 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11758 is the default.
11759
11760 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11761 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11762 Group Commands}).
11763
11764 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11765 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11766 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11767
11768 @lisp
11769 (nnfolder "archive"
11770 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11771 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11772 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11773 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11774 @end lisp
11775
11776 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11777 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11778 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11779 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11780
11781 @lisp
11782 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11783 '(nnfolder "archive"
11784 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11785 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11786 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11787 @end lisp
11788
11789 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11790 @cindex Gcc
11791 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11792 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11793 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11794
11795 This variable can be used to do the following:
11796
11797 @table @asis
11798 @item a string
11799 Messages will be saved in that group.
11800
11801 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11802 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11803 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11804 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11805 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11806 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11807 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11808 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11809 @samp{nnml:foo}.
11810
11811 @item a list of strings
11812 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11813
11814 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11815 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11816
11817 @item @code{nil}
11818 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11819 @end table
11820
11821 Let's illustrate:
11822
11823 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11824 @lisp
11825 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11826 @end lisp
11827
11828 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11829 @lisp
11830 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11831 @end lisp
11832
11833 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11834 @lisp
11835 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11836 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11837 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11838 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11839 @end lisp
11840
11841 More complex stuff:
11842 @lisp
11843 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11844 '((if (message-news-p)
11845 "misc-news"
11846 "misc-mail")))
11847 @end lisp
11848
11849 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11850 messages in one file per month:
11851
11852 @lisp
11853 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11854 '((if (message-news-p)
11855 "misc-news"
11856 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11857 @end lisp
11858
11859 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11860 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11861
11862 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11863 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11864 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11865 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11866 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11867 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11868 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11869 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11870 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11871 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
11872
11873 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
11874 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
11875 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
11876 this will disable archiving.
11877
11878 @table @code
11879 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
11880 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
11881 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
11882 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
11883 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
11884 group names.
11885
11886 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
11887 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
11888 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
11889 of names).
11890
11891 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
11892 but the latter is the preferred method.
11893
11894 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11895 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
11896 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
11897
11898 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11899 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
11900 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
11901 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
11902 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
11903 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
11904 changed in the future.
11905
11906 @end table
11907
11908
11909 @node Posting Styles
11910 @section Posting Styles
11911 @cindex posting styles
11912 @cindex styles
11913
11914 All them variables, they make my head swim.
11915
11916 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
11917 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
11918 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
11919 on?
11920
11921 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
11922 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
11923 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
11924 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
11925 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
11926 variable:
11927
11928 @lisp
11929 ((".*"
11930 (signature "Peace and happiness")
11931 (organization "What me?"))
11932 ("^comp"
11933 (signature "Death to everybody"))
11934 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
11935 (organization "Emacs is it")))
11936 @end lisp
11937
11938 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
11939 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
11940 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
11941 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
11942 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
11943 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
11944 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
11945 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
11946
11947 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
11948 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
11949 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
11950 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
11951 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
11952 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
11953 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
11954 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
11955 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
11956 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
11957 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
11958 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
11959 said to @dfn{match}.
11960
11961 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
11962 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
11963 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
11964 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
11965 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
11966 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
11967 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
11968 name can be one of:
11969
11970 @itemize @bullet
11971 @item @code{signature}
11972 @item @code{signature-file}
11973 @item @code{x-face-file}
11974 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
11975 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
11976 @item @code{body}
11977 @end itemize
11978
11979 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
11980 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
11981 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
11982 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
11983 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
11984
11985 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
11986 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
11987 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
11988 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
11989 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
11990 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
11991 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
11992 references chars lines xref extra.
11993
11994 @vindex message-reply-headers
11995
11996 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
11997 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
11998 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
11999
12000 @findex message-mail-p
12001 @findex message-news-p
12002
12003 So here's a new example:
12004
12005 @lisp
12006 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12007 '((".*"
12008 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12009 (name "User Name")
12010 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12011 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12012 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12013 ("^rec.humor"
12014 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12015 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12016 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12017 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12018 (signature my-news-signature))
12019 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12020 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12021 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12022 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12023 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12024 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12025 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12026 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12027 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12028 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12029 ("nnml:.*"
12030 (From (save-excursion
12031 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
12032 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12033 ("^nn.+:"
12034 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12035 @end lisp
12036
12037 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12038 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12039 if you fill many roles.
12040 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12041 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12042
12043 @node Drafts
12044 @section Drafts
12045 @cindex drafts
12046
12047 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12048 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12049 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12050 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12051 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12052
12053 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12054 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12055 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12056 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12057 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12058 group.)
12059
12060 @cindex nndraft
12061 @vindex nndraft-directory
12062 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12063 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12064 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12065 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12066 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12067 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12068
12069 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12070 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12071 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12072 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12073 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12074 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12075 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12076 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12077 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12078
12079 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12080 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12081 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12082 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12083 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12084 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12085 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12086 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12087 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12088 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12089 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12090 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12091 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12092 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12093 @c
12094 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12095 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12096 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12097
12098 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12099 @kindex D e (Draft)
12100 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12101 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12102 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12103
12104 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12105 Articles}).
12106
12107 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12108 @kindex D s (Draft)
12109 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12110 @kindex D S (Draft)
12111 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12112 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12113 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12114 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12115 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12116 in the buffer.
12117
12118 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12119 @kindex D t (Draft)
12120 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12121 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12122 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12123
12124
12125 @node Rejected Articles
12126 @section Rejected Articles
12127 @cindex rejected articles
12128
12129 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12130 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12131 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12132 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12133
12134 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12135 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12136 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12137 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12138 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12139
12140 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12141 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12142 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12143
12144 @node Signing and encrypting
12145 @section Signing and encrypting
12146 @cindex using gpg
12147 @cindex using s/mime
12148 @cindex using smime
12149
12150 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12151 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12152 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12153 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12154
12155 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12156 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12157 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12158 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12159 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12160 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12161 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12162 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12163 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12164 automatically encrypted messages.
12165
12166 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12167 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12168 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12169
12170 @table @kbd
12171
12172 @item C-c C-m s s
12173 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12174 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12175
12176 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12177
12178 @item C-c C-m s o
12179 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12180 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12181
12182 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12183
12184 @item C-c C-m s p
12185 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12186 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12187
12188 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12189
12190 @item C-c C-m c s
12191 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12192 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12193
12194 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12195
12196 @item C-c C-m c o
12197 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12198 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12199
12200 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12201
12202 @item C-c C-m c p
12203 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12204 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12205
12206 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12207
12208 @item C-c C-m C-n
12209 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12210 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12211 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12212
12213 @end table
12214
12215 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12216
12217 @node Select Methods
12218 @chapter Select Methods
12219 @cindex foreign groups
12220 @cindex select methods
12221
12222 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12223 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12224 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12225 personal mail group.
12226
12227 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12228 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12229 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12230 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12231 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12232 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12233
12234 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12235 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12236
12237 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12238 group as.
12239
12240 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12241 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12242 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12243 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12244 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12245
12246 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12247
12248 @menu
12249 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12250 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12251 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12252 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12253 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12254 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12255 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12256 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12257 @end menu
12258
12259
12260 @node Server Buffer
12261 @section Server Buffer
12262
12263 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12264 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12265 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12266 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12267 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12268 back end represents a virtual server.
12269
12270 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12271 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12272 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12273 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12274
12275 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12276 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12277 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12278 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12279 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12280 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12281 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12282
12283 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12284 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12285
12286 @menu
12287 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12288 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12289 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12290 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12291 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12292 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12293 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12294 @end menu
12295
12296 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12297 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12298
12299
12300 @node Server Buffer Format
12301 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12302 @cindex server buffer format
12303
12304 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12305 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12306 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12307 variable, with some simple extensions:
12308
12309 @table @samp
12310
12311 @item h
12312 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12313
12314 @item n
12315 The name of this server.
12316
12317 @item w
12318 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12319
12320 @item s
12321 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12322
12323 @item a
12324 Whether this server is agentized.
12325 @end table
12326
12327 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12328 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12329 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12330 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12331
12332 @table @samp
12333 @item S
12334 Server name.
12335
12336 @item M
12337 Server method.
12338 @end table
12339
12340 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12341
12342
12343 @node Server Commands
12344 @subsection Server Commands
12345 @cindex server commands
12346
12347 @table @kbd
12348
12349 @item v
12350 @kindex v (Server)
12351 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
12352 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it key to some
12353 function or better use it as a prefix key.
12354
12355 @item a
12356 @kindex a (Server)
12357 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12358 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12359
12360 @item e
12361 @kindex e (Server)
12362 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12363 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12364
12365 @item SPACE
12366 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12367 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12368 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12369
12370 @item q
12371 @kindex q (Server)
12372 @findex gnus-server-exit
12373 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12374
12375 @item k
12376 @kindex k (Server)
12377 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12378 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12379
12380 @item y
12381 @kindex y (Server)
12382 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12383 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12384
12385 @item c
12386 @kindex c (Server)
12387 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12388 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12389
12390 @item l
12391 @kindex l (Server)
12392 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12393 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12394
12395 @item s
12396 @kindex s (Server)
12397 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12398 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12399 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12400 servers.
12401
12402 @item g
12403 @kindex g (Server)
12404 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12405 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12406 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12407 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12408
12409 @end table
12410
12411
12412 @node Example Methods
12413 @subsection Example Methods
12414
12415 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12416
12417 @lisp
12418 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12419 @end lisp
12420
12421 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12422
12423 @lisp
12424 (nnspool "")
12425 @end lisp
12426
12427 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12428 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12429 will.
12430
12431 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12432 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12433
12434 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12435 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12436 look like then:
12437
12438 @lisp
12439 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12440 @end lisp
12441
12442 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12443 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12444
12445 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12446 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12447 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12448 your private mail:
12449
12450 @lisp
12451 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12452 @end lisp
12453
12454 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12455 that.)
12456
12457 Here's the method for a public spool:
12458
12459 @lisp
12460 (nnmh "public"
12461 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12462 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12463 @end lisp
12464
12465 @cindex proxy
12466 @cindex firewall
12467
12468 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12469 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12470 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12471 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12472 should probably look something like this:
12473
12474 @lisp
12475 (nntp "firewall"
12476 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12477 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12478 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12479 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12480 @end lisp
12481
12482 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12483 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12484 configuration to the example above:
12485
12486 @lisp
12487 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12488 @end lisp
12489
12490 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12491
12492 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12493 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12494 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12495
12496 @lisp
12497 (nntp "outside"
12498 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12499 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12500 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12501 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12502 @end lisp
12503
12504 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12505 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12506 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12507 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12508
12509
12510 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12511 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12512
12513 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12514 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12515
12516 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12517 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12518 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12519
12520 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12521
12522 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12523 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12524 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12525 will contain the following:
12526
12527 @lisp
12528 (nnml "cache")
12529 @end lisp
12530
12531 Change that to:
12532
12533 @lisp
12534 (nnml "cache"
12535 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12536 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12537 @end lisp
12538
12539 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12540 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12541 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12542
12543
12544 @node Server Variables
12545 @subsection Server Variables
12546 @cindex server variables
12547 @cindex server parameters
12548
12549 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12550 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12551 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12552 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12553 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12554
12555 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12556 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12557 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12558 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12559 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12560 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12561 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12562 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12563 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12564
12565 @lisp
12566 (nnml "public"
12567 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12568 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12569 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12570 @end lisp
12571
12572 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12573
12574 @node Servers and Methods
12575 @subsection Servers and Methods
12576
12577 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12578 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12579 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12580 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12581 over.
12582
12583
12584 @node Unavailable Servers
12585 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12586
12587 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12588 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12589 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12590 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12591 actually the case or not.
12592
12593 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12594 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12595 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12596 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12597 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12598 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12599 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12600 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12601
12602 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12603 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12604
12605 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12606 with the following commands:
12607
12608 @table @kbd
12609
12610 @item O
12611 @kindex O (Server)
12612 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12613 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12614 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12615
12616 @item C
12617 @kindex C (Server)
12618 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12619 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12620 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12621
12622 @item D
12623 @kindex D (Server)
12624 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12625 Mark the current server as unreachable
12626 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12627
12628 @item M-o
12629 @kindex M-o (Server)
12630 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12631 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12632 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12633
12634 @item M-c
12635 @kindex M-c (Server)
12636 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12637 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12638 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12639
12640 @item R
12641 @kindex R (Server)
12642 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12643 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12644 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12645
12646 @item L
12647 @kindex L (Server)
12648 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12649 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12650
12651 @end table
12652
12653
12654 @node Getting News
12655 @section Getting News
12656 @cindex reading news
12657 @cindex news back ends
12658
12659 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12660 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12661 or it can read from a local spool.
12662
12663 @menu
12664 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12665 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12666 @end menu
12667
12668
12669 @node NNTP
12670 @subsection NNTP
12671 @cindex nntp
12672
12673 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12674 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12675 server as the, uhm, address.
12676
12677 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12678 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12679 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12680 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12681
12682 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12683 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12684 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12685
12686 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12687 server:
12688
12689 @table @code
12690
12691 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12692 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12693 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12694 @cindex authinfo
12695 @cindex authentication
12696 @cindex nntp authentication
12697 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12698 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12699 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12700 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12701 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12702 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12703 present in this hook.
12704
12705 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12706 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12707 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12708 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12709 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12710 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12711 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12712 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12713 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12714 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12715 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12716 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12717
12718 @enumerate
12719 @item
12720 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12721
12722 @item
12723 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12724
12725 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12726 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12727 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12728 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12729 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12730 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12731 @samp{force} is explained below.
12732
12733 @end enumerate
12734
12735 Here's an example file:
12736
12737 @example
12738 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12739 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12740 @end example
12741
12742 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12743 have to be first, for instance.
12744
12745 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12746 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12747 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12748 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12749 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12750 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12751 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12752
12753 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12754 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12755
12756 @example
12757 default force yes
12758 @end example
12759
12760 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12761 previously mentioned.
12762
12763 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12764
12765 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12766 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12767 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12768 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12769 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12770
12771 @lisp
12772 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12773 '(("innd" (ding))))
12774 @end lisp
12775
12776 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12777
12778 The default value is
12779
12780 @lisp
12781 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12782 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12783 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12784 @end lisp
12785
12786 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12787 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12788
12789 @item nntp-maximum-request
12790 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12791 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12792 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12793 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12794 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12795 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12796 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12797
12798 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12799 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12800 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12801 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12802 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12803 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12804 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12805 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12806 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12807 no timeouts are done.
12808
12809 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12810 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12811 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12812 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12813 can be used.
12814
12815 @item nntp-xover-commands
12816 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12817 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12818 @cindex XOVER
12819 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12820 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12821 "XOVERVIEW")}.
12822
12823 @item nntp-nov-gap
12824 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12825 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12826 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12827 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12828 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12829 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12830 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12831 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12832 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12833 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12834 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12835
12836 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12837 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12838 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12839
12840 @item nntp-record-commands
12841 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12842 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
12843 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
12844 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
12845 that doesn't seem to work.
12846
12847 @item nntp-open-connection-function
12848 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
12849 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
12850 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
12851 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
12852 Six pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
12853 two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
12854 indirect ones (two pre-made).
12855
12856 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
12857 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
12858 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
12859 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
12860 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
12861 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
12862 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
12863
12864 @lisp
12865 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
12866 @end lisp
12867
12868 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
12869 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
12870
12871 @end table
12872
12873 @menu
12874 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
12875 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
12876 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
12877 @end menu
12878
12879
12880 @node Direct Functions
12881 @subsubsection Direct Functions
12882 @cindex direct connection functions
12883
12884 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
12885 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
12886 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
12887 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12888
12889 @table @code
12890 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
12891 @item nntp-open-network-stream
12892 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
12893 remote system.
12894
12895 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
12896 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
12897 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12898 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
12899 installed. You then define a server as follows:
12900
12901 @lisp
12902 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12903 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
12904 ;;
12905 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12906 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
12907 (nntp-port-number )
12908 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12909 @end lisp
12910
12911 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
12912 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
12913 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
12914 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
12915 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
12916 then define a server as follows:
12917
12918 @lisp
12919 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
12920 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
12921 ;;
12922 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
12923 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
12924 (nntp-port-number 563)
12925 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
12926 @end lisp
12927
12928 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
12929 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
12930 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
12931 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
12932 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
12933 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
12934 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
12935 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
12936
12937 @lisp
12938 (nntp "socksified"
12939 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12940 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
12941 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
12942 @end lisp
12943
12944 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
12945 session, which is not a good idea.
12946 @end table
12947
12948
12949 @node Indirect Functions
12950 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
12951 @cindex indirect connection functions
12952
12953 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
12954 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12955 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
12956 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
12957 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
12958 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
12959
12960 @table @code
12961 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12962 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
12963 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
12964 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
12965 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
12966
12967 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12968
12969 @table @code
12970 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
12971 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
12972 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
12973 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
12974
12975 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12976 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
12977 List of strings to be used as the switches to
12978 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
12979 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
12980 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
12981 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
12982 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
12983 host.
12984 @end table
12985
12986 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12987 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
12988 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
12989 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
12990
12991 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
12992
12993 @table @code
12994 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
12995 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
12996 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
12997 @samp{telnet}.
12998
12999 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13000 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13001 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13002 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13003
13004 @item nntp-via-user-password
13005 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13006 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13007
13008 @item nntp-via-envuser
13009 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13010 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13011 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13012 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13013
13014 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13015 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13016 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13017 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13018
13019 @end table
13020
13021 @end table
13022
13023
13024 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13025 functions:
13026
13027 @table @code
13028
13029 @item nntp-via-user-name
13030 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13031 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13032
13033 @item nntp-via-address
13034 @vindex nntp-via-address
13035 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13036
13037 @end table
13038
13039
13040 @node Common Variables
13041 @subsubsection Common Variables
13042
13043 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13044 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13045 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13046 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13047 variables individually).
13048
13049 @table @code
13050
13051 @item nntp-pre-command
13052 @vindex nntp-pre-command
13053 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
13054 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
13055 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
13056 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
13057
13058 @item nntp-address
13059 @vindex nntp-address
13060 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13061
13062 @item nntp-port-number
13063 @vindex nntp-port-number
13064 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13065 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
13066 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
13067 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
13068 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
13069 not work with named ports.
13070
13071 @item nntp-end-of-line
13072 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
13073 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
13074 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
13075 using a non native connection function.
13076
13077 @item nntp-telnet-command
13078 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13079 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
13080 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
13081 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13082 @samp{telnet}.
13083
13084 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13085 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13086 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
13087 is @samp{("-8")}.
13088
13089 @end table
13090
13091
13092 @node News Spool
13093 @subsection News Spool
13094 @cindex nnspool
13095 @cindex news spool
13096
13097 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
13098 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
13099 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
13100 instance.
13101
13102 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13103 anything else) as the address.
13104
13105 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13106 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13107 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13108 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13109
13110 @table @code
13111
13112 @item nnspool-inews-program
13113 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13114 Program used to post an article.
13115
13116 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13117 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13118 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13119
13120 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13121 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13122 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13123 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13124
13125 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13126 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13127 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13128 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13129
13130 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13131 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13132 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13133
13134 @item nnspool-active-file
13135 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13136 The name of the active file.
13137
13138 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13139 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13140 The name of the group descriptions file.
13141
13142 @item nnspool-history-file
13143 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13144 The name of the news history file.
13145
13146 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13147 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13148 The name of the active date file.
13149
13150 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13151 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13152 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13153 that it finds.
13154
13155 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13156 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13157 @cindex sed
13158 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13159 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13160 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13161 there.
13162
13163 @end table
13164
13165
13166 @node Getting Mail
13167 @section Getting Mail
13168 @cindex reading mail
13169 @cindex mail
13170
13171 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13172 course.
13173
13174 @menu
13175 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13176 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13177 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13178 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13179 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13180 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13181 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13182 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13183 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13184 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13185 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13186 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13187 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13188 @end menu
13189
13190
13191 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13192 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13193
13194 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13195 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13196 of a culture shock.
13197
13198 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13199 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13200
13201 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13202 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13203 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13204 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13205
13206 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13207
13208 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13209 deleted? How awful!
13210
13211 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13212 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13213 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13214 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13215 Mail}.
13216
13217 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13218 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13219 they want to treat a message.
13220
13221 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13222 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13223 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13224 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13225 archived somewhere else.
13226
13227 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13228 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13229 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13230 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13231 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13232
13233 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13234 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13235 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13236
13237 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13238 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13239 differently.
13240
13241 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13242 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13243 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13244 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13245 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13246
13247 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13248 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13249 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13250 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13251 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13252 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13253 You Do.)
13254
13255
13256 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13257 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13258
13259 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13260 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13261 and things will happen automatically.
13262
13263 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13264 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13265
13266 @lisp
13267 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13268 @end lisp
13269
13270 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13271 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13272 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13273 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13274 like any other group.
13275
13276 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13277
13278 @lisp
13279 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13280 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13281 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13282 ("other" "")))
13283 @end lisp
13284
13285 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13286 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13287 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13288 last group.
13289
13290 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13291 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13292 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13293
13294
13295 @node Splitting Mail
13296 @subsection Splitting Mail
13297 @cindex splitting mail
13298 @cindex mail splitting
13299 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13300
13301 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13302 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13303 to be split into groups.
13304
13305 @lisp
13306 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13307 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13308 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13309 ("mail.other" "")))
13310 @end lisp
13311
13312 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13313 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13314 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13315 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13316 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13317 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13318 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13319
13320 @lisp
13321 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13322 @end lisp
13323
13324 @noindent
13325 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13326 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13327
13328 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13329 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13330 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13331 mail belongs in that group.
13332
13333 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
13334 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13335 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
13336 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13337 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
13338 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
13339 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
13340 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
13341 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
13342 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
13343
13344 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13345 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13346 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13347 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13348 thinks should carry this mail message.
13349
13350 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13351 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13352 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13353 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13354
13355 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13356 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13357 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13358 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13359 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
13360
13361 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13362 @cindex crosspost
13363 @cindex links
13364 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13365 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13366 links. If that's the case for you, set
13367 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13368 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13369
13370 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13371 @findex nnmail-split-history
13372 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13373 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13374 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13375 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13376 Group Commands}).
13377
13378 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13379 Header lines longer than the value of
13380 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13381 function.
13382
13383 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13384 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13385 By default the splitting codes @acronym{MIME} decodes headers so you
13386 can match on non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. The
13387 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset} variable specifies the default
13388 charset for decoding. The behavior can be turned off completely by
13389 binding @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} to @code{nil}, which is
13390 useful if you want to match articles based on the raw header data.
13391
13392 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13393 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13394 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13395 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13396 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13397 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13398 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13399 other kinds of entries.)
13400
13401 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13402 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13403 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13404 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13405 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13406 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13407 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13408 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13409 month's rent money.
13410
13411
13412 @node Mail Sources
13413 @subsection Mail Sources
13414
13415 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13416 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13417 maildir, for instance.
13418
13419 @menu
13420 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13421 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13422 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13423 @end menu
13424
13425
13426 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13427 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13428 @cindex POP
13429 @cindex mail server
13430 @cindex procmail
13431 @cindex mail spool
13432 @cindex mail source
13433
13434 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13435 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13436
13437 Here's an example:
13438
13439 @lisp
13440 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13441 @end lisp
13442
13443 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13444 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13445 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13446 default values.
13447
13448 The following mail source types are available:
13449
13450 @table @code
13451 @item file
13452 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13453
13454 Keywords:
13455
13456 @table @code
13457 @item :path
13458 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13459 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13460 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13461
13462 @item :prescript
13463 @itemx :postscript
13464 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13465 @end table
13466
13467 An example file mail source:
13468
13469 @lisp
13470 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13471 @end lisp
13472
13473 Or using the default file name:
13474
13475 @lisp
13476 (file)
13477 @end lisp
13478
13479 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13480 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13481 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13482 mail spool while moving the mail.
13483
13484 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13485
13486 @lisp
13487 (setq mail-sources
13488 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13489 @end lisp
13490
13491 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13492
13493 @example
13494 #!/bin/sh
13495 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13496 # flu@@iki.fi
13497
13498 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13499 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
13500 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13501 @end example
13502
13503 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
13504
13505
13506 @item directory
13507 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13508 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13509 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13510 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13511 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13512 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13513 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13514 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13515 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13516 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13517
13518 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13519 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13520 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13521 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13522
13523 Keywords:
13524
13525 @table @code
13526 @item :path
13527 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13528 value.
13529
13530 @item :suffix
13531 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13532 @samp{.spool}.
13533
13534 @item :predicate
13535 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13536 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13537 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13538 predicate are considered.
13539
13540 @item :prescript
13541 @itemx :postscript
13542 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13543
13544 @end table
13545
13546 An example directory mail source:
13547
13548 @lisp
13549 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13550 :suffix ".prcml")
13551 @end lisp
13552
13553 @item pop
13554 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13555
13556 Keywords:
13557
13558 @table @code
13559 @item :server
13560 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13561 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13562
13563 @item :port
13564 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13565 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13566 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13567 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13568 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13569
13570 @item :user
13571 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13572 name.
13573
13574 @item :password
13575 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13576 the user is prompted.
13577
13578 @item :program
13579 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13580 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13581
13582 @example
13583 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13584 @end example
13585
13586 The valid format specifier characters are:
13587
13588 @table @samp
13589 @item t
13590 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13591 included in this string.
13592
13593 @item s
13594 The name of the server.
13595
13596 @item P
13597 The port number of the server.
13598
13599 @item u
13600 The user name to use.
13601
13602 @item p
13603 The password to use.
13604 @end table
13605
13606 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13607 corresponding keywords.
13608
13609 @item :prescript
13610 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13611 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13612
13613 @item :postscript
13614 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13615 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13616
13617 @item :function
13618 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13619 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13620 mail should be moved to.
13621
13622 @item :authentication
13623 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13624 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13625 @code{password}.
13626
13627 @end table
13628
13629 @vindex pop3-movemail
13630 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
13631 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13632 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If the
13633 @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server} is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be
13634 left on the @acronym{POP} server after fetching when using
13635 @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers maintain no state
13636 information between sessions, so what the client believes is there and
13637 what is actually there may not match up. If they do not, then the whole
13638 thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
13639
13640 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server,
13641 using the default user name, and default fetcher:
13642
13643 @lisp
13644 (pop)
13645 @end lisp
13646
13647 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13648
13649 @lisp
13650 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13651 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13652 @end lisp
13653
13654 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13655
13656 @lisp
13657 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13658 @end lisp
13659
13660 @item maildir
13661 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13662 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13663 contains exactly one mail.
13664
13665 Keywords:
13666
13667 @table @code
13668 @item :path
13669 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13670 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13671 @file{~/Maildir/}.
13672 @item :subdirs
13673 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13674 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13675
13676 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13677 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13678 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13679 @c below.
13680
13681 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13682 from locking problems).
13683
13684 @end table
13685
13686 Two example maildir mail sources:
13687
13688 @lisp
13689 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13690 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13691 @end lisp
13692
13693 @lisp
13694 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13695 :subdirs ("new"))
13696 @end lisp
13697
13698 @item imap
13699 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13700 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13701 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13702 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13703 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13704
13705 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13706 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13707
13708 Keywords:
13709
13710 @table @code
13711 @item :server
13712 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13713 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13714
13715 @item :port
13716 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13717 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13718
13719 @item :user
13720 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13721 name.
13722
13723 @item :password
13724 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13725 prompted.
13726
13727 @item :stream
13728 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13729 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13730 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13731 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13732
13733 @item :authentication
13734 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13735 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13736 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13737 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13738
13739 @item :program
13740 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13741 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13742 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13743
13744 @example
13745 ssh %s imapd
13746 @end example
13747
13748 The valid format specifier characters are:
13749
13750 @table @samp
13751 @item s
13752 The name of the server.
13753
13754 @item l
13755 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13756
13757 @item p
13758 The port number of the server.
13759 @end table
13760
13761 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13762 corresponding keywords.
13763
13764 @item :mailbox
13765 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13766 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13767
13768 @item :predicate
13769 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13770 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13771 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13772 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13773 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13774 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13775
13776 @item :fetchflag
13777 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13778 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13779 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13780 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13781
13782 @item :dontexpunge
13783 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13784 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13785
13786 @end table
13787
13788 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13789
13790 @lisp
13791 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13792 :stream kerberos4
13793 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13794 @end lisp
13795
13796 @item webmail
13797 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13798 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13799 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13800
13801 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13802 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13803
13804 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13805
13806 Keywords:
13807
13808 @table @code
13809 @item :subtype
13810 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13811 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13812
13813 @item :user
13814 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13815 name.
13816
13817 @item :password
13818 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
13819 prompted.
13820
13821 @item :dontexpunge
13822 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
13823 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
13824
13825 @end table
13826
13827 An example webmail source:
13828
13829 @lisp
13830 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
13831 :user "user-name"
13832 :password "secret")
13833 @end lisp
13834 @end table
13835
13836 @table @dfn
13837 @item Common Keywords
13838 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
13839
13840 Keywords:
13841
13842 @table @code
13843 @item :plugged
13844 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
13845 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
13846 example:
13847
13848 @lisp
13849 (setq mail-sources
13850 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
13851 :suffix ""
13852 :plugged t)))
13853 @end lisp
13854
13855 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
13856 useful when you use local mail and news.
13857
13858 @end table
13859 @end table
13860
13861 @subsubsection Function Interface
13862
13863 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
13864 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
13865 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
13866 consider the following mail-source setting:
13867
13868 @lisp
13869 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
13870 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
13871 @end lisp
13872
13873 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
13874 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
13875 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
13876 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
13877 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
13878
13879 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
13880
13881
13882 @node Mail Source Customization
13883 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
13884
13885 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
13886 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
13887 variables.
13888
13889 @table @code
13890 @item mail-source-crash-box
13891 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
13892 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
13893 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
13894
13895 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
13896 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
13897 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
13898 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
13899 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
13900 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
13901 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
13902 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
13903
13904 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13905 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
13906 If non-@code{nil}, ask for for confirmation before deleting old incoming
13907 files. This variable only applies when
13908 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
13909
13910 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
13911 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
13912 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
13913
13914 @item mail-source-directory
13915 @vindex mail-source-directory
13916 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
13917 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
13918 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
13919 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
13920
13921 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13922 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
13923 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
13924 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
13925 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
13926 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
13927 number.
13928
13929 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
13930 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
13931 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
13932
13933 @item mail-source-movemail-program
13934 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
13935 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
13936 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
13937
13938 @end table
13939
13940
13941 @node Fetching Mail
13942 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
13943
13944 @vindex mail-sources
13945 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
13946 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
13947 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
13948 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
13949
13950 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
13951 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
13952 themselves.
13953
13954 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
13955 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
13956
13957 @lisp
13958 (setq mail-sources
13959 '((file)
13960 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13961 :password "secret")))
13962 @end lisp
13963
13964 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
13965
13966 @lisp
13967 (setq mail-sources
13968 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
13969 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13970 :user "user-name"
13971 :port "pop3"
13972 :password "secret")))
13973 @end lisp
13974
13975
13976 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
13977 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
13978 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
13979 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
13980 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
13981 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
13982
13983
13984
13985 @node Mail Back End Variables
13986 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
13987
13988 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
13989 mail back ends.
13990
13991 @table @code
13992 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13993 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
13994 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
13995 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
13996
13997 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
13998 @item nnmail-split-hook
13999 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
14000 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
14001 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
14002 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
14003 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
14004 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
14005 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
14006 in the buffer will show up in any files.
14007 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
14008 to this hook.
14009
14010 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14011 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14012 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14013 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14014 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
14015 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
14016 starting to handle the new mail) and
14017 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
14018 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
14019 default file modes the new mail files get:
14020
14021 @lisp
14022 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14023 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
14024
14025 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14026 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
14027 @end lisp
14028
14029 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
14030 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
14031 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
14032 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
14033 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
14034 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
14035 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
14036
14037 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
14038 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
14039 @findex delete-file
14040 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
14041
14042 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14043 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14044 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
14045 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
14046 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
14047
14048 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14049 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14050 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
14051 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
14052 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
14053
14054 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
14055 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
14056 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
14057
14058 @end table
14059
14060
14061 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
14062 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
14063 @cindex mail splitting
14064 @cindex fancy mail splitting
14065
14066 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
14067 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
14068 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
14069 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
14070 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
14071 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
14072
14073 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
14074
14075 @lisp
14076 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
14077 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
14078 ;; @r{from real errors.}
14079 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
14080 "mail.misc"))
14081 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
14082 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
14083 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
14084 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
14085 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
14086 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
14087 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
14088 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
14089 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
14090 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
14091 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
14092 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
14093 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
14094 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
14095 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
14096 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
14097 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
14098 "misc.misc")
14099 @end lisp
14100
14101 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14102 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14103 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14104
14105 @table @code
14106
14107 @item group
14108 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14109 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14110
14111 @c Don't fold this line.
14112 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
14113 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
14114 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
14115 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
14116 @var{split}.
14117
14118 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
14119 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
14120 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
14121 @var{split} is processed.
14122
14123 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
14124 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
14125 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
14126 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14127
14128 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14129 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14130 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14131 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14132 stored in one or more groups.
14133
14134 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14135 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14136 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14137
14138 @item junk
14139 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14140 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14141
14142 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14143 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14144 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14145 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14146
14147 @cindex body split
14148 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14149 body of the messages:
14150
14151 @lisp
14152 (defun split-on-body ()
14153 (save-excursion
14154 (save-restriction
14155 (widen)
14156 (goto-char (point-min))
14157 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14158 "string.group"))))
14159 @end lisp
14160
14161 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14162 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14163 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14164 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14165 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14166 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14167 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14168
14169 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14170 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14171 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14172 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14173 should return a split.
14174
14175 @item nil
14176 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14177
14178 @end table
14179
14180 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14181
14182 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
14183 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
14184 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
14185 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
14186 for example,
14187
14188 @example
14189 (any "joe" "joemail")
14190 @end example
14191
14192 @noindent
14193 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
14194 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
14195 of the following three ways:
14196
14197 @enumerate
14198 @item
14199 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14200 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
14201 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
14202 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
14203 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
14204 @code{nil}.
14205
14206 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
14207
14208 @item
14209 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
14210 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
14211 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
14212 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
14213 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
14214
14215 @item
14216 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
14217 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
14218 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
14219 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14220 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
14221 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14222 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14223 @end enumerate
14224
14225 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14226 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14227 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14228 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14229 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14230 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14231 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14232
14233 @table @code
14234 @item from
14235 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14236 @item to
14237 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14238 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14239 @item any
14240 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14241 @end table
14242
14243 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14244 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14245 when all this splitting is performed.
14246
14247 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14248 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14249 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14250
14251 @example
14252 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14253 @end example
14254
14255 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14256 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14257
14258 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14259 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14260 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14261 groupings 1 through 9.
14262
14263 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14264 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14265 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14266 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14267 groups when users send to an address using different case
14268 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14269 is @code{t}.
14270
14271 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14272 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14273 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14274 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14275 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14276 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14277 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14278 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14279 it once per thread.
14280
14281 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14282 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14283 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14284 using the colon feature, like so:
14285 @lisp
14286 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14287 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14288 nnmail-split-fancy
14289 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14290 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14291 ))
14292 @end lisp
14293
14294 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14295 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14296 in the file specified by the variable
14297 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14298 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14299 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14300 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14301 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14302 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14303 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14304 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14305 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14306 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14307 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14308 300 kBytes in size.)
14309 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14310 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14311 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14312 messages goes into the new group.
14313
14314 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14315 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14316 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14317 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14318 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14319 ``outgoing'' group.
14320
14321
14322 @node Group Mail Splitting
14323 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14324 @cindex mail splitting
14325 @cindex group mail splitting
14326
14327 @findex gnus-group-split
14328 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14329 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14330 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14331 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14332 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14333 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14334 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14335 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14336
14337 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14338 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14339 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14340 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14341
14342 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14343 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14344 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14345 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14346 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14347 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14348 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14349
14350 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14351 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14352 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14353 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14354 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14355 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14356 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14357
14358 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14359 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14360 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14361 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14362 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14363 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14364 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14365 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14366 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14367 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14368 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14369 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14370 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14371
14372 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14373 been defined:
14374
14375 @example
14376 nnml:mail.bar:
14377 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14378 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14379 nnml:mail.foo:
14380 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14381 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14382 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14383 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14384 nnml:mail.others:
14385 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14386 @end example
14387
14388 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14389 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14390 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14391
14392 @lisp
14393 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14394 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14395 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14396 "mail.others")
14397 @end lisp
14398
14399 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14400 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14401 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14402 splits like this:
14403
14404 @lisp
14405 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14406 @end lisp
14407
14408 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14409 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14410 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14411 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14412 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14413 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14414 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14415 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14416 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14417
14418 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14419 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14420 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14421 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14422 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14423 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14424 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14425 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14426 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14427
14428 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14429 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14430 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14431 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14432 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14433 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14434
14435 @lisp
14436 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14437 @end lisp
14438
14439 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14440 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14441 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14442 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14443 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14444 value.
14445
14446 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14447 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14448 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14449 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14450
14451 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14452 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14453 @cindex incorporating old mail
14454 @cindex import old mail
14455
14456 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14457 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14458 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14459 your mail groups.
14460
14461 Doing so can be quite easy.
14462
14463 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14464 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14465 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14466 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14467 your @code{nnml} groups.
14468
14469 Here's how:
14470
14471 @enumerate
14472 @item
14473 Go to the group buffer.
14474
14475 @item
14476 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14477 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14478
14479 @item
14480 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14481
14482 @item
14483 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14484 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14485
14486 @item
14487 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14488 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14489 @end enumerate
14490
14491 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14492 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14493 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14494 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14495 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14496
14497 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14498 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14499 using the new mail back end.
14500
14501
14502 @node Expiring Mail
14503 @subsection Expiring Mail
14504 @cindex article expiry
14505
14506 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14507 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14508 different approach to mail reading.
14509
14510 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14511 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14512 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14513 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14514 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14515 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14516 course.
14517
14518 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14519 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14520 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14521 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14522 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14523 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14524 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14525 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14526 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14527
14528 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14529 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14530 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14531 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14532 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14533 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14534 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14535 expirable.
14536
14537 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14538 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14539 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14540 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14541 into its own group.)
14542
14543 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14544 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14545 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14546 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14547 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14548 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14549 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14550 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14551 scoring.
14552
14553 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14554 Groups that match the regular expression
14555 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14556 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14557 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14558
14559 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14560 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14561 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14562 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14563 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14564
14565 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14566 @lisp
14567 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14568 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14569 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14570 @end lisp
14571
14572 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14573 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14574 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14575 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14576 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14577
14578 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14579 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14580
14581 @lisp
14582 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14583 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14584 @end lisp
14585
14586 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14587 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14588
14589 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14590 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14591 don't really mix very well.
14592
14593 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14594 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14595 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14596 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14597 days.
14598
14599 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14600 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14601 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14602 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14603 everywhere else:
14604
14605 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14606 @lisp
14607 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14608 (lambda (group)
14609 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14610 31)
14611 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14612 1)
14613 ((string= group "important")
14614 'never)
14615 (t
14616 6))))
14617 @end lisp
14618
14619 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14620 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14621
14622 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14623 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14624 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14625 @code{never}.
14626
14627 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14628 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14629
14630 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14631 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14632 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14633 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14634 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14635 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14636 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14637 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14638 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14639 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14640 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14641 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14642 name or @code{delete}.
14643
14644 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14645 @lisp
14646 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14647 @end lisp
14648
14649 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14650 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14651 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14652 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14653 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14654
14655 @lisp
14656 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14657 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14658 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14659 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14660 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14661 @end lisp
14662
14663 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14664 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14665 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14666 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14667 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14668 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14669
14670 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14671 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14672 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14673 easier for procmail users.
14674
14675 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14676 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14677 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14678 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14679 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14680 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14681 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14682 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14683 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14684 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14685 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14686 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14687 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14688 with! So there!
14689
14690 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14691
14692 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14693 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14694 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14695 auto-expire turned on.
14696
14697
14698 @node Washing Mail
14699 @subsection Washing Mail
14700 @cindex mail washing
14701 @cindex list server brain damage
14702 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14703
14704 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14705 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14706 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14707 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14708 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14709 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14710
14711 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14712 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14713 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14714 laugh.
14715
14716 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14717 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14718 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14719 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14720
14721 @table @code
14722 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14723 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14724 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14725 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14726 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14727
14728 @table @code
14729 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14730 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14731 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14732 Emacs running on MS machines.
14733
14734 @end table
14735
14736 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14737 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14738 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14739 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14740
14741 @table @code
14742 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14743 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14744 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14745 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14746
14747 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14748 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14749 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14750 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14751 into a feature by documenting it.)
14752
14753 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14754 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14755 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14756 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14757 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14758 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14759 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14760 @code{\\(..\\)}.
14761
14762 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14763 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14764
14765 @lisp
14766 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14767 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14768 @end lisp
14769
14770 This can also be done non-destructively with
14771 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14772
14773 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14774 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14775 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14776
14777 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14778 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14779 @cindex Eudora
14780 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14781 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14782 @code{References} headers.
14783
14784 @end table
14785
14786 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14787 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14788 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14789 include:
14790
14791 @table @code
14792 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14793 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14794 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14795
14796 @end table
14797 @end table
14798
14799
14800 @node Duplicates
14801 @subsection Duplicates
14802
14803 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14804 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14805 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14806 @cindex duplicate mails
14807 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14808 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14809 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14810 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14811 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14812 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14813 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14814 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14815 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14816 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14817 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
14818 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
14819 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
14820
14821 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
14822 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
14823 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
14824 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
14825
14826 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
14827 @code{nil}.
14828
14829 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
14830 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
14831 methods:
14832
14833 @lisp
14834 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
14835 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
14836 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
14837 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
14838 (any mail "mail.misc")
14839 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14840 [...] ))
14841 @end lisp
14842 @noindent
14843 Or something like:
14844 @lisp
14845 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14846 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
14847 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14848 [...]))
14849 @end lisp
14850
14851 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
14852 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
14853 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
14854 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
14855 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
14856
14857
14858 @node Not Reading Mail
14859 @subsection Not Reading Mail
14860
14861 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
14862 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
14863 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
14864
14865 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
14866 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
14867 mail, which should help.
14868
14869 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14870 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14871 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
14872 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
14873 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
14874 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
14875 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
14876 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
14877 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
14878 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
14879 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
14880
14881 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
14882 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
14883 incoming mail.
14884
14885
14886 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
14887 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
14888
14889 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
14890 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
14891 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
14892
14893 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
14894 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
14895 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
14896 Spool}).
14897
14898 @menu
14899 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
14900 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
14901 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
14902 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
14903 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
14904 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
14905 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
14906 @end menu
14907
14908
14909 @node Unix Mail Box
14910 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
14911 @cindex nnmbox
14912 @cindex unix mail box
14913
14914 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14915 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14916 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
14917 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
14918 which group it belongs in.
14919
14920 Virtual server settings:
14921
14922 @table @code
14923 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
14924 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
14925 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
14926 @file{~/mbox}.
14927
14928 @item nnmbox-active-file
14929 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
14930 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
14931 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
14932
14933 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
14934 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
14935 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
14936 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
14937 @end table
14938
14939
14940 @node Rmail Babyl
14941 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
14942 @cindex nnbabyl
14943 @cindex Rmail mbox
14944
14945 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14946 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14947 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
14948 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
14949 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
14950
14951 Virtual server settings:
14952
14953 @table @code
14954 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
14955 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
14956 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
14957
14958 @item nnbabyl-active-file
14959 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
14960 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
14961 @file{~/.rmail-active}
14962
14963 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14964 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
14965 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
14966 @code{t}
14967 @end table
14968
14969
14970 @node Mail Spool
14971 @subsubsection Mail Spool
14972 @cindex nnml
14973 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
14974
14975 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
14976 format. It should be used with some caution.
14977
14978 @vindex nnml-directory
14979 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
14980 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
14981 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
14982 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
14983
14984 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
14985 care of all that.
14986
14987 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
14988 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
14989 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
14990 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
14991 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
14992 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
14993 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
14994 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
14995
14996 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
14997 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
14998 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
14999 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
15000
15001 @cindex self contained nnml servers
15002 @cindex marks
15003 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
15004 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15005 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15006 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
15007 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
15008 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
15009 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
15010 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
15011 directory).
15012
15013 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
15014 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
15015 them next time it starts.
15016
15017 Virtual server settings:
15018
15019 @table @code
15020 @item nnml-directory
15021 @vindex nnml-directory
15022 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
15023 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
15024 is @file{~/Mail}).
15025
15026 @item nnml-active-file
15027 @vindex nnml-active-file
15028 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
15029 @file{~/Mail/active}.
15030
15031 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
15032 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
15033 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15034 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
15035
15036 @item nnml-get-new-mail
15037 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15038 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
15039 @code{t}.
15040
15041 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
15042 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
15043 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15044 default is @code{nil}.
15045
15046 @item nnml-nov-file-name
15047 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
15048 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
15049
15050 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15051 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15052 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
15053
15054 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
15055 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
15056 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15057 default is @code{nil}.
15058
15059 @item nnml-marks-file-name
15060 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
15061 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
15062
15063 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
15064 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
15065 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
15066 files.
15067
15068 @end table
15069
15070 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
15071 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
15072 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
15073 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
15074 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
15075 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
15076 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
15077 Commands}).
15078
15079
15080 @node MH Spool
15081 @subsubsection MH Spool
15082 @cindex nnmh
15083 @cindex mh-e mail spool
15084
15085 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
15086 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
15087 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
15088 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
15089 for.
15090
15091 Virtual server settings:
15092
15093 @table @code
15094 @item nnmh-directory
15095 @vindex nnmh-directory
15096 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
15097 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
15098 @file{~/Mail})
15099
15100 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
15101 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15102 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
15103 @code{t}.
15104
15105 @item nnmh-be-safe
15106 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
15107 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
15108 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
15109 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
15110 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
15111 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
15112 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
15113 @end table
15114
15115
15116 @node Maildir
15117 @subsubsection Maildir
15118 @cindex nnmaildir
15119 @cindex maildir
15120
15121 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
15122 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
15123 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
15124 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
15125 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
15126 within a maildir.
15127
15128 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
15129 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
15130 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15131 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15132 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15133 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15134 that appear as group in Gnus.
15135
15136 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15137 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15138 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15139
15140 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15141 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15142 another, and you will keep your marks.
15143
15144 Virtual server settings:
15145
15146 @table @code
15147 @item directory
15148 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15149 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15150 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15151 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15152 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15153 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15154 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15155 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15156 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15157 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15158
15159 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15160 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15161 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15162 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15163 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15164 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15165 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15166 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15167 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15168 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15169 value.
15170
15171 @item target-prefix
15172 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15173 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15174 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15175 closed.
15176
15177 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15178 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15179 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15180 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15181 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15182 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15183 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15184 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15185 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15186
15187 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15188 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15189 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15190 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15191 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15192
15193 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15194 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15195 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15196 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15197 @code{force} argument.
15198
15199 @item directory-files
15200 This should be a function with the same interface as
15201 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15202 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15203 parameter is optional; the default is
15204 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15205 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15206 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15207 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15208 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15209 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15210
15211 @item get-new-mail
15212 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15213 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15214 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15215 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15216 value is @code{nil}.
15217
15218 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15219 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15220 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15221 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15222 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15223 @end table
15224
15225 @subsubsection Group parameters
15226
15227 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15228 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15229 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15230 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15231 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15232 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15233 another back end.
15234
15235 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15236 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15237 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15238 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15239 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15240 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15241 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15242 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15243 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15244
15245 @table @code
15246 @item expire-age
15247 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15248 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15249 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15250 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15251 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
15252 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
15253 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
15254 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15255 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15256 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15257 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15258 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15259 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15260
15261 @item expire-group
15262 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15263 @example
15264 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15265 @end example
15266 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15267 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15268 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15269 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15270 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15271 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15272 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15273 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15274 article. So that form can refer to
15275 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15276 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
15277 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15278 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15279
15280 @item read-only
15281 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15282 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15283 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15284 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15285 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15286 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15287 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15288 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15289 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15290 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15291 contain extra copies of the articles.
15292
15293 @item directory-files
15294 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15295 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15296 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15297 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15298
15299 @item distrust-Lines:
15300 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15301 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15302 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15303
15304 @item always-marks
15305 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15306 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15307 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15308 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15309 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15310 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15311
15312 @item never-marks
15313 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15314 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15315 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15316 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15317 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15318 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15319 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15320
15321 @item nov-cache-size
15322 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15323 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15324 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15325 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15326 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15327 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15328 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15329 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15330 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15331 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15332 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15333 @end table
15334
15335 @subsubsection Article identification
15336 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15337 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15338 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15339 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15340 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15341 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15342 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15343 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15344 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15345 request the article in the summary buffer.
15346
15347 @subsubsection NOV data
15348 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15349 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15350 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15351 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15352 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15353 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15354 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15355 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15356 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15357 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15358 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15359
15360 @subsubsection Article marks
15361 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15362 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15363 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15364 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15365 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15366 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15367 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15368 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15369
15370 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15371 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15372 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15373 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15374 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15375 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15376 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15377 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15378 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15379
15380
15381 @node Mail Folders
15382 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15383 @cindex nnfolder
15384 @cindex mbox folders
15385 @cindex mail folders
15386
15387 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15388 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15389 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15390 numbers and arrival dates.
15391
15392 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15393 @cindex marks
15394 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15395 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15396 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15397 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15398 Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15399 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15400 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15401 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15402 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15403 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15404
15405 Virtual server settings:
15406
15407 @table @code
15408 @item nnfolder-directory
15409 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15410 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15411 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15412 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15413
15414 @item nnfolder-active-file
15415 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15416 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15417
15418 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15419 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15420 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15421 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15422
15423 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15424 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15425 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15426 default is @code{t}
15427
15428 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15429 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15430 @cindex backup files
15431 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15432 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15433 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15434 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15435
15436 @lisp
15437 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15438 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15439
15440 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15441 @end lisp
15442
15443 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15444 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15445 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15446 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15447 extract some information from it before removing it.
15448
15449 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15450 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15451 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15452 default is @code{nil}.
15453
15454 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15455 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15456 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15457
15458 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15459 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15460 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15461 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15462
15463 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15464 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15465 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15466 default is @code{nil}.
15467
15468 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15469 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15470 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15471
15472 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15473 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15474 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15475 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15476
15477 @end table
15478
15479
15480 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15481 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15482 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15483 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15484 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15485 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15486 though.
15487
15488 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15489 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15490
15491 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15492 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15493 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15494 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15495 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15496
15497 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15498 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15499 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15500 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15501 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15502 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15503 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15504 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15505 via NFS).
15506
15507 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15508 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15509 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15510 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15511
15512 @table @code
15513 @item nnmbox
15514
15515 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15516 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15517 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15518 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15519 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15520 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15521 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15522 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15523 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15524 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15525 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15526 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15527 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15528 what's where.
15529
15530 @item nnbabyl
15531
15532 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15533 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15534 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15535 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15536 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15537 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15538 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15539 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15540 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15541 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15542 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15543 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15544 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15545 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15546
15547 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15548 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15549 look at your mail.
15550
15551 @item nnml
15552
15553 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15554 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15555 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15556 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15557 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15558 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15559 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15560 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15561 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15562 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15563 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15564 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15565 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15566 provided by the active file and overviews.
15567
15568 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15569 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15570 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15571 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15572 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15573 wins big.
15574
15575 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15576 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15577 tiny files.
15578
15579 @item nnmh
15580
15581 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15582 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15583 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15584 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15585 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15586 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15587 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15588
15589 @item nnfolder
15590
15591 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15592 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15593 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15594 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15595 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15596 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15597 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15598 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15599 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15600
15601 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15602 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15603 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15604 friendly mail back end all over.
15605
15606 @item nnmaildir
15607
15608 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15609 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15610 mail back ends.
15611
15612 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15613 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15614 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15615 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15616 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15617 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15618 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15619 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15620 file system.
15621
15622 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15623 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15624 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15625 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15626 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15627 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15628 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15629 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15630 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15631 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15632 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15633
15634 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15635 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15636 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15637 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15638 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15639 @code{nnmaildir}.
15640
15641 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15642 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15643 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15644 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15645 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15646 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15647 removed in the future.
15648
15649 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15650 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15651 on your file system.
15652
15653 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15654 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15655
15656 @end table
15657
15658
15659 @node Browsing the Web
15660 @section Browsing the Web
15661 @cindex web
15662 @cindex browsing the web
15663 @cindex www
15664 @cindex http
15665
15666 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15667 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15668 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15669 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15670 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15671 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15672 even know what a news group is.
15673
15674 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15675 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15676 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15677 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15678 you mad in the end.
15679
15680 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15681 to do it instead?
15682
15683 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15684 interfaces to these sources.
15685
15686 @menu
15687 * Archiving Mail::
15688 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15689 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15690 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15691 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15692 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15693 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
15694 @end menu
15695
15696 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
15697 alternatives to work.
15698
15699 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15700 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15701 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15702 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15703 though, you should be ok.
15704
15705 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15706 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15707 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15708 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15709 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15710
15711 @node Archiving Mail
15712 @subsection Archiving Mail
15713 @cindex archiving mail
15714 @cindex backup of mail
15715
15716 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15717 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15718 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15719 marks is fairly simple.
15720
15721 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15722 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15723 though.)
15724
15725 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15726 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15727 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15728 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15729 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15730 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15731 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15732 before you restore the data.
15733
15734 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15735 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15736 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15737 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15738 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15739 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15740 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15741 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15742 is unnecessary in that case.
15743
15744 @node Web Searches
15745 @subsection Web Searches
15746 @cindex nnweb
15747 @cindex Google
15748 @cindex dejanews
15749 @cindex gmane
15750 @cindex Usenet searches
15751 @cindex searching the Usenet
15752
15753 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15754 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15755 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15756 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15757 searches without having to use a browser.
15758
15759 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15760 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15761 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15762 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15763 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15764
15765 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15766 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15767 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15768 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15769 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15770 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15771 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15772 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15773 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15774 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15775 group as read.
15776
15777 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15778 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15779 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15780 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15781 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15782 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15783
15784 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
15785 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
15786 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
15787
15788 Virtual server variables:
15789
15790 @table @code
15791 @item nnweb-type
15792 @vindex nnweb-type
15793 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15794 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15795 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15796
15797 @item nnweb-search
15798 @vindex nnweb-search
15799 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15800
15801 @item nnweb-max-hits
15802 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15803 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15804 999.
15805
15806 @item nnweb-type-definition
15807 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15808 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15809 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15810 present:
15811
15812 @table @code
15813 @item article
15814 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15815 understands.
15816
15817 @item map
15818 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
15819
15820 @item search
15821 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
15822
15823 @item address
15824 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
15825 to.
15826
15827 @item id
15828 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
15829 @end table
15830
15831 @end table
15832
15833
15834 @node Slashdot
15835 @subsection Slashdot
15836 @cindex Slashdot
15837 @cindex nnslashdot
15838
15839 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
15840 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
15841 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
15842
15843 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
15844 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15845
15846 @lisp
15847 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15848 '((nnslashdot "")))
15849 @end lisp
15850
15851 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
15852 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
15853 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
15854 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
15855 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
15856 Methods}).
15857
15858 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
15859 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15860
15861 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
15862 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
15863 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
15864 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
15865 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
15866 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
15867 @acronym{HTML} forms.
15868
15869 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
15870
15871 @table @code
15872 @item nnslashdot-threaded
15873 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
15874 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
15875 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
15876 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
15877 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
15878 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
15879
15880 @item nnslashdot-login-name
15881 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
15882 The login name to use when posting.
15883
15884 @item nnslashdot-password
15885 @vindex nnslashdot-password
15886 The password to use when posting.
15887
15888 @item nnslashdot-directory
15889 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
15890 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
15891 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
15892
15893 @item nnslashdot-active-url
15894 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
15895 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
15896 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
15897 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
15898
15899 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
15900 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
15901 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
15902
15903 @item nnslashdot-article-url
15904 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
15905 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
15906 article. The default is
15907 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
15908
15909 @item nnslashdot-threshold
15910 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
15911 The score threshold. The default is -1.
15912
15913 @item nnslashdot-group-number
15914 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
15915 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
15916 updated. The default is 0.
15917
15918 @end table
15919
15920
15921
15922 @node Ultimate
15923 @subsection Ultimate
15924 @cindex nnultimate
15925 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
15926
15927 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
15928 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
15929 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
15930 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
15931
15932 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
15933 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
15934 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
15935 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
15936 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
15937 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
15938 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
15939
15940 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
15941
15942 @table @code
15943 @item nnultimate-directory
15944 @vindex nnultimate-directory
15945 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
15946 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
15947 @end table
15948
15949
15950 @node Web Archive
15951 @subsection Web Archive
15952 @cindex nnwarchive
15953 @cindex Web Archive
15954
15955 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
15956 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
15957 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
15958 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
15959 groups updated.
15960
15961 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
15962 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
15963 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
15964 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
15965 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
15966 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
15967 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
15968 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
15969
15970 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
15971
15972 @table @code
15973 @item nnwarchive-directory
15974 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
15975 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
15976 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
15977
15978 @item nnwarchive-login
15979 @vindex nnwarchive-login
15980 The account name on the web server.
15981
15982 @item nnwarchive-passwd
15983 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
15984 The password for your account on the web server.
15985 @end table
15986
15987 @node RSS
15988 @subsection RSS
15989 @cindex nnrss
15990 @cindex RSS
15991
15992 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
15993 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
15994 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
15995 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
15996 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
15997
15998 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
15999 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16000
16001 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16002 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16003 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16004 group names.
16005
16006 @kindex G R (Group)
16007 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16008 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16009 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16010 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16011
16012 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16013 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16014 subscribe to groups.
16015
16016 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16017 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16018 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16019 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16020 variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
16021 the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
16022 XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
16023 the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
16024
16025 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16026 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16027 and a @samp{text/html} part.
16028
16029 @cindex OPML
16030 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16031 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16032 Markup Language).
16033
16034 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
16035 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
16036 file.
16037 @end defun
16038
16039 @defun nnrss-opml-export
16040 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
16041 @acronym{OPML} format.
16042 @end defun
16043
16044 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
16045
16046 @table @code
16047 @item nnrss-directory
16048 @vindex nnrss-directory
16049 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
16050 @file{~/News/rss/}.
16051
16052 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
16053 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
16054 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
16055 data files. The default is the value of
16056 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
16057 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
16058
16059 @item nnrss-use-local
16060 @vindex nnrss-use-local
16061 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
16062 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
16063 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
16064 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
16065 download script using @command{wget}.
16066
16067 @item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
16068 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
16069 parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
16070 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
16071 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
16072 to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
16073 simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
16074 @samp{text/html} parts.
16075 @end table
16076
16077 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
16078 the summary buffer.
16079
16080 @lisp
16081 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
16082 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
16083
16084 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
16085 (let ((descr
16086 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
16087 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
16088 @end lisp
16089
16090 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
16091 summary buffer.
16092
16093 @lisp
16094 (require 'browse-url)
16095
16096 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
16097 (interactive "p")
16098 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
16099 (mail-header-extra
16100 (gnus-data-header
16101 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
16102 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
16103 (if url
16104 (progn
16105 (browse-url (cdr url))
16106 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
16107 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
16108
16109 (eval-after-load "gnus"
16110 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
16111 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
16112 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
16113 @end lisp
16114
16115 Even if you have added @code{"text/html"} to the
16116 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
16117 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
16118 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
16119 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
16120 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
16121 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
16122 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
16123 @code{nnrss} groups:
16124
16125 @lisp
16126 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
16127 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
16128 '(add-to-list
16129 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
16130 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
16131 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
16132
16133 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
16134 (add-to-list
16135 'gnus-parameters
16136 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
16137 @end lisp
16138
16139
16140 @node Customizing W3
16141 @subsection Customizing W3
16142 @cindex W3
16143 @cindex html
16144 @cindex url
16145 @cindex Netscape
16146
16147 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
16148 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
16149 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
16150 users.
16151
16152 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
16153 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
16154 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
16155
16156 @lisp
16157 (eval-after-load "w3"
16158 '(progn
16159 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
16160 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
16161 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
16162 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
16163 (browse-url url)
16164 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
16165 @end lisp
16166
16167 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
16168 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
16169 follow the link.
16170
16171
16172 @node IMAP
16173 @section IMAP
16174 @cindex nnimap
16175 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
16176
16177 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
16178 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
16179 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
16180 specify the network address of the server.
16181
16182 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
16183 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
16184 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
16185 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
16186 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
16187 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
16188
16189 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
16190 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
16191 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
16192 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
16193
16194 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
16195 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
16196 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
16197 usage explained in this section.
16198
16199 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
16200 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
16201 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
16202 see below.)
16203
16204 @lisp
16205 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16206 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16207 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16208 (nnimap "dolk"
16209 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16210 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16211 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16212 (nnimap "barbar"
16213 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16214 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16215 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16216 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16217 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16218 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16219 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16220 (nnimap-stream network))
16221 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16222 (nnimap "vic20"
16223 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16224 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16225 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16226 @end lisp
16227
16228 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16229 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16230 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16231 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16232
16233 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16234 server:
16235
16236 @table @code
16237
16238 @item nnimap-address
16239 @vindex nnimap-address
16240
16241 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16242 server name if not specified.
16243
16244 @item nnimap-server-port
16245 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16246 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16247
16248 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16249
16250 @lisp
16251 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16252 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16253 @end lisp
16254
16255 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16256 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16257 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16258 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16259 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16260 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16261 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16262
16263 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16264 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16265 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16266 mailbox.
16267
16268 Example server specification:
16269
16270 @lisp
16271 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16272 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16273 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16274 @end lisp
16275
16276 @item nnimap-stream
16277 @vindex nnimap-stream
16278 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16279 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16280 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16281 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16282 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16283
16284 Example server specification:
16285
16286 @lisp
16287 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16288 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16289 @end lisp
16290
16291 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16292
16293 @itemize @bullet
16294 @item
16295 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16296 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16297 @item
16298 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16299 @item
16300 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16301 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16302 @samp{starttls}.
16303 @item
16304 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16305 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16306 @item
16307 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16308 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16309 @item
16310 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16311 @item
16312 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16313 @end itemize
16314
16315 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16316 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16317 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16318 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16319 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16320 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16321 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16322 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16323 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16324 program.
16325
16326 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16327 needed. It is available from
16328 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16329
16330 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16331 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16332 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16333 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16334 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16335 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16336 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16337 tried.
16338
16339 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16340 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16341 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16342 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16343 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16344 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16345 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16346 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
16347
16348 @vindex imap-shell-program
16349 @vindex imap-shell-host
16350 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16351 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16352
16353 @item nnimap-authenticator
16354 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16355
16356 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16357 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16358
16359 Example server specification:
16360
16361 @lisp
16362 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16363 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16364 @end lisp
16365
16366 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16367
16368 @itemize @bullet
16369 @item
16370 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16371 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16372 @item
16373 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16374 @code{imtest}.
16375 @item
16376 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16377 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16378 @item
16379 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16380 @item
16381 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16382 @item
16383 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16384 @end itemize
16385
16386 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16387 @cindex expunging
16388 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16389 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16390 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16391 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16392 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16393 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16394 similar).
16395
16396 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16397 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16398 running in circles yet?
16399
16400 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16401 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16402 variable.
16403
16404 The possible options are:
16405
16406 @table @code
16407
16408 @item always
16409 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16410 closing a mailbox.
16411 @item never
16412 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16413 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16414 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16415 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16416 @item ask
16417 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16418 articles or not.
16419
16420 @end table
16421
16422 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16423 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16424
16425 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16426 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16427 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16428 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16429 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16430 has only one.)
16431
16432 Probably the only reason for frobbing this would be if you're trying
16433 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16434
16435 @lisp
16436 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16437 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16438 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16439 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16440 @end lisp
16441
16442 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16443 as ticked for other users.
16444
16445 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16446 @cindex expunging
16447 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16448
16449 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16450 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16451 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16452 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16453
16454 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16455 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16456 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16457 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16458
16459 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16460 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16461
16462 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16463 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16464 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16465 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16466
16467 @example
16468 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16469 @end example
16470
16471 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16472 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16473 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16474 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16475 @code{port imap}.
16476
16477 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16478 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16479
16480 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16481 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16482 Courier 1.7.1 did.
16483
16484 @end table
16485
16486 @menu
16487 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16488 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16489 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16490 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16491 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16492 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16493 @end menu
16494
16495
16496
16497 @node Splitting in IMAP
16498 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16499 @cindex splitting imap mail
16500
16501 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16502 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16503 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16504 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16505 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16506
16507 And it does.
16508
16509 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16510 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16511 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16512
16513 Here are the variables of interest:
16514
16515 @table @code
16516
16517 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16518 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16519 @cindex crosspost
16520 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16521
16522 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16523 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16524 found will be used.
16525
16526 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16527
16528 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16529 @cindex splitting, inbox
16530 @cindex inbox
16531 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16532
16533 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16534 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16535 splitting is disabled!
16536
16537 @lisp
16538 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16539 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16540 @end lisp
16541
16542 No nnmail equivalent.
16543
16544 @item nnimap-split-rule
16545 @cindex splitting, rules
16546 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16547
16548 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16549 this variable.
16550
16551 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16552 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16553 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16554 Neither did I, we need examples.
16555
16556 @lisp
16557 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16558 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
16559 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16560 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16561 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16562 @end lisp
16563
16564 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16565 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16566 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16567
16568 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16569 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16570 instance:
16571
16572 @lisp
16573 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16574 @end lisp
16575
16576 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16577 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16578
16579 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16580 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16581 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16582 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16583
16584 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16585 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16586 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16587 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16588 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16589 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16590
16591 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16592 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16593 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16594
16595 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16596 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16597 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16598
16599 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16600
16601 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16602 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16603 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16604
16605 @lisp
16606 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16607 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16608 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16609 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16610 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16611 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16612 @end lisp
16613
16614 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16615 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16616 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16617 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16618 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16619 group/function elements.
16620
16621 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16622
16623 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16624 @cindex splitting
16625 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16626
16627 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16628 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16629
16630 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16631 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16632 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16633 @samp{UNDELETED}.
16634
16635 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16636 @cindex splitting, fancy
16637 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16638 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16639
16640 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16641 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16642 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16643
16644 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16645 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16646 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16647 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16648
16649 Example:
16650
16651 @lisp
16652 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16653 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16654 @end lisp
16655
16656 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16657
16658 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16659 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16660 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16661
16662 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16663 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16664 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16665 splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
16666
16667 @end table
16668
16669 @node Expiring in IMAP
16670 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16671 @cindex expiring imap mail
16672
16673 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16674 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16675 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16676 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16677 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16678 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16679 process.
16680
16681 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16682 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16683 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16684 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16685 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16686 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16687 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16688 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16689
16690 @table @code
16691
16692 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16693 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16694
16695 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16696 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16697
16698 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16699
16700 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16701 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16702 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16703 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16704
16705 @end table
16706
16707 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16708 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16709 @cindex editing imap acls
16710 @cindex Access Control Lists
16711 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16712 @kindex G l (Group)
16713 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16714
16715 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16716 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16717 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16718 doesn't.
16719
16720 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16721 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16722 editing window with detailed instructions.
16723
16724 Some possible uses:
16725
16726 @itemize @bullet
16727 @item
16728 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16729 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16730 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16731 @item
16732 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16733 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16734 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16735 INBOX.mailbox).
16736 @end itemize
16737
16738 @node Expunging mailboxes
16739 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16740 @cindex expunging
16741
16742 @cindex expunge
16743 @cindex manual expunging
16744 @kindex G x (Group)
16745 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16746
16747 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16748 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16749 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16750
16751 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16752 delete them.
16753
16754 @node A note on namespaces
16755 @subsection A note on namespaces
16756 @cindex IMAP namespace
16757 @cindex namespaces
16758
16759 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16760 by the following text in the RFC2060:
16761
16762 @display
16763 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16764
16765 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16766 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16767 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16768 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
16769
16770 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
16771 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
16772 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
16773 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
16774 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
16775 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
16776 @end display
16777
16778 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
16779 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
16780 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
16781
16782 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
16783 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
16784 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
16785 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
16786 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
16787 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
16788 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
16789 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
16790 Gnus.
16791
16792 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
16793 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
16794 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
16795
16796 @node Debugging IMAP
16797 @subsection Debugging IMAP
16798 @cindex IMAP debugging
16799 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
16800
16801 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
16802 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
16803 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
16804 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
16805
16806 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
16807 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
16808 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
16809 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
16810 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
16811 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
16812 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
16813
16814
16815 @vindex imap-log
16816 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
16817 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
16818 follows:
16819
16820 @lisp
16821 (setq imap-log t)
16822 @end lisp
16823
16824 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
16825 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
16826 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
16827 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
16828 data.
16829
16830 @node Other Sources
16831 @section Other Sources
16832
16833 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
16834 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
16835 newsgroups.
16836
16837 @menu
16838 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
16839 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
16840 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
16841 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
16842 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
16843 @end menu
16844
16845
16846 @node Directory Groups
16847 @subsection Directory Groups
16848 @cindex nndir
16849 @cindex directory groups
16850
16851 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
16852 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
16853 names, of course.
16854
16855 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
16856 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
16857 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
16858 back end to read directories. Big deal.
16859
16860 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
16861 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
16862 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
16863 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
16864 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
16865
16866 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
16867
16868 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
16869 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
16870 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
16871 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
16872
16873
16874 @node Anything Groups
16875 @subsection Anything Groups
16876 @cindex nneething
16877
16878 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
16879 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
16880 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
16881 true.
16882
16883 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
16884 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
16885 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
16886 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
16887 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
16888 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
16889 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
16890 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
16891 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
16892 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
16893 elements.
16894
16895 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
16896 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
16897 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
16898 in the article buffer, just as usual.
16899
16900 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
16901 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
16902 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
16903 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
16904
16905 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
16906 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
16907 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
16908 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
16909 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
16910 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
16911 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
16912 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
16913
16914 Some variables:
16915
16916 @table @code
16917 @item nneething-map-file-directory
16918 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
16919 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
16920 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
16921
16922 @item nneething-exclude-files
16923 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
16924 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
16925 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
16926
16927 @item nneething-include-files
16928 @vindex nneething-include-files
16929 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
16930 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
16931
16932 @item nneething-map-file
16933 @vindex nneething-map-file
16934 Name of the map files.
16935 @end table
16936
16937
16938 @node Document Groups
16939 @subsection Document Groups
16940 @cindex nndoc
16941 @cindex documentation group
16942 @cindex help group
16943
16944 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
16945 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
16946
16947 @table @code
16948 @cindex Babyl
16949 @cindex Rmail mbox
16950 @item babyl
16951 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
16952
16953 @cindex mbox
16954 @cindex Unix mbox
16955 @item mbox
16956 The standard Unix mbox file.
16957
16958 @cindex MMDF mail box
16959 @item mmdf
16960 The MMDF mail box format.
16961
16962 @item news
16963 Several news articles appended into a file.
16964
16965 @cindex rnews batch files
16966 @item rnews
16967 The rnews batch transport format.
16968
16969 @item nsmail
16970 Netscape mail boxes.
16971
16972 @item mime-parts
16973 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
16974
16975 @item standard-digest
16976 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
16977
16978 @item mime-digest
16979 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
16980
16981 @item lanl-gov-announce
16982 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
16983
16984 @cindex forwarded messages
16985 @item rfc822-forward
16986 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
16987
16988 @item outlook
16989 The Outlook mail box.
16990
16991 @item oe-dbx
16992 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
16993
16994 @item exim-bounce
16995 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
16996
16997 @item forward
16998 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
16999
17000 @item rfc934
17001 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17002
17003 @item mailman
17004 A mailman digest.
17005
17006 @item clari-briefs
17007 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17008
17009 @item slack-digest
17010 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17011
17012 @item mail-in-mail
17013 The last resort.
17014 @end table
17015
17016 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17017 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17018 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17019 file is.
17020
17021 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17022 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17023 group. And that's it.
17024
17025 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17026 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17027 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17028 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17029 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17030 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17031 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17032 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17033 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17034 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17035
17036 Virtual server variables:
17037
17038 @table @code
17039 @item nndoc-article-type
17040 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17041 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17042 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17043 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17044 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17045 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17046
17047 @item nndoc-post-type
17048 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17049 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17050 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17051 and @code{news}.
17052 @end table
17053
17054 @menu
17055 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17056 @end menu
17057
17058
17059 @node Document Server Internals
17060 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17061
17062 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17063 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17064 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17065 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17066
17067 First, here's an example document type definition:
17068
17069 @example
17070 (mmdf
17071 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17072 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17073 @end example
17074
17075 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17076 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17077 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17078 types can be defined with very few settings:
17079
17080 @table @code
17081 @item first-article
17082 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17083 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17084 totally ignored.
17085
17086 @item article-begin
17087 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17088 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17089 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17090 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17091
17092 @item article-begin-function
17093 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17094 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17095
17096 @item head-begin
17097 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17098 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17099 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17100
17101 @item head-begin-function
17102 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17103 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17104
17105 @item head-end
17106 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17107 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17108
17109 @item body-begin
17110 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17111 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17112 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17113
17114 @item body-begin-function
17115 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17116 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17117
17118 @item body-end
17119 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17120 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17121 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17122
17123 @item body-end-function
17124 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17125 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17126
17127 @item file-begin
17128 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17129 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17130
17131 @item file-end
17132 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17133 regexp will be totally ignored.
17134
17135 @end table
17136
17137 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17138 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17139 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17140 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17141 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17142
17143 @table @code
17144 @item prepare-body-function
17145 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17146 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17147 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17148
17149 @item article-transform-function
17150 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17151 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17152 body of the article.
17153
17154 @item generate-head-function
17155 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17156 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17157 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17158 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17159
17160 @item generate-article-function
17161 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17162 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17163 parameter when requesting all articles.
17164
17165 @item dissection-function
17166 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17167 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17168 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17169 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17170 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17171 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17172
17173 @end table
17174
17175 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17176 digests:
17177
17178 @example
17179 (standard-digest
17180 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17181 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17182 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17183 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17184 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17185 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17186 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17187 (subtype digest guess))
17188 @end example
17189
17190 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17191 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17192 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17193 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17194 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17195
17196 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17197 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17198 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17199 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17200 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17201 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17202 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17203 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17204 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17205 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17206 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17207 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17208
17209
17210 @node SOUP
17211 @subsection SOUP
17212 @cindex SOUP
17213 @cindex offline
17214
17215 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
17216 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
17217 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
17218
17219 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
17220 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
17221 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
17222 newsreaders.
17223
17224 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
17225 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
17226 that interested in doing things properly.
17227
17228 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17229 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17230 fiddly.
17231
17232 First some terminology:
17233
17234 @table @dfn
17235
17236 @item server
17237 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17238 get news and/or mail from.
17239
17240 @item home machine
17241 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17242 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17243
17244 @item packet
17245 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17246 of packets:
17247
17248 @table @dfn
17249 @item message packets
17250 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17251 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17252 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17253
17254 @item response packets
17255 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17256 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17257 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17258
17259 @end table
17260
17261 @end table
17262
17263
17264 @enumerate
17265
17266 @item
17267 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17268 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17269 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17270 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17271
17272 @item
17273 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17274
17275 @item
17276 You put the packet in your home directory.
17277
17278 @item
17279 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17280 the native or secondary server.
17281
17282 @item
17283 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17284 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17285
17286 @item
17287 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17288 packet.
17289
17290 @item
17291 You transfer this packet to the server.
17292
17293 @item
17294 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17295
17296 @item
17297 You then repeat until you die.
17298
17299 @end enumerate
17300
17301 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17302 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17303
17304 @menu
17305 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17306 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17307 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17308 @end menu
17309
17310
17311 @node SOUP Commands
17312 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17313
17314 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17315
17316 @table @kbd
17317 @item G s b
17318 @kindex G s b (Group)
17319 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17320 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17321 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17322 process/prefix convention.
17323
17324 @item G s w
17325 @kindex G s w (Group)
17326 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17327 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17328
17329 @item G s s
17330 @kindex G s s (Group)
17331 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17332 Send all replies from the replies packet
17333 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17334
17335 @item G s p
17336 @kindex G s p (Group)
17337 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17338 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17339
17340 @item G s r
17341 @kindex G s r (Group)
17342 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17343 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17344
17345 @item O s
17346 @kindex O s (Summary)
17347 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17348 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17349 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17350 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17351
17352 @end table
17353
17354
17355 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17356 thingies:
17357
17358 @table @code
17359
17360 @item gnus-soup-directory
17361 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17362 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17363 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17364
17365 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17366 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17367 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17368 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17369
17370 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17371 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17372 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17373 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17374
17375 @item gnus-soup-packer
17376 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17377 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17378 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17379
17380 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17381 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17382 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17383 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17384
17385 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17386 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17387 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17388
17389 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17390 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17391 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17392 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17393
17394 @end table
17395
17396
17397 @node SOUP Groups
17398 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17399 @cindex nnsoup
17400
17401 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17402 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17403 you can read them at leisure.
17404
17405 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17406
17407 @table @code
17408
17409 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17410 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17411 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17412 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17413
17414 @item nnsoup-directory
17415 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17416 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17417 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17418
17419 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17420 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17421 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17422 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17423
17424 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17425 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17426 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17427 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17428 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17429
17430 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17431 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17432 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17433 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17434
17435 @item nnsoup-active-file
17436 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17437 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17438 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17439 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17440 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17441
17442 @item nnsoup-packer
17443 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17444 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17445 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17446
17447 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17448 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17449 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17450 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17451
17452 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17453 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17454 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17455 @file{~/}.
17456
17457 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17458 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17459 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17460 @samp{Soupout}.
17461
17462 @item nnsoup-always-save
17463 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17464 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17465
17466 @end table
17467
17468
17469 @node SOUP Replies
17470 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17471
17472 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17473 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17474 more for that to happen.
17475
17476 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17477 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17478 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17479 @sc{soup} system.
17480
17481 In specific, this is what it does:
17482
17483 @lisp
17484 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17485 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17486 @end lisp
17487
17488 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17489 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17490 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17491
17492
17493 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17494 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17495 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17496 @cindex gateways
17497
17498 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17499 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17500 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17501
17502 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17503 used to post with.
17504
17505 Server variables:
17506
17507 @table @code
17508 @item nngateway-address
17509 @vindex nngateway-address
17510 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17511
17512 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17513 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17514 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17515 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17516 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17517 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17518 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17519 gateway address.
17520
17521 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17522 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17523 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17524
17525 @example
17526 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17527 @end example
17528
17529 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17530
17531 @example
17532 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17533 @end example
17534
17535 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17536
17537 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17538 @table @code
17539
17540 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17541 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17542 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17543
17544 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17545
17546 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17547 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17548 @code{nngateway-address}.
17549 @end table
17550
17551 @end table
17552
17553 Here's an example:
17554
17555 @lisp
17556 (setq gnus-post-method
17557 '(nngateway
17558 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17559 (nngateway-header-transformation
17560 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17561 @end lisp
17562
17563 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17564
17565 @lisp
17566 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17567 @end lisp
17568
17569
17570
17571 @node Combined Groups
17572 @section Combined Groups
17573
17574 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17575 groups.
17576
17577 @menu
17578 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17579 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17580 @end menu
17581
17582
17583 @node Virtual Groups
17584 @subsection Virtual Groups
17585 @cindex nnvirtual
17586 @cindex virtual groups
17587 @cindex merging groups
17588
17589 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17590 other groups.
17591
17592 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17593 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17594 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17595
17596 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17597 regexp to match component groups.
17598
17599 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17600 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17601 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17602 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17603 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17604 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17605 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17606 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17607
17608 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17609 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17610
17611 @lisp
17612 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17613 @end lisp
17614
17615 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17616 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17617
17618 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17619 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17620 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17621 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17622
17623 @example
17624 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17625 @end example
17626
17627 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17628 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17629 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17630
17631 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17632 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17633 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17634 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17635 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17636
17637 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17638 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17639 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17640
17641 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17642 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17643 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17644 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17645 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17646 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17647 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17648 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17649 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17650 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17651 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17652
17653 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17654 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17655 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17656 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17657 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17658 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17659 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17660
17661 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17662 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17663
17664 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17665 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17666 inherited.
17667
17668
17669 @node Kibozed Groups
17670 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17671 @cindex nnkiboze
17672 @cindex kibozing
17673
17674 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17675 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17676 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17677 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17678
17679 @kindex G k (Group)
17680 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17681 buffer.
17682
17683 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17684 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17685 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17686 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17687
17688 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17689 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17690 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17691
17692 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17693 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17694 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17695 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17696 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17697 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17698 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17699 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17700
17701 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17702 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17703 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17704 Stranger things have happened.
17705
17706 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17707 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17708
17709 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17710 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17711 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17712 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17713 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17714 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17715 component articles.
17716
17717 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17718 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17719
17720
17721 @node Gnus Unplugged
17722 @section Gnus Unplugged
17723 @cindex offline
17724 @cindex unplugged
17725 @cindex agent
17726 @cindex Gnus agent
17727 @cindex Gnus unplugged
17728
17729 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
17730 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
17731 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
17732 read news. Believe it or not.
17733
17734 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
17735 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
17736 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
17737 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
17738 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
17739
17740 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
17741 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
17742 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
17743 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
17744 reading news on a machine.
17745
17746 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
17747 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
17748
17749 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
17750
17751 @menu
17752 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
17753 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
17754 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
17755 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
17756 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
17757 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
17758 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
17759 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
17760 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
17761 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
17762 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
17763 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
17764 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
17765 @end menu
17766
17767
17768 @node Agent Basics
17769 @subsection Agent Basics
17770
17771 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
17772
17773 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
17774 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
17775 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
17776 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
17777
17778 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
17779 connected to the net continuously.
17780
17781 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
17782 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
17783
17784 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
17785 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
17786 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
17787 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
17788 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
17789
17790 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
17791 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
17792 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
17793 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
17794 they're kinda like plugged always).
17795
17796 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
17797 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
17798 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
17799 the culprit.
17800
17801 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
17802 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
17803 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
17804 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
17805 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
17806
17807 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
17808
17809 @itemize @bullet
17810
17811 @item
17812 @findex gnus-unplugged
17813 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
17814 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
17815 already fetched while in this mode.
17816
17817 @item
17818 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
17819 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
17820 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
17821 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
17822 Source Specifiers}).
17823
17824 @item
17825 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
17826 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
17827 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
17828 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
17829 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
17830
17831 @item
17832 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
17833 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
17834 then you read the news offline.
17835
17836 @item
17837 And then you go to step 2.
17838 @end itemize
17839
17840 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
17841 the Agent.
17842
17843 @itemize @bullet
17844
17845 @item
17846 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
17847 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
17848 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
17849 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
17850 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
17851 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
17852 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
17853 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
17854
17855 @item
17856 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
17857 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
17858 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
17859 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
17860
17861 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
17862 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
17863 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
17864 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
17865 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
17866 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
17867 configure them.
17868
17869 @item
17870 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
17871 @end itemize
17872
17873
17874 @node Agent Categories
17875 @subsection Agent Categories
17876
17877 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
17878 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
17879 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
17880 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
17881 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
17882 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
17883 you're interested in the articles anyway.
17884
17885 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
17886 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
17887 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
17888 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
17889 buffer for creating and managing categories.
17890
17891 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
17892 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
17893 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
17894 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
17895 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
17896 sink.
17897
17898 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
17899 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
17900 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
17901 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
17902 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
17903 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
17904 your settings.
17905
17906 @menu
17907 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
17908 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
17909 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
17910 @end menu
17911
17912
17913 @node Category Syntax
17914 @subsubsection Category Syntax
17915
17916 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
17917 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
17918 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
17919 listed below.
17920
17921 @cindex Agent Parameters
17922 @table @code
17923 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
17924 The name of the category.
17925
17926 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
17927 The list of groups that are in this category.
17928
17929 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
17930 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
17931 are eligible for downloading; and
17932
17933 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
17934 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
17935 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
17936 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
17937
17938 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
17939 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
17940 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
17941 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
17942 only groups that should not be expired.
17943
17944 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
17945 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
17946 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
17947
17948 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
17949 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
17950
17951 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
17952 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
17953
17954 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
17955 an integer that overrides the value of
17956 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
17957
17958 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
17959 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
17960
17961 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
17962 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
17963 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17964 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
17965 @c all other symbols disable them.
17966
17967 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
17968 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
17969 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
17970 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
17971 all other symbols enable them.
17972 @end table
17973
17974 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
17975 created.
17976
17977 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
17978 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
17979 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
17980 category.
17981
17982 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
17983 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
17984 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
17985 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
17986
17987 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
17988 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
17989 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
17990
17991 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
17992 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
17993 operators sprinkled in between.
17994
17995 Perhaps some examples are in order.
17996
17997 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
17998 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
17999
18000 @lisp
18001 short
18002 @end lisp
18003
18004 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18005 short (for some value of ``short'').
18006
18007 Here's a more complex predicate:
18008
18009 @lisp
18010 (or high
18011 (and
18012 (not low)
18013 (not long)))
18014 @end lisp
18015
18016 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18017 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18018 drift.
18019
18020 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18021 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18022 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18023
18024 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18025 you want to do, you can write your own.
18026
18027 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18028 bound to the value determined by calling
18029 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18030 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18031 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18032 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18033 predicate to individual groups.
18034
18035 @table @code
18036 @item short
18037 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18038 lines; default 100.
18039
18040 @item long
18041 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18042 lines; default 200.
18043
18044 @item low
18045 True iff the article has a download score less than
18046 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18047
18048 @item high
18049 True iff the article has a download score greater than
18050 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18051
18052 @item spam
18053 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18054 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18055 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18056
18057 @item true
18058 Always true.
18059
18060 @item false
18061 Always false.
18062 @end table
18063
18064 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18065 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18066 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18067 useful values.
18068
18069 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18070 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
18071 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18072 something along the lines of the following:
18073
18074 @lisp
18075 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18076 "Say whether an article is old."
18077 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18078 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18079 @end lisp
18080
18081 with the predicate then defined as:
18082
18083 @lisp
18084 (not my-article-old-p)
18085 @end lisp
18086
18087 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18088 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18089 wherever.
18090
18091 @lisp
18092 (require 'gnus-agent)
18093 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18094 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18095 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18096 @end lisp
18097
18098 and simply specify your predicate as:
18099
18100 @lisp
18101 (not old)
18102 @end lisp
18103
18104 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18105 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18106 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18107 just don't give a damn.
18108
18109 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18110 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18111 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18112 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18113 parameters like so:
18114
18115 @lisp
18116 (agent-predicate . short)
18117 @end lisp
18118
18119 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18120 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18121 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18122
18123 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18124
18125 @lisp
18126 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18127 @end lisp
18128
18129 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18130 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18131 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18132
18133
18134 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18135 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18136 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18137 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18138 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18139 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18140
18141 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18142 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18143 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18144 if it's to be specific to that group.
18145
18146 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18147 three forms:
18148
18149 @enumerate
18150 @item
18151 Score rule
18152
18153 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18154 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18155
18156 example:
18157
18158 @itemize @bullet
18159 @item
18160 Category specification
18161
18162 @lisp
18163 (("from"
18164 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18165 ("lines"
18166 (500 -100 nil <)))
18167 @end lisp
18168
18169 @item
18170 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18171
18172 @lisp
18173 (agent-score ("from"
18174 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18175 ("lines"
18176 (500 -100 nil <)))
18177 @end lisp
18178
18179 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18180 @end itemize
18181
18182 @item
18183 Agent score file
18184
18185 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18186 keywords stated above.
18187
18188 example:
18189
18190 @itemize @bullet
18191 @item
18192 Category specification
18193
18194 @lisp
18195 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18196 @end lisp
18197
18198 or perhaps
18199
18200 @lisp
18201 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18202 @end lisp
18203
18204 @item
18205 Group Parameter specification
18206
18207 @lisp
18208 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18209 @end lisp
18210
18211 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18212 about parenthesis?
18213 @end itemize
18214
18215 @item
18216 Use @code{normal} score files
18217
18218 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18219 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18220 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18221 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18222
18223 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18224 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18225 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18226 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18227
18228 @itemize @bullet
18229 @item
18230 Category Specification
18231
18232 @lisp
18233 file
18234 @end lisp
18235
18236 @item
18237 Group Parameter specification
18238
18239 @lisp
18240 (agent-score . file)
18241 @end lisp
18242 @end itemize
18243 @end enumerate
18244
18245 @node Category Buffer
18246 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18247
18248 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18249 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18250 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18251
18252 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18253
18254 @table @kbd
18255 @item q
18256 @kindex q (Category)
18257 @findex gnus-category-exit
18258 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18259
18260 @item e
18261 @kindex e (Category)
18262 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18263 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18264 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18265
18266 @item k
18267 @kindex k (Category)
18268 @findex gnus-category-kill
18269 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18270
18271 @item c
18272 @kindex c (Category)
18273 @findex gnus-category-copy
18274 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18275
18276 @item a
18277 @kindex a (Category)
18278 @findex gnus-category-add
18279 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18280
18281 @item p
18282 @kindex p (Category)
18283 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18284 Edit the predicate of the current category
18285 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18286
18287 @item g
18288 @kindex g (Category)
18289 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18290 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18291 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18292
18293 @item s
18294 @kindex s (Category)
18295 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18296 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18297 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18298
18299 @item l
18300 @kindex l (Category)
18301 @findex gnus-category-list
18302 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18303 @end table
18304
18305
18306 @node Category Variables
18307 @subsubsection Category Variables
18308
18309 @table @code
18310 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18311 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18312 Hook run in category buffers.
18313
18314 @item gnus-category-line-format
18315 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18316 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18317 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18318
18319 @table @samp
18320 @item c
18321 The name of the category.
18322
18323 @item g
18324 The number of groups in the category.
18325 @end table
18326
18327 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18328 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18329 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18330
18331 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18332 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18333 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18334
18335 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18336 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18337 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18338
18339 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18340 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18341 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18342 0.
18343
18344 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18345 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18346 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18347 0.
18348
18349 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18350 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18351 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18352 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18353 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18354 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18355 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18356 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18357 read.
18358 Default 7.
18359
18360 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18361 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18362 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18363 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18364 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18365 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18366 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18367
18368 @end table
18369
18370
18371 @node Agent Commands
18372 @subsection Agent Commands
18373 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18374 @kindex J j (Agent)
18375
18376 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18377 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18378 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18379
18380
18381 @menu
18382 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18383 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18384 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18385 @end menu
18386
18387
18388
18389
18390 @node Group Agent Commands
18391 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18392
18393 @table @kbd
18394 @item J u
18395 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18396 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18397 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18398 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18399
18400 @item J c
18401 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18402 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18403 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18404
18405 @item J s
18406 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18407 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18408 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18409 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18410
18411 @item J S
18412 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18413 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18414 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18415 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18416
18417 @item J a
18418 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18419 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18420 Add the current group to an Agent category
18421 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18422 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18423
18424 @item J r
18425 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18426 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18427 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18428 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18429 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18430
18431 @item J Y
18432 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18433 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18434 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18435
18436
18437 @end table
18438
18439
18440 @node Summary Agent Commands
18441 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18442
18443 @table @kbd
18444 @item J #
18445 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18446 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18447 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18448
18449 @item J M-#
18450 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18451 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18452 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18453 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18454
18455 @cindex %
18456 @item @@
18457 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18458 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18459 Toggle whether to download the article
18460 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18461 default.
18462
18463 @item J c
18464 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18465 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18466 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18467
18468 @item J S
18469 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18470 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18471 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18472 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18473
18474 @item J s
18475 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18476 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
18477 Download all processable articles in this group.
18478 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
18479
18480 @item J u
18481 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18482 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18483 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18484 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18485
18486 @end table
18487
18488
18489 @node Server Agent Commands
18490 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18491
18492 @table @kbd
18493 @item J a
18494 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18495 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18496 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18497 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18498
18499 @item J r
18500 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18501 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18502 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18503 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18504
18505 @end table
18506
18507
18508 @node Agent Visuals
18509 @subsection Agent Visuals
18510
18511 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18512 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18513 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18514 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18515 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18516 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18517 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18518 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18519 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18520 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18521
18522 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18523 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18524 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18525 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18526 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18527 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18528 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18529 articles will be available when unplugged.
18530
18531 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18532 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18533 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18534 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18535 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18536 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18537 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18538 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18539
18540 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18541 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18542 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18543 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18544 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18545 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18546 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18547 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18548 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18549
18550 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18551 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18552 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18553 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18554 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
18555
18556 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
18557 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
18558 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
18559 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
18560 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
18561 disable the undownload faces by customizing
18562 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
18563 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second,
18564 if you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
18565 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to @code{t}.
18566 This parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an
18567 Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
18568 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18569
18570 @node Agent as Cache
18571 @subsection Agent as Cache
18572
18573 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18574 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18575 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18576 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18577 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18578 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18579 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18580 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18581 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18582
18583 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18584 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18585 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18586 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18587 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18588
18589 @node Agent Expiry
18590 @subsection Agent Expiry
18591
18592 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18593 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18594 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18595 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18596 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18597 @cindex agent expiry
18598 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18599 @cindex expiry
18600
18601 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18602 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18603 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18604 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18605 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18606 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18607 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18608 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18609
18610 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
18611 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
18612 synchronized with the group.
18613
18614 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18615 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18616
18617 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18618 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18619 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18620 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18621 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18622 be kept indefinitely.
18623
18624 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18625 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18626 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18627 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18628
18629 @node Agent Regeneration
18630 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18631
18632 @cindex agent regeneration
18633 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18634 @cindex regeneration
18635
18636 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18637 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18638 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18639 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18640 internal inconsistencies.
18641
18642 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18643 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18644 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18645 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18646 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18647 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18648
18649 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18650 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18651 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18652 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18653 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18654 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18655
18656 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18657 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18658 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18659 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18660 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18661 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18662 agent as unread.
18663
18664 @node Agent and IMAP
18665 @subsection Agent and IMAP
18666
18667 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
18668 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
18669 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
18670 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
18671
18672 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
18673 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
18674 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
18675 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
18676
18677 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
18678 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
18679 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
18680 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
18681
18682 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18683 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
18684 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
18685 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
18686 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
18687 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
18688
18689 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
18690 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
18691 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
18692 in the group buffer.
18693
18694 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
18695 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
18696
18697 @itemize @bullet
18698
18699 @item
18700 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
18701
18702 @item
18703 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
18704
18705 @end itemize
18706
18707 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
18708 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
18709 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
18710 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
18711 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
18712 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
18713 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
18714 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
18715
18716
18717 @node Outgoing Messages
18718 @subsection Outgoing Messages
18719
18720 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
18721 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
18722 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
18723
18724 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
18725 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
18726 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
18727 messages in the draft group.
18728
18729
18730
18731 @node Agent Variables
18732 @subsection Agent Variables
18733
18734 @table @code
18735 @item gnus-agent-directory
18736 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
18737 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
18738 @file{~/News/agent/}.
18739
18740 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
18741 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
18742 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
18743 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
18744 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
18745 by default.
18746
18747 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18748 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
18749 Hook run when connecting to the network.
18750
18751 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18752 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
18753 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
18754
18755 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18756 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
18757 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
18758
18759 @item gnus-agent-cache
18760 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
18761 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
18762 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
18763 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
18764
18765 @item gnus-agent-go-online
18766 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
18767 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
18768 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
18769 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
18770 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
18771 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
18772 online status.
18773
18774 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18775 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
18776 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
18777 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
18778 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
18779 read. The default is @code{t}.
18780
18781 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18782 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
18783 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
18784 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
18785 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
18786 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
18787 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
18788 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
18789 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
18790 over and over again.
18791
18792 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18793 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
18794 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
18795 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
18796 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
18797 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
18798 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
18799 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
18800 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
18801 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
18802 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
18803 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
18804 see any cycling.
18805
18806 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
18807 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
18808 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
18809 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
18810 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
18811 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
18812 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
18813 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
18814 is only valid if the Agent is used.
18815
18816 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18817 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
18818 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
18819 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
18820 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
18821 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
18822
18823 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
18824 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
18825 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
18826 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
18827 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
18828
18829 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18830 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
18831 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
18832 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
18833 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
18834 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
18835 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
18836 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
18837 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
18838 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
18839 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
18840
18841 @end table
18842
18843
18844 @node Example Setup
18845 @subsection Example Setup
18846
18847 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
18848 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
18849 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
18850
18851 @lisp
18852 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
18853 ;;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
18854 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
18855
18856 ;;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
18857 ;;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
18858 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
18859
18860 ;;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
18861 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
18862
18863 ;;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
18864 ;;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
18865 ;;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
18866 @end lisp
18867
18868 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
18869 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
18870 gnus}.
18871
18872 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
18873 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
18874 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
18875 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
18876 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
18877 once.
18878
18879 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
18880 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
18881 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
18882 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
18883 back all the killed groups.)
18884
18885 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
18886 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
18887 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
18888
18889
18890 @node Batching Agents
18891 @subsection Batching Agents
18892 @findex gnus-agent-batch
18893
18894 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
18895 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
18896 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
18897
18898 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
18899 following incantation:
18900
18901 @example
18902 #!/bin/sh
18903 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
18904 @end example
18905
18906
18907 @node Agent Caveats
18908 @subsection Agent Caveats
18909
18910 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
18911 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
18912 may ask:
18913
18914 @table @dfn
18915 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
18916
18917 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
18918 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
18919 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
18920
18921 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
18922 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
18923
18924 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
18925
18926 @end table
18927
18928 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
18929 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
18930 locally stored articles.
18931
18932
18933 @node Scoring
18934 @chapter Scoring
18935 @cindex scoring
18936
18937 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
18938 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
18939 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
18940 attention!
18941
18942 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
18943 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
18944 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
18945 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
18946 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
18947
18948 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
18949 before generating the summary buffer.
18950
18951 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
18952 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
18953 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
18954
18955 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
18956 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
18957 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
18958 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
18959
18960 @menu
18961 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
18962 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
18963 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
18964 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
18965 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
18966 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
18967 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
18968 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
18969 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
18970 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
18971 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
18972 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
18973 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
18974 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
18975 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
18976 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
18977 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
18978 @end menu
18979
18980
18981 @node Summary Score Commands
18982 @section Summary Score Commands
18983 @cindex score commands
18984
18985 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
18986 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
18987 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
18988 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
18989 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
18990
18991 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
18992 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
18993 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
18994 score file the current one.
18995
18996 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
18997
18998 @table @kbd
18999
19000 @item V s
19001 @kindex V s (Summary)
19002 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19003 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19004
19005 @item V S
19006 @kindex V S (Summary)
19007 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19008 Display the score of the current article
19009 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19010
19011 @item V t
19012 @kindex V t (Summary)
19013 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19014 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19015 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19016 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19017 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19018 score file and edit it.
19019
19020 @item V w
19021 @kindex V w (Summary)
19022 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19023 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19024
19025 @item V R
19026 @kindex V R (Summary)
19027 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19028 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19029 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19030 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19031 effect you're having.
19032
19033 @item V c
19034 @kindex V c (Summary)
19035 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19036 Make a different score file the current
19037 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19038
19039 @item V e
19040 @kindex V e (Summary)
19041 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19042 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19043 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19044 File Editing}).
19045
19046 @item V f
19047 @kindex V f (Summary)
19048 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19049 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19050 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19051
19052 @item V F
19053 @kindex V F (Summary)
19054 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19055 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19056 after editing score files.
19057
19058 @item V C
19059 @kindex V C (Summary)
19060 @findex gnus-score-customize
19061 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19062 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19063
19064 @end table
19065
19066 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19067
19068 @table @kbd
19069
19070 @item V m
19071 @kindex V m (Summary)
19072 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19073 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19074 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19075
19076 @item V x
19077 @kindex V x (Summary)
19078 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19079 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19080 expunge all articles below this score
19081 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19082 @end table
19083
19084 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19085 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19086 them.)
19087
19088 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19089 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19090
19091 @enumerate
19092 @item
19093 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19094 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19095 @item
19096 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19097 keys are available:
19098 @table @kbd
19099
19100 @item a
19101 Score on the author name.
19102
19103 @item s
19104 Score on the subject line.
19105
19106 @item x
19107 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19108
19109 @item r
19110 Score on the @code{References} line.
19111
19112 @item d
19113 Score on the date.
19114
19115 @item l
19116 Score on the number of lines.
19117
19118 @item i
19119 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19120
19121 @item e
19122 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19123 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19124
19125 @item f
19126 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19127 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19128 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19129
19130 @item b
19131 Score on the body.
19132
19133 @item h
19134 Score on the head.
19135
19136 @item t
19137 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19138 files.)
19139
19140 @end table
19141
19142 @item
19143 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19144 what headers you are scoring on.
19145
19146 @table @code
19147
19148 @item strings
19149
19150 @table @kbd
19151
19152 @item e
19153 Exact matching.
19154
19155 @item s
19156 Substring matching.
19157
19158 @item f
19159 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19160
19161 @item r
19162 Regexp matching
19163 @end table
19164
19165 @item date
19166 @table @kbd
19167
19168 @item b
19169 Before date.
19170
19171 @item a
19172 After date.
19173
19174 @item n
19175 This date.
19176 @end table
19177
19178 @item number
19179 @table @kbd
19180
19181 @item <
19182 Less than number.
19183
19184 @item =
19185 Equal to number.
19186
19187 @item >
19188 Greater than number.
19189 @end table
19190 @end table
19191
19192 @item
19193 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19194 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19195 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19196 file.
19197 @table @kbd
19198
19199 @item t
19200 Temporary score entry.
19201
19202 @item p
19203 Permanent score entry.
19204
19205 @item i
19206 Immediately scoring.
19207 @end table
19208
19209 @item
19210 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19211 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19212 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19213
19214 @end enumerate
19215
19216 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19217 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19218 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19219 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19220
19221 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19222 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19223 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19224 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19225 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19226
19227 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19228 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19229 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19230 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19231 current score file.
19232
19233 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19234 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19235 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19236
19237
19238 @node Group Score Commands
19239 @section Group Score Commands
19240 @cindex group score commands
19241
19242 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19243
19244 @table @kbd
19245
19246 @item W f
19247 @kindex W f (Group)
19248 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19249 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19250 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19251 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19252
19253 @end table
19254
19255 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19256
19257 @findex gnus-batch-score
19258 @cindex batch scoring
19259 @example
19260 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19261 @end example
19262
19263
19264 @node Score Variables
19265 @section Score Variables
19266 @cindex score variables
19267
19268 @table @code
19269
19270 @item gnus-use-scoring
19271 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19272 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19273 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19274
19275 @item gnus-kill-killed
19276 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19277 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19278 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19279 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19280 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19281 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19282 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19283
19284 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19285 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19286 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19287 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19288 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19289
19290 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19291 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19292 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19293 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19294
19295 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19296 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19297 @cindex score cache
19298 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19299 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19300 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19301 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19302 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19303 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19304 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19305 be cached.
19306
19307 @item gnus-save-score
19308 @vindex gnus-save-score
19309 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19310 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19311 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19312
19313 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19314 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19315 across group visits.
19316
19317 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19318 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19319 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19320 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19321 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19322 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19323 manually entered data.
19324
19325 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19326 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19327 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19328
19329 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19330 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19331 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19332 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19333 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19334 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19335
19336 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19337 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19338 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19339 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19340
19341 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19342 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19343 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19344 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19345
19346 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19347 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19348 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19349 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19350
19351 Predefined functions available are:
19352 @table @code
19353
19354 @item gnus-score-find-single
19355 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19356 Only apply the group's own score file.
19357
19358 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19359 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19360 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19361 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19362 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19363 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19364 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19365 then a regexp match is done.
19366
19367 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19368 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19369
19370 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19371 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19372 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19373 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19374
19375 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19376 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19377 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19378 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19379 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19380 server.
19381
19382 @end table
19383 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19384 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19385 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19386 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19387 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19388 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19389 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19390 Phu.
19391
19392 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19393 overall score file, you could use the value
19394 @example
19395 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19396 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19397 @end example
19398
19399 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19400 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19401 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19402 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19403 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19404
19405 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19406 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19407 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19408 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19409 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19410 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19411 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19412 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19413
19414 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19415 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19416 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19417
19418 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19419 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19420 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19421 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19422 threading---according to the current value of
19423 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19424 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19425 simplified in this manner.
19426
19427 @end table
19428
19429
19430 @node Score File Format
19431 @section Score File Format
19432 @cindex score file format
19433
19434 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19435 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19436 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19437
19438 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19439
19440 @lisp
19441 (("from"
19442 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19443 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19444 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19445 ("subject"
19446 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19447 ("xref"
19448 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19449 ("lines"
19450 (2 -100 nil <))
19451 (mark 0)
19452 (expunge -1000)
19453 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19454 (read-only nil)
19455 (orphan -10)
19456 (adapt t)
19457 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19458 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19459 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19460 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19461 (eval (ding)))
19462 @end lisp
19463
19464 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19465 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19466
19467 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19468 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19469 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19470
19471 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19472
19473 @table @code
19474
19475 @item STRING
19476 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19477 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19478 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19479 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19480 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19481 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19482 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19483 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19484 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19485 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19486 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19487 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19488 to articles that matches these score entries.
19489
19490 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19491 score entry has one to four elements.
19492 @enumerate
19493
19494 @item
19495 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19496 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19497 integer.
19498
19499 @item
19500 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19501 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19502 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19503 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19504 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19505 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19506
19507 @item
19508 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19509 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19510 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19511 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19512 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19513
19514 @item
19515 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19516 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19517 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19518 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19519 @table @dfn
19520
19521 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19522 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19523 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19524 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19525 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19526 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19527 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19528 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19529 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19530 instead, if you feel like.
19531
19532 @item Extra
19533 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19534 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19535 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19536 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19537 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19538 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19539 overviews:
19540
19541 @lisp
19542 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19543 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19544 @end lisp
19545
19546 @item Lines, Chars
19547 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19548 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19549
19550 These predicates are true if
19551
19552 @example
19553 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19554 @end example
19555
19556 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19557 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19558 following form:
19559
19560 @lisp
19561 (< header-value 4)
19562 @end lisp
19563
19564 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19565 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19566 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19567 it's not. I think.)
19568
19569 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19570 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19571 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19572 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19573
19574 @item Date
19575 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19576 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19577 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19578 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19579 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19580 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19581 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19582
19583 @cindex ISO8601
19584 @cindex date
19585 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19586 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19587 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19588 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19589 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19590 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19591 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19592 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19593 whole family, eh?)
19594
19595 @item Head, Body, All
19596 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19597 header uses.
19598
19599 @item Followup
19600 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19601 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19602 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19603 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19604 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19605 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19606 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19607 files.)
19608
19609 @item Thread
19610 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19611 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19612 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19613 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19614 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19615 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19616 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19617 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19618 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19619 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19620 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19621 @end table
19622 @end enumerate
19623
19624 @cindex score file atoms
19625 @item mark
19626 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19627 lower than this number will be marked as read.
19628
19629 @item expunge
19630 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19631 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
19632
19633 @item mark-and-expunge
19634 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
19635 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
19636 summary buffer.
19637
19638 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
19639 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
19640 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
19641 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
19642 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
19643
19644 @item files
19645 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
19646 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
19647 this one was.
19648
19649 @item exclude-files
19650 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
19651 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
19652 other.
19653
19654 @item eval
19655 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
19656 ignored when handling global score files.
19657
19658 @item read-only
19659 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
19660 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
19661 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
19662 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
19663
19664 @item orphan
19665 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
19666 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
19667 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
19668 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
19669
19670 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
19671
19672 @example
19673 (orphan -500)
19674 (mark-and-expunge -100)
19675 @end example
19676
19677 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
19678 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
19679 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
19680 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
19681 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
19682
19683 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
19684 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
19685 scoring rules exist.
19686
19687 @item adapt
19688 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
19689 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
19690 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
19691 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
19692 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
19693 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
19694 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19695 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
19696 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
19697 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
19698 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
19699 it.
19700
19701 @item adapt-file
19702 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
19703 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
19704 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
19705 file for a number of groups.
19706
19707 @item local
19708 @cindex local variables
19709 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
19710 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
19711 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
19712 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
19713 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
19714 be evaluated.
19715 @end table
19716
19717
19718 @node Score File Editing
19719 @section Score File Editing
19720
19721 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
19722 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
19723 with a mode for that.
19724
19725 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
19726 additional commands:
19727
19728 @table @kbd
19729
19730 @item C-c C-c
19731 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
19732 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
19733 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
19734 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
19735
19736 @item C-c C-d
19737 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
19738 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
19739 Insert the current date in numerical format
19740 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
19741 you were wondering.
19742
19743 @item C-c C-p
19744 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
19745 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
19746 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
19747 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
19748 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
19749 you.
19750
19751 @end table
19752
19753 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
19754
19755 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
19756 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
19757
19758 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
19759 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
19760
19761
19762 @node Adaptive Scoring
19763 @section Adaptive Scoring
19764 @cindex adaptive scoring
19765
19766 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
19767 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
19768 stupidity, to be precise.
19769
19770 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
19771 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
19772 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
19773 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
19774 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
19775 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
19776 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
19777 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
19778 variable to @code{(word line)}.
19779
19780 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19781 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
19782 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
19783 might look something like this:
19784
19785 @lisp
19786 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
19787 '((gnus-unread-mark)
19788 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
19789 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
19790 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
19791 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
19792 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
19793 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
19794 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
19795 (gnus-ancient-mark)
19796 (gnus-low-score-mark)
19797 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
19798 @end lisp
19799
19800 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
19801 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
19802 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
19803 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
19804 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
19805 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
19806 entries.
19807
19808 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
19809 will be applied to each article.
19810
19811 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
19812 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
19813 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
19814 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
19815
19816 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
19817 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
19818 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
19819 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
19820
19821 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
19822 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
19823 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
19824 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
19825
19826 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
19827 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
19828 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
19829 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
19830 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
19831 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
19832
19833 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
19834 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
19835 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
19836
19837 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
19838 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
19839 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
19840
19841 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
19842 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
19843 let you use different rules in different groups.
19844
19845 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
19846 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
19847 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
19848 is @file{ADAPT}.
19849
19850 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
19851 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
19852 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
19853 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
19854 the length of the match is less than
19855 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
19856 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
19857 this problem.
19858
19859 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19860 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
19861 headers. If you adapt on words, the
19862 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
19863 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
19864
19865 @lisp
19866 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
19867 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
19868 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
19869 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
19870 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
19871 @end lisp
19872
19873 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
19874 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
19875 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
19876 score with 30 points.
19877
19878 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
19879 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
19880 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
19881 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
19882 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
19883
19884 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
19885 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
19886 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
19887 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
19888 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
19889
19890 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
19891 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
19892 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
19893 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
19894
19895 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
19896 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
19897 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
19898 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
19899
19900 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
19901 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
19902 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
19903 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
19904 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
19905
19906 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
19907 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
19908 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
19909
19910 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
19911 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
19912 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
19913 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
19914
19915
19916 @node Home Score File
19917 @section Home Score File
19918
19919 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
19920 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
19921 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
19922 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
19923
19924 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
19925 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
19926 could perhaps use the same home score file.
19927
19928 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
19929 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
19930 be:
19931
19932 @enumerate
19933 @item
19934 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
19935 groups.
19936
19937 @item
19938 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
19939 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
19940 parameter.
19941
19942 @item
19943 A list. The elements in this list can be:
19944
19945 @enumerate
19946 @item
19947 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
19948 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
19949
19950 @item
19951 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
19952 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
19953 name of the group as the parameter.
19954
19955 @item
19956 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
19957 @end enumerate
19958
19959 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
19960 for matches.
19961
19962 @end enumerate
19963
19964 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
19965
19966 @lisp
19967 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19968 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
19969 @end lisp
19970
19971 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
19972 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
19973
19974 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
19975 @lisp
19976 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19977 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
19978 @end lisp
19979
19980 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
19981 Other functions include
19982
19983 @table @code
19984 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
19985 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
19986 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
19987 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
19988
19989 @end table
19990
19991 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
19992 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
19993 their own home score files:
19994
19995 @lisp
19996 (setq gnus-home-score-file
19997 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
19998 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
19999 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20000 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20001 @end lisp
20002
20003 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20004 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20005 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20006 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20007 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20008
20009 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20010 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20011 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20012 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20013 precedence over this variable.
20014
20015
20016 @node Followups To Yourself
20017 @section Followups To Yourself
20018
20019 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20020 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20021 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20022 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20023 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20024 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20025
20026 @table @code
20027
20028 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20029 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20030 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20031 article.
20032
20033 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20034 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20035 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20036 your own article.
20037 @end table
20038
20039 @vindex message-sent-hook
20040 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20041 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20042 @lisp
20043 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20044 @end lisp
20045
20046
20047 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20048 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20049 mine:
20050
20051 @example
20052 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20053 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20054 @end example
20055
20056 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20057 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20058 myself:
20059
20060 @lisp
20061 ("references"
20062 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20063 1000 nil r))
20064 @end lisp
20065
20066 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20067 is system-dependent.
20068
20069
20070 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20071 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20072 @cindex scoring on other headers
20073
20074 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20075 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20076 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20077 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20078 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20079
20080 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
20081 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20082 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20083 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20084 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20085
20086 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20087
20088 @lisp
20089 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20090 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20091 @end lisp
20092
20093 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20094 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20095 time if you have much mail.
20096
20097 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20098 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20099
20100 See? Simple.
20101
20102
20103 @node Scoring Tips
20104 @section Scoring Tips
20105 @cindex scoring tips
20106
20107 @table @dfn
20108
20109 @item Crossposts
20110 @cindex crossposts
20111 @cindex scoring crossposts
20112 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20113 the @code{Xref} header.
20114 @lisp
20115 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20116 @end lisp
20117
20118 @item Multiple crossposts
20119 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20120 more than, say, 3 groups:
20121 @lisp
20122 ("xref"
20123 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20124 -1000 nil r))
20125 @end lisp
20126
20127 @item Matching on the body
20128 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20129 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20130 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20131 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20132 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20133 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20134 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20135 the matches.
20136
20137 @item Marking as read
20138 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20139 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20140 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20141 @lisp
20142 ((mark -100))
20143 @end lisp
20144 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20145
20146 @item Negated character classes
20147 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20148 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20149 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20150 @end table
20151
20152
20153 @node Reverse Scoring
20154 @section Reverse Scoring
20155 @cindex reverse scoring
20156
20157 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20158 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20159 like this in your score file:
20160
20161 @lisp
20162 (("subject"
20163 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20164 (mark 1)
20165 (expunge 1))
20166 @end lisp
20167
20168 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20169 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20170
20171
20172 @node Global Score Files
20173 @section Global Score Files
20174 @cindex global score files
20175
20176 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20177 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20178 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20179
20180 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20181 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20182 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20183
20184 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20185 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20186 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20187 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20188 files are applicable to which group.
20189
20190 To use the score file
20191 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20192 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20193 say this:
20194
20195 @lisp
20196 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20197 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20198 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20199 @end lisp
20200
20201 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20202 @noindent
20203 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20204 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20205 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20206 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20207
20208 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20209 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20210
20211 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20212 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20213 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20214 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20215 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20216 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20217
20218 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20219 head:
20220
20221 @itemize @bullet
20222
20223 @item
20224 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20225 @item
20226 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20227 @item
20228 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20229 @item
20230 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20231 lowered out of existence.
20232 @item
20233 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20234 articles completely.
20235
20236 @item
20237 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20238 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20239 old articles for a long time.
20240 @end itemize
20241
20242 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20243 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20244 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20245 holding our breath yet?
20246
20247
20248 @node Kill Files
20249 @section Kill Files
20250 @cindex kill files
20251
20252 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20253 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20254 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20255
20256 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20257 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20258 files into score files.
20259
20260 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20261 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20262 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20263 that isn't a very good idea.
20264
20265 Normal kill files look like this:
20266
20267 @lisp
20268 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20269 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20270 (gnus-expunge "X")
20271 @end lisp
20272
20273 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20274 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20275
20276 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20277 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20278 interpreting it.
20279
20280 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20281
20282 @table @kbd
20283
20284 @item M-k
20285 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20286 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20287 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20288
20289 @item M-K
20290 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20291 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20292 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20293 @end table
20294
20295 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20296
20297 @table @kbd
20298
20299 @item M-k
20300 @kindex M-k (Group)
20301 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20302 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20303
20304 @item M-K
20305 @kindex M-K (Group)
20306 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20307 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20308 @end table
20309
20310 Kill file variables:
20311
20312 @table @code
20313 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20314 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20315 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20316 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20317 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20318 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20319 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20320
20321 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20322 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20323 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20324 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20325 kills.
20326
20327 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20328 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20329 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20330 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20331 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20332 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20333 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20334 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20335 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20336
20337 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20338 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20339 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20340
20341 @end table
20342
20343
20344 @node Converting Kill Files
20345 @section Converting Kill Files
20346 @cindex kill files
20347 @cindex converting kill files
20348
20349 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20350 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20351 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20352 by hand.
20353
20354 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20355 You can fetch it from
20356 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20357
20358 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20359 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20360 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20361 before.
20362
20363
20364 @node GroupLens
20365 @section GroupLens
20366 @cindex GroupLens
20367
20368 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20369 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20370
20371 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20372 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20373 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20374 news articles generated every day.
20375
20376 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20377 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20378 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20379 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20380 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20381 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20382 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20383 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20384 article.
20385
20386 @menu
20387 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20388 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20389 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20390 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20391 @end menu
20392
20393
20394 @node Using GroupLens
20395 @subsection Using GroupLens
20396
20397 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
20398 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
20399 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
20400
20401 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
20402
20403 @table @code
20404
20405 @item gnus-use-grouplens
20406 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
20407 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
20408 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
20409
20410 @item grouplens-pseudonym
20411 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
20412 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
20413 with the Better Bit Bureau.
20414
20415 @item grouplens-newsgroups
20416 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
20417 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
20418
20419 @end table
20420
20421 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
20422 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
20423 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
20424 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
20425 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
20426 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
20427
20428
20429 @node Rating Articles
20430 @subsection Rating Articles
20431
20432 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
20433 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
20434 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
20435 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
20436 like this one?''
20437
20438 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
20439
20440 @table @kbd
20441
20442 @item r
20443 @kindex r (GroupLens)
20444 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
20445 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
20446
20447 @item k
20448 @kindex k (GroupLens)
20449 @findex grouplens-score-thread
20450 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
20451 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
20452 threads in rec.humor.
20453
20454 @end table
20455
20456 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
20457 the score of the article you're reading.
20458
20459 @table @kbd
20460
20461 @item 1-5 n
20462 @kindex n (GroupLens)
20463 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
20464 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
20465
20466 @item 1-5 ,
20467 @kindex , (GroupLens)
20468 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
20469 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
20470
20471 @end table
20472
20473 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
20474 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
20475
20476
20477 @node Displaying Predictions
20478 @subsection Displaying Predictions
20479
20480 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
20481 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
20482 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
20483 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
20484 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
20485
20486 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
20487 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
20488 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
20489 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
20490 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
20491 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
20492 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
20493 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
20494 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
20495 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
20496 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
20497 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
20498 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
20499
20500 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
20501 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
20502 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
20503 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
20504
20505 The following are valid values for that variable.
20506
20507 @table @code
20508 @item prediction-spot
20509 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
20510 displayed.
20511
20512 @item confidence-interval
20513 A numeric confidence interval.
20514
20515 @item prediction-bar
20516 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
20517
20518 @item confidence-bar
20519 Numerical confidence.
20520
20521 @item confidence-spot
20522 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
20523
20524 @item prediction-num
20525 Plain-old numeric value.
20526
20527 @item confidence-plus-minus
20528 Prediction +/- confidence.
20529
20530 @end table
20531
20532
20533 @node GroupLens Variables
20534 @subsection GroupLens Variables
20535
20536 @table @code
20537
20538 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
20539 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
20540 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
20541 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
20542 %s\n}.
20543
20544 @item grouplens-bbb-host
20545 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
20546 default.
20547
20548 @item grouplens-bbb-port
20549 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
20550
20551 @item grouplens-score-offset
20552 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
20553 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
20554 default is 0.
20555
20556 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
20557 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
20558 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
20559
20560 @end table
20561
20562
20563 @node Advanced Scoring
20564 @section Advanced Scoring
20565
20566 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20567 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20568 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20569 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20570 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20571
20572 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20573 scoring patterns.
20574
20575 @menu
20576 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20577 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20578 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20579 @end menu
20580
20581
20582 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20583 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20584
20585 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20586 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20587 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20588 non-@code{nil} value.
20589
20590 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20591 operator, and various match operators.
20592
20593 Logical operators:
20594
20595 @table @code
20596 @item &
20597 @itemx and
20598 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20599 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20600 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20601 @code{true}.
20602
20603 @item |
20604 @itemx or
20605 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20606 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20607 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20608
20609 @item !
20610 @itemx not
20611 @itemx ¬
20612 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20613 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20614
20615 @end table
20616
20617 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20618 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20619 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20620 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20621 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20622 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20623 the ancestry you want to go.
20624
20625 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20626 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20627 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20628 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20629 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20630
20631
20632 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20633 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20634
20635 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20636 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20637 of parentheses.
20638
20639 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20640 when he's talking about Gnus:
20641
20642 @example
20643 @group
20644 ((&
20645 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20646 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20647 1000)
20648 @end group
20649 @end example
20650
20651 Quite simple, huh?
20652
20653 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20654
20655 @example
20656 ((&
20657 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20658 (|
20659 ("subject" "Gnus")
20660 ("lines" 100 >)))
20661 1000)
20662 @end example
20663
20664 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20665 really don't want to read what he's written:
20666
20667 @example
20668 ((&
20669 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20670 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20671 -100000)
20672 @end example
20673
20674 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20675 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20676 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20677 very interesting:
20678
20679 @example
20680 ((&
20681 (1-
20682 (&
20683 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20684 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20685 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20686 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20687 1000)
20688 @end example
20689
20690 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20691 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20692 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20693 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20694
20695 @example
20696 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20697 -200)
20698 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20699 200)
20700 @end example
20701
20702 The possibilities are endless.
20703
20704 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20705 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20706
20707 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20708 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20709 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20710 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20711 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20712 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20713 @samp{subject}) first.
20714
20715 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20716 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20717 something like:
20718
20719 @example
20720 ...
20721 (1-
20722 (1-
20723 ("from" "lars")))
20724 ...
20725 @end example
20726
20727 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20728 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20729
20730 @example
20731 (1-
20732 (&
20733 ("from" "Lars")
20734 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20735 @end example
20736
20737 than it is to say:
20738
20739 @example
20740 (&
20741 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20742 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20743 @end example
20744
20745
20746 @node Score Decays
20747 @section Score Decays
20748 @cindex score decays
20749 @cindex decays
20750
20751 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20752 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20753 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20754 use them in any sensible way.
20755
20756 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20757 @findex gnus-decay-score
20758 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20759 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20760 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20761 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20762 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20763 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
20764 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
20765 definition of that function:
20766
20767 @lisp
20768 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20769 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20770 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20771 (let ((n (- score
20772 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20773 (min (abs score)
20774 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20775 (* (abs score)
20776 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20777 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20778 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
20779 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20780 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20781 (string-to-number
20782 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20783 (floor n))))
20784 @end lisp
20785
20786 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20787 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20788 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20789 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20790
20791 @enumerate
20792 @item
20793 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20794
20795 @item
20796 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20797
20798 @item
20799 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20800 score.
20801 @end enumerate
20802
20803 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20804 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20805 the new score, which should be an integer.
20806
20807 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
20808 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
20809
20810 @iftex
20811 @iflatex
20812 @chapter Message
20813 @include message.texi
20814 @chapter Emacs MIME
20815 @include emacs-mime.texi
20816 @chapter Sieve
20817 @include sieve.texi
20818 @chapter PGG
20819 @include pgg.texi
20820 @end iflatex
20821 @end iftex
20822
20823 @node Various
20824 @chapter Various
20825
20826 @menu
20827 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
20828 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
20829 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
20830 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
20831 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
20832 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
20833 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
20834 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
20835 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
20836 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
20837 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
20838 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
20839 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
20840 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
20841 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
20842 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
20843 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
20844 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
20845 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
20846 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
20847 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
20848 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
20849 @end menu
20850
20851
20852 @node Process/Prefix
20853 @section Process/Prefix
20854 @cindex process/prefix convention
20855
20856 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
20857 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
20858
20859 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
20860 command to be performed on.
20861
20862 It goes like this:
20863
20864 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
20865 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
20866 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
20867 with the current one.
20868
20869 @vindex transient-mark-mode
20870 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
20871 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
20872
20873 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
20874 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
20875 the process mark.
20876
20877 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
20878 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
20879
20880 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
20881 are avoided.
20882
20883 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
20884 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
20885 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
20886 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
20887
20888 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
20889 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
20890 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
20891 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
20892 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
20893 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
20894 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
20895 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
20896
20897 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
20898 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
20899 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
20900 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
20901 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
20902
20903
20904 @node Interactive
20905 @section Interactive
20906 @cindex interaction
20907
20908 @table @code
20909
20910 @item gnus-novice-user
20911 @vindex gnus-novice-user
20912 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
20913 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
20914 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
20915 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
20916 default.
20917
20918 @item gnus-expert-user
20919 @vindex gnus-expert-user
20920 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
20921 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
20922 matter how strange.
20923
20924 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
20925 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
20926 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
20927 is @code{t} by default.
20928
20929 @item gnus-interactive-exit
20930 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
20931 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
20932 default.
20933 @end table
20934
20935
20936 @node Symbolic Prefixes
20937 @section Symbolic Prefixes
20938 @cindex symbolic prefixes
20939
20940 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
20941 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
20942 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
20943 rule of 900 to the current article.
20944
20945 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
20946 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
20947 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
20948 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
20949 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
20950 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
20951 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
20952
20953 @kindex M-i (Summary)
20954 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
20955 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
20956 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
20957 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
20958 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
20959 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
20960 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
20961 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
20962
20963 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
20964 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
20965 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
20966
20967 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
20968 Interactive}.
20969
20970
20971 @node Formatting Variables
20972 @section Formatting Variables
20973 @cindex formatting variables
20974
20975 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
20976 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
20977 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
20978 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
20979 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
20980 be annoyed by.
20981
20982 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
20983 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
20984 lots of percentages everywhere.
20985
20986 @menu
20987 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
20988 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
20989 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
20990 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
20991 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
20992 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
20993 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
20994 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
20995 @end menu
20996
20997 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
20998 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
20999 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
21000 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
21001 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
21002 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
21003 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
21004 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
21005
21006 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
21007 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
21008
21009 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
21010 @findex gnus-update-format
21011 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
21012 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
21013 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
21014 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
21015
21016
21017
21018 @node Formatting Basics
21019 @subsection Formatting Basics
21020
21021 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
21022 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
21023 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
21024
21025 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
21026 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
21027 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
21028 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
21029 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
21030 the right instead.
21031
21032 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
21033 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
21034 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
21035 less than 4 characters wide.
21036
21037 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
21038 @samp{%&user-date;}.
21039
21040
21041 @node Mode Line Formatting
21042 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
21043
21044 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
21045 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
21046 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
21047 with the following two differences:
21048
21049 @enumerate
21050
21051 @item
21052 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
21053
21054 @item
21055 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
21056 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
21057 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
21058 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
21059 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
21060 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
21061 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
21062
21063 @end enumerate
21064
21065
21066 @node Advanced Formatting
21067 @subsection Advanced Formatting
21068
21069 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
21070 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
21071 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
21072 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
21073
21074 These are the valid modifiers:
21075
21076 @table @code
21077 @item pad
21078 @itemx pad-left
21079 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
21080 length.
21081
21082 @item pad-right
21083 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
21084 length.
21085
21086 @item max
21087 @itemx max-left
21088 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
21089
21090 @item max-right
21091 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
21092 length.
21093
21094 @item cut
21095 @itemx cut-left
21096 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
21097
21098 @item cut-right
21099 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
21100
21101 @item ignore
21102 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
21103
21104 @item form
21105 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
21106 used.
21107
21108 Here's an example:
21109
21110 @lisp
21111 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
21112 @end lisp
21113
21114 @end table
21115
21116 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
21117 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
21118 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
21119 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
21120 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
21121 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
21122 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
21123
21124 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
21125 last operation, padding.
21126
21127 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
21128 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
21129 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
21130 @xref{Compilation}.
21131
21132
21133 @node User-Defined Specs
21134 @subsection User-Defined Specs
21135
21136 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
21137 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
21138 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
21139 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
21140 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
21141 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
21142 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
21143 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
21144 should protect against that.
21145
21146 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
21147 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
21148
21149 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
21150 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
21151 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
21152 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
21153 inserted.
21154
21155
21156 @node Formatting Fonts
21157 @subsection Formatting Fonts
21158
21159 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
21160 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
21161 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
21162 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
21163 over it.
21164
21165 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
21166 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
21167 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
21168 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
21169 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
21170 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
21171
21172 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
21173 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
21174 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
21175 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
21176 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
21177 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
21178 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
21179 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
21180 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
21181 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
21182 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
21183 paragraph.)
21184
21185 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
21186
21187 @lisp
21188 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
21189 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
21190 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
21191
21192 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
21193 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
21194 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
21195 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
21196 ;; @r{Set the color.}
21197 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
21198 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
21199
21200 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
21201 (setq gnus-group-line-format
21202 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
21203 @end lisp
21204
21205 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
21206 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
21207
21208 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
21209 mode-line variables.
21210
21211 @node Positioning Point
21212 @subsection Positioning Point
21213
21214 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
21215 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
21216 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
21217
21218 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
21219
21220 @findex gnus-goto-colon
21221 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
21222 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
21223
21224 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
21225 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
21226 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
21227 place point there.
21228
21229
21230 @node Tabulation
21231 @subsection Tabulation
21232
21233 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
21234 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
21235 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
21236 about lining up the following text afterwards.
21237
21238 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
21239 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
21240
21241 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21242 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21243 This is the soft tabulator.
21244
21245 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21246 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21247 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21248
21249
21250 @node Wide Characters
21251 @subsection Wide Characters
21252
21253 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21254 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21255 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21256
21257 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21258 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21259 these countries, that's not true.
21260
21261 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21262 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21263 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21264 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21265 for Emacs.
21266
21267
21268 @node Window Layout
21269 @section Window Layout
21270 @cindex window layout
21271
21272 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21273
21274 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21275 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21276 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21277 @code{t} by default.
21278
21279 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21280 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21281
21282 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21283 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21284 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21285
21286 @lisp
21287 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21288 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21289 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21290 (article 1.0))))
21291 @end lisp
21292
21293 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21294 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21295 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21296 possible names is listed below.
21297
21298 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21299 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21300
21301 @lisp
21302 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21303 (article 1.0)))
21304 @end lisp
21305
21306 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21307 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21308 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21309 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21310 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21311 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21312 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21313 size spec per split.
21314
21315 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21316 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21317 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21318 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21319 present) gets focus.
21320
21321 Here's a more complicated example:
21322
21323 @lisp
21324 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21325 (summary 0.25 point)
21326 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21327 (article 1.0)))
21328 @end lisp
21329
21330 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21331 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21332 occupy, not a percentage.
21333
21334 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21335 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21336 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21337 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21338 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21339 is non-@code{nil}.
21340
21341 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21342
21343 @lisp
21344 (article (horizontal 1.0
21345 (vertical 0.5
21346 (group 1.0)
21347 (gnus-carpal 4))
21348 (vertical 1.0
21349 (summary 0.25 point)
21350 (summary-carpal 4)
21351 (article 1.0))))
21352 @end lisp
21353
21354 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21355 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21356
21357 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21358 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21359 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21360 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21361 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21362
21363 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21364 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21365 lines from the splits.
21366
21367 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21368 may look like:
21369
21370 @example
21371 @group
21372 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21373 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21374 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21375 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21376 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21377 size = number | frame-params
21378 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21379 @end group
21380 @end example
21381
21382 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21383 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21384 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21385 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21386
21387 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21388 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21389 @cindex window height
21390 @cindex window width
21391 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21392 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21393 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
21394 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
21395 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
21396 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
21397
21398 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
21399 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
21400 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
21401 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
21402
21403 @findex gnus-configure-frame
21404 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
21405 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
21406 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
21407 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
21408 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
21409 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
21410 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
21411 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
21412 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
21413 configuration list.
21414
21415 @lisp
21416 (gnus-configure-frame
21417 '(horizontal 1.0
21418 (vertical 10
21419 (group 1.0)
21420 (article 0.3 point))
21421 (vertical 1.0
21422 (article 1.0)
21423 (horizontal 4
21424 (group 1.0)
21425 (article 10)))))
21426 @end lisp
21427
21428 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
21429 @code{frame} split:
21430
21431 @lisp
21432 (gnus-configure-frame
21433 '(frame 1.0
21434 (vertical 1.0
21435 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
21436 (article 1.0))
21437 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
21438 (user-position . t)
21439 (left . -1) (top . 1))
21440 (picon 1.0))))
21441
21442 @end lisp
21443
21444 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
21445 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
21446 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
21447 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
21448 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
21449 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
21450 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
21451 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
21452 is such a plist.
21453 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
21454 be found in its default value.
21455
21456 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
21457 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
21458 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
21459 might be used:
21460
21461 @lisp
21462 (message (horizontal 1.0
21463 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
21464 (vertical 0.24
21465 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
21466 '(summary 0.5))
21467 (group 1.0))))
21468 @end lisp
21469
21470 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
21471 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
21472 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
21473
21474 @lisp
21475 (message
21476 (frame 1.0
21477 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
21478 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
21479 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
21480 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
21481 (name . "Message"))
21482 (message 1.0 point))))
21483 @end lisp
21484
21485 @findex gnus-add-configuration
21486 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
21487 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
21488 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
21489 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
21490
21491 @lisp
21492 (gnus-add-configuration
21493 '(article (vertical 1.0
21494 (group 4)
21495 (summary .25 point)
21496 (article 1.0))))
21497 @end lisp
21498
21499 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
21500 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
21501 Gnus has been loaded.
21502
21503 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
21504 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
21505 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
21506 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
21507 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
21508
21509 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
21510 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
21511 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
21512 windows resized.
21513
21514 @subsection Example Window Configurations
21515
21516 @itemize @bullet
21517 @item
21518 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
21519 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
21520
21521 @ifinfo
21522 @example
21523 +---+---------+
21524 | G | Summary |
21525 | r +---------+
21526 | o | |
21527 | u | Article |
21528 | p | |
21529 +---+---------+
21530 @end example
21531 @end ifinfo
21532
21533 @lisp
21534 (gnus-add-configuration
21535 '(article
21536 (horizontal 1.0
21537 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21538 (vertical 1.0
21539 (summary 0.16 point)
21540 (article 1.0)))))
21541
21542 (gnus-add-configuration
21543 '(summary
21544 (horizontal 1.0
21545 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
21546 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
21547 @end lisp
21548
21549 @end itemize
21550
21551
21552 @node Faces and Fonts
21553 @section Faces and Fonts
21554 @cindex faces
21555 @cindex fonts
21556 @cindex colors
21557
21558 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
21559 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
21560 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
21561 interface.
21562
21563
21564 @node Compilation
21565 @section Compilation
21566 @cindex compilation
21567 @cindex byte-compilation
21568
21569 @findex gnus-compile
21570
21571 Remember all those line format specification variables?
21572 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
21573 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
21574 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
21575 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
21576 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
21577 course.)
21578
21579 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
21580 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
21581 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
21582 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
21583 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
21584 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
21585 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
21586
21587
21588 @node Mode Lines
21589 @section Mode Lines
21590 @cindex mode lines
21591
21592 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
21593 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
21594 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
21595 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
21596 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
21597 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
21598 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
21599 quicker.
21600
21601 @cindex display-time
21602
21603 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
21604 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
21605 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
21606 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
21607 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
21608 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
21609 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
21610 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
21611 this variable:
21612
21613 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
21614 @lisp
21615 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
21616 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
21617 (+ 21
21618 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
21619 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
21620 (length display-time-string)))))
21621 @end lisp
21622
21623 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
21624 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
21625 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
21626 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
21627 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
21628
21629
21630 @node Highlighting and Menus
21631 @section Highlighting and Menus
21632 @cindex visual
21633 @cindex highlighting
21634 @cindex menus
21635
21636 @vindex gnus-visual
21637 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
21638 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
21639 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
21640 file.
21641
21642 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
21643 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
21644
21645 @table @code
21646 @item group-highlight
21647 Do highlights in the group buffer.
21648 @item summary-highlight
21649 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
21650 @item article-highlight
21651 Do highlights in the article buffer.
21652 @item highlight
21653 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
21654 @item group-menu
21655 Create menus in the group buffer.
21656 @item summary-menu
21657 Create menus in the summary buffers.
21658 @item article-menu
21659 Create menus in the article buffer.
21660 @item browse-menu
21661 Create menus in the browse buffer.
21662 @item server-menu
21663 Create menus in the server buffer.
21664 @item score-menu
21665 Create menus in the score buffers.
21666 @item menu
21667 Create menus in all buffers.
21668 @end table
21669
21670 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
21671 buffers, you could say something like:
21672
21673 @lisp
21674 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
21675 @end lisp
21676
21677 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
21678
21679 @lisp
21680 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
21681 @end lisp
21682
21683 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
21684 in all Gnus buffers.
21685
21686 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
21687
21688 @table @code
21689 @item gnus-mouse-face
21690 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
21691 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
21692 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
21693
21694 @end table
21695
21696 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
21697
21698 @table @code
21699
21700 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
21701 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
21702 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
21703
21704 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
21705 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
21706 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
21707
21708 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
21709 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
21710 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
21711
21712 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
21713 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
21714 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
21715
21716 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
21717 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
21718 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
21719
21720 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
21721 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
21722 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
21723
21724 @end table
21725
21726
21727 @node Buttons
21728 @section Buttons
21729 @cindex buttons
21730 @cindex mouse
21731 @cindex click
21732
21733 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
21734 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
21735 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
21736 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
21737 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
21738
21739 Right.
21740
21741 @vindex gnus-carpal
21742 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
21743 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
21744 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
21745
21746
21747 @table @code
21748
21749 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21750 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
21751 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
21752
21753 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
21754 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
21755 Face used on buttons.
21756
21757 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
21758 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
21759 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
21760
21761 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21762 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
21763 Buttons in the group buffer.
21764
21765 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21766 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
21767 Buttons in the summary buffer.
21768
21769 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21770 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
21771 Buttons in the server buffer.
21772
21773 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21774 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
21775 Buttons in the browse buffer.
21776 @end table
21777
21778 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
21779 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
21780 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
21781
21782
21783 @node Daemons
21784 @section Daemons
21785 @cindex demons
21786 @cindex daemons
21787
21788 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
21789 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
21790 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
21791 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
21792 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
21793
21794 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
21795 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
21796 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
21797
21798 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
21799 been idle for thirty minutes:
21800
21801 @lisp
21802 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
21803 @end lisp
21804
21805 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
21806 Emacs is idle:
21807
21808 @lisp
21809 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
21810 @end lisp
21811
21812 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
21813 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
21814 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21815
21816 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
21817 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
21818 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
21819 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
21820
21821 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
21822 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
21823 @var{idle} minutes.
21824
21825 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
21826 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
21827 minutes.
21828
21829 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
21830 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
21831 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
21832
21833 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
21834 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
21835 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
21836 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
21837
21838 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
21839 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
21840
21841 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
21842 @lisp
21843 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
21844 @end lisp
21845
21846 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
21847 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
21848 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
21849 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
21850 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
21851 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
21852 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
21853 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
21854 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
21855 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
21856 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
21857
21858 @findex gnus-demon-init
21859 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
21860 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
21861 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
21862 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
21863 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
21864
21865 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
21866 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
21867 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
21868 behave.
21869
21870
21871 @node NoCeM
21872 @section NoCeM
21873 @cindex nocem
21874 @cindex spam
21875
21876 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
21877 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
21878
21879 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
21880 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
21881 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
21882 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
21883 away.
21884
21885 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
21886 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
21887 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
21888 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
21889
21890 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
21891 this will make spam disappear.
21892
21893 There are some variables to customize, of course:
21894
21895 @table @code
21896 @item gnus-use-nocem
21897 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
21898 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
21899 by default.
21900
21901 You can also set this variable to a positive number as a group level.
21902 In that case, Gnus scans NoCeM messages when checking new news if this
21903 value is not exceeding a group level that you specify as the prefix
21904 argument to some commands, e.g. @code{gnus},
21905 @code{gnus-group-get-new-news}, etc. Otherwise, Gnus does not scan
21906 NoCeM messages if you specify a group level to those commands. For
21907 example, if you use 1 or 2 on the mail groups and the levels on the news
21908 groups remain the default, 3 is the best choice.
21909
21910 @item gnus-nocem-groups
21911 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
21912 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
21913 default is
21914 @lisp
21915 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
21916 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
21917 @end lisp
21918
21919 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
21920 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
21921 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
21922 people you want to listen to. The default is
21923 @lisp
21924 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
21925 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
21926 @end lisp
21927 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
21928
21929 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
21930 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
21931
21932 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
21933 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
21934 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
21935 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
21936 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
21937 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
21938 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
21939 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
21940 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
21941 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
21942
21943 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
21944 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
21945
21946 @lisp
21947 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
21948 @end lisp
21949
21950 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
21951 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
21952
21953 @lisp
21954 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
21955 @end lisp
21956
21957 The specs are applied left-to-right.
21958
21959
21960 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
21961 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
21962 @findex pgg-verify
21963 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
21964 says she is. The default is @code{pgg-verify}, which returns
21965 non-@code{nil} if the verification is successful, otherwise (including
21966 the case the NoCeM message was not signed) returns @code{nil}. If this
21967 is too slow and you don't care for verification (which may be dangerous),
21968 you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
21969
21970 Formerly the default was @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
21971 function. While you can still use it, you can change it into
21972 @code{pgg-verify} running with GnuPG if you are willing to add the
21973 @acronym{PGP} public keys to GnuPG's keyring.
21974
21975 @item gnus-nocem-directory
21976 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
21977 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
21978 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
21979
21980 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21981 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
21982 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
21983 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
21984 might then see old spam.
21985
21986 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
21987 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
21988 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
21989 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
21990 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
21991 issuers.
21992
21993 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21994 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
21995 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
21996 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
21997
21998 @end table
21999
22000 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
22001 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
22002 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
22003 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
22004
22005
22006 @node Undo
22007 @section Undo
22008 @cindex undo
22009
22010 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
22011 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
22012 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
22013
22014 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
22015 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
22016 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
22017 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
22018 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
22019 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
22020 @code{undo} function.
22021
22022 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
22023 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
22024 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
22025 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
22026 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
22027 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
22028 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
22029 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
22030 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
22031 never be totally undoable.
22032
22033 @findex gnus-undo-mode
22034 @vindex gnus-use-undo
22035 @findex gnus-undo
22036 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
22037 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
22038 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
22039 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
22040 command.
22041
22042
22043 @node Predicate Specifiers
22044 @section Predicate Specifiers
22045 @cindex predicate specifiers
22046
22047 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
22048 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
22049 to type all that much.
22050
22051 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
22052
22053 Here's an example:
22054
22055 @lisp
22056 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
22057 gnus-article-unread-p)
22058 @end lisp
22059
22060 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
22061 functions all take one parameter.
22062
22063 @findex gnus-make-predicate
22064 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
22065 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
22066 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
22067 specifier.
22068
22069
22070 @node Moderation
22071 @section Moderation
22072 @cindex moderation
22073
22074 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
22075 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
22076 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
22077 get a copy.
22078
22079 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
22080 buffers. Put
22081
22082 @lisp
22083 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
22084 @end lisp
22085
22086 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
22087
22088 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
22089 supposed to work:
22090
22091 @enumerate
22092 @item
22093 You split your incoming mail by matching on
22094 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
22095 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
22096
22097 @item
22098 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
22099 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
22100
22101 @item
22102 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
22103 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
22104 @kbd{c} command.
22105 @end enumerate
22106
22107 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
22108
22109 @lisp
22110 (setq gnus-moderated-list
22111 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
22112 @end lisp
22113
22114
22115 @node Fetching a Group
22116 @section Fetching a Group
22117 @cindex fetching a group
22118
22119 @findex gnus-fetch-group
22120 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
22121 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
22122 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
22123 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
22124 It takes the group name as a parameter.
22125
22126
22127 @node Image Enhancements
22128 @section Image Enhancements
22129
22130 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
22131 support images yet.}, is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has
22132 taken advantage of that.
22133
22134 @menu
22135 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
22136 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
22137 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
22138 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
22139 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
22140 @end menu
22141
22142
22143 @node X-Face
22144 @subsection X-Face
22145 @cindex x-face
22146
22147 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
22148 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
22149 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
22150 readers.
22151
22152 @cindex x-face
22153 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
22154 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
22155 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
22156 @iftex
22157 @iflatex
22158 \include{xface}
22159 @end iflatex
22160 @end iftex
22161 @c @anchor{X-Face}
22162
22163 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
22164 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
22165 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
22166 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
22167 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
22168 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
22169 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends. For XEmacs it's faster if
22170 XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The default action
22171 under Emacs without image support is to fork off the @code{display}
22172 program.
22173
22174 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is from the
22175 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
22176 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
22177
22178 The variable that controls this is the
22179 @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable. If this variable is a
22180 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
22181 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
22182 If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches
22183 the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
22184
22185 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
22186 @code{xface}).
22187
22188 @noindent
22189 Face and variable:
22190
22191 @table @code
22192 @item gnus-x-face
22193 @vindex gnus-x-face
22194 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
22195 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
22196 default colors are black and white.
22197 @end table
22198
22199 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
22200 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
22201 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
22202 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
22203 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
22204 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
22205
22206 @findex gnus-random-x-face
22207 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
22208 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
22209 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
22210 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
22211 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
22212 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
22213 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
22214 header data as a string.
22215
22216 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
22217 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
22218 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
22219 randomly generated data.
22220
22221 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
22222 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
22223 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
22224 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
22225 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
22226
22227 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
22228 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22229
22230 @lisp
22231 (setq message-required-news-headers
22232 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22233 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
22234 @end lisp
22235
22236 Using the last function would be something like this:
22237
22238 @lisp
22239 (setq message-required-news-headers
22240 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22241 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
22242 (gnus-x-face-from-file
22243 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
22244 @end lisp
22245
22246
22247 @node Face
22248 @subsection Face
22249 @cindex face
22250
22251 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
22252
22253 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22254 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22255 represent the author of the message.
22256
22257 @cindex face
22258 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22259 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22260 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22261 specifications.
22262
22263 Viewing an @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
22264 PNG images.
22265 @c Maybe add this:
22266 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
22267 @c (featurep 'png)
22268 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
22269
22270 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22271 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22272
22273 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22274 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22275 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22276
22277 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22278 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22279 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22280 converts the file to Face format by using the
22281 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22282
22283 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22284 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22285
22286 @lisp
22287 (setq message-required-news-headers
22288 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22289 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22290 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22291 @end lisp
22292
22293
22294 @node Smileys
22295 @subsection Smileys
22296 @cindex smileys
22297
22298 @iftex
22299 @iflatex
22300 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22301 \input{smiley}
22302 @end iflatex
22303 @end iftex
22304
22305 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22306 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22307
22308 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22309 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22310
22311 @lisp
22312 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22313 @end lisp
22314
22315 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22316 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22317 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22318 text and maps that to file names.
22319
22320 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22321 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22322 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22323 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22324 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22325 displayed.
22326
22327 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22328 files:
22329
22330 @table @code
22331
22332 @item smiley-data-directory
22333 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22334 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22335
22336 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22337 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22338 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22339
22340 @end table
22341
22342
22343 @node Picons
22344 @subsection Picons
22345
22346 @iftex
22347 @iflatex
22348 \include{picons}
22349 @end iflatex
22350 @end iftex
22351
22352 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22353 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22354 over your shoulder as you read news.
22355
22356 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22357
22358 @iftex
22359 @iflatex
22360 \margindex{}
22361 @end iflatex
22362 @end iftex
22363
22364 @quotation
22365 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22366 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22367 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22368 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22369 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22370 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22371 @code{GIF} formats.
22372 @end quotation
22373
22374 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22375 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22376 point your Web browser at
22377 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22378
22379 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22380 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22381
22382 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22383 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22384 Picons databases.
22385
22386 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22387
22388 @table @code
22389
22390 @item gnus-picon-databases
22391 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22392 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
22393 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
22394 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
22395 "/usr/local/faces")}.
22396
22397 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
22398 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
22399 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22400 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
22401
22402 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
22403 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
22404 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
22405 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
22406
22407 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
22408 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
22409 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22410 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
22411 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
22412
22413 @item gnus-picon-file-types
22414 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
22415 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
22416 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
22417
22418 @end table
22419
22420
22421 @node XVarious
22422 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
22423
22424 @table @code
22425 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22426 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22427 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
22428 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
22429 unusual directory structure.
22430
22431 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22432 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22433 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
22434 default.
22435
22436 @end table
22437
22438 @subsubsection Toolbar
22439
22440 @table @code
22441
22442 @item gnus-use-toolbar
22443 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
22444 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
22445 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
22446 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
22447 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
22448 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
22449 names show. The default is @code{default}.
22450
22451 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
22452 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
22453 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
22454 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
22455 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
22456 The default is that of the default toolbar.
22457
22458 @item gnus-group-toolbar
22459 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
22460 The toolbar in the group buffer.
22461
22462 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
22463 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
22464 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
22465
22466 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22467 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
22468 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
22469
22470 @end table
22471
22472 @iftex
22473 @iflatex
22474 \margindex{}
22475 @end iflatex
22476 @end iftex
22477
22478
22479 @node Fuzzy Matching
22480 @section Fuzzy Matching
22481 @cindex fuzzy matching
22482
22483 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
22484 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
22485
22486 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
22487 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
22488 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
22489
22490 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
22491 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
22492 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
22493 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
22494 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
22495
22496
22497 @node Thwarting Email Spam
22498 @section Thwarting Email Spam
22499 @cindex email spam
22500 @cindex spam
22501 @cindex UCE
22502 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22503
22504 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
22505 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
22506 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
22507 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
22508 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
22509 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
22510 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
22511 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
22512 in the end.
22513
22514 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
22515 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
22516 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
22517 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
22518 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
22519 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
22520
22521 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
22522
22523 @menu
22524 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
22525 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
22526 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
22527 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
22528 @end menu
22529
22530 @node The problem of spam
22531 @subsection The problem of spam
22532 @cindex email spam
22533 @cindex spam filtering approaches
22534 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
22535 @cindex UCE
22536 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22537
22538 First, some background on spam.
22539
22540 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
22541 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
22542 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
22543 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
22544 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
22545 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
22546 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
22547 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
22548 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
22549
22550 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
22551 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
22552 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
22553 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
22554 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
22555 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
22556 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
22557 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
22558 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
22559 and processing.
22560
22561 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
22562 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
22563 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
22564 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
22565 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
22566 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
22567 from Bulgarian IPs.
22568
22569 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
22570 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
22571 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
22572 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
22573
22574 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
22575 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
22576 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
22577 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
22578
22579 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
22580 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
22581 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
22582 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
22583 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
22584 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
22585 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
22586 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
22587 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
22588
22589 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
22590 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
22591 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
22592 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
22593 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
22594 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
22595 down for some time because of the incident.
22596
22597 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
22598 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
22599 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
22600 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
22601 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
22602 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
22603 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
22604 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
22605 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
22606 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
22607 the server that it has misclassified mail.
22608
22609 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
22610 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
22611 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
22612 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
22613 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
22614 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
22615 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
22616 spam plague.
22617
22618 @node Anti-Spam Basics
22619 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
22620 @cindex email spam
22621 @cindex spam
22622 @cindex UCE
22623 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
22624
22625 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
22626 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
22627
22628 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
22629 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
22630 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
22631 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
22632 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
22633 part of the mail address.)
22634
22635 @lisp
22636 (setq message-default-news-headers
22637 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
22638 @end lisp
22639
22640 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
22641 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22642
22643 @lisp
22644 (...
22645 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
22646 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
22647 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
22648 "spam"))
22649 ...)
22650 @end lisp
22651
22652 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
22653 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
22654 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
22655 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
22656
22657 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
22658 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
22659 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
22660 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
22661 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
22662 your fancy split rule in this way:
22663
22664 @lisp
22665 (
22666 ...
22667 (to "larsi" "misc")
22668 "spam")
22669 @end lisp
22670
22671 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
22672 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
22673 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
22674 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
22675 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
22676
22677 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
22678 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
22679 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
22680 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
22681
22682 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
22683
22684
22685 @node SpamAssassin
22686 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
22687 @cindex SpamAssassin
22688 @cindex Vipul's Razor
22689 @cindex DCC
22690
22691 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
22692 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
22693 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
22694 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
22695 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
22696 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
22697 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
22698
22699 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
22700 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
22701 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
22702 recipes.
22703
22704 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
22705 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
22706 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
22707 Specifiers}) follow.
22708
22709 @lisp
22710 (setq mail-sources
22711 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
22712 (pop :user "jrl"
22713 :server "pophost"
22714 :postscript
22715 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
22716 @end lisp
22717
22718 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
22719 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
22720 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
22721
22722 @lisp
22723 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
22724 ...))
22725 @end lisp
22726
22727 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
22728
22729 @lisp
22730 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
22731 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
22732 ...))
22733 @end lisp
22734
22735 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
22736 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
22737 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
22738 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
22739
22740 @lisp
22741 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
22742 ...))
22743 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
22744 (save-excursion
22745 (save-restriction
22746 (widen)
22747 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
22748 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
22749 "spam"))))
22750 @end lisp
22751
22752 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
22753 downloaded by default. You need to set
22754 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
22755 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
22756
22757 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
22758 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
22759 spam. And here is the nifty function:
22760
22761 @lisp
22762 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
22763 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
22764 (interactive)
22765 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
22766 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
22767 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
22768 @end lisp
22769
22770 @node Hashcash
22771 @subsection Hashcash
22772 @cindex hashcash
22773
22774 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
22775 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
22776 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
22777 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
22778 in smaller communities.
22779
22780 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
22781 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
22782 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
22783 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
22784 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
22785 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
22786 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
22787 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
22788 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
22789 one of them separately.
22790
22791 @cindex X-Hashcash
22792 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
22793 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
22794 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
22795 header. For more details, and for the external application
22796 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
22797 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
22798 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
22799
22800 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
22801 like:
22802
22803 @lisp
22804 (require 'hashcash)
22805 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
22806 @end lisp
22807
22808 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
22809 contrib directory or at
22810 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
22811
22812 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
22813
22814 @table @code
22815
22816 @item hashcash-default-payment
22817 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
22818 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
22819 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
22820 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
22821
22822 @item hashcash-payment-alist
22823 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
22824 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
22825 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
22826 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
22827 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
22828 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
22829 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
22830 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
22831
22832 @item hashcash
22833 @vindex hashcash
22834 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
22835
22836 @end table
22837
22838 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
22839 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
22840 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
22841 a useful contribution, however.
22842
22843 @node Spam Package
22844 @section Spam Package
22845 @cindex spam filtering
22846 @cindex spam
22847
22848 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
22849 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
22850 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
22851 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
22852
22853 @menu
22854 * Spam Package Introduction::
22855 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
22856 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
22857 * Spam and Ham Processors::
22858 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
22859 * Spam Back Ends::
22860 * Extending the Spam package::
22861 * Spam Statistics Package::
22862 @end menu
22863
22864 @node Spam Package Introduction
22865 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
22866 @cindex spam filtering
22867 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
22868 @cindex spam
22869
22870 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
22871 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
22872
22873 @cindex spam-initialize
22874 @vindex spam-use-stat
22875 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
22876 @code{spam-initialize}:
22877
22878 @example
22879 (spam-initialize)
22880 @end example
22881
22882 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
22883 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
22884 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
22885 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
22886 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
22887
22888 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
22889 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
22890
22891 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
22892 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
22893
22894 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
22895 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
22896 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
22897 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
22898 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
22899
22900 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
22901 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
22902 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
22903 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
22904 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
22905 Groups}.
22906
22907 @cindex spam back ends
22908 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
22909 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
22910 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
22911 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
22912 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
22913
22914 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
22915 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
22916
22917 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
22918 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
22919 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
22920 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
22921 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
22922 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
22923 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
22924
22925 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
22926 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
22927 point, the Spam package does several things:
22928
22929 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
22930 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
22931 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
22932 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
22933 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
22934 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
22935 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
22936 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
22937 Ham Processors}.
22938
22939 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
22940 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
22941 group:
22942
22943 @table @kbd
22944 @item M-d
22945 @itemx M s x
22946 @itemx S x
22947 @kindex M-d
22948 @kindex S x
22949 @kindex M s x
22950 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
22951 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
22952 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
22953 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
22954 @end table
22955
22956 @noindent
22957 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
22958 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
22959
22960 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
22961 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
22962 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
22963 to be processed as ham by setting
22964 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
22965 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
22966
22967 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
22968 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
22969 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
22970 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
22971 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
22972 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
22973 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
22974 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
22975 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
22976 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
22977 If an article cannot not be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
22978 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
22979
22980 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
22981 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
22982 want each article to be processed only once, load the
22983 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
22984 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
22985 Configuration Examples}.
22986
22987 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
22988 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
22989 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
22990 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
22991
22992 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
22993 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
22994
22995 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
22996 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
22997 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
22998
22999 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
23000 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
23001 @cindex spam filtering
23002 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
23003 @cindex spam
23004
23005 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
23006 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
23007 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
23008 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
23009 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
23010
23011 @example
23012 (: spam-split)
23013 @end example
23014
23015 @vindex spam-split-group
23016 @noindent
23017 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
23018 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
23019 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
23020 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
23021 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
23022 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
23023 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
23024 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
23025 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
23026
23027 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
23028
23029 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
23030 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
23031 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
23032 you should also set set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body}
23033 to @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can
23034 ``scan'' the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only
23035 retrieves the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells
23036 it to retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by
23037 default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
23038 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Splitting
23039 in IMAP}.
23040
23041 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
23042 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
23043 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
23044 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
23045 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
23046 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
23047 ends, and the following split rule:
23048
23049 @example
23050 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23051 (any "ding" "ding")
23052 (: spam-split)
23053 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23054 "mail")
23055 @end example
23056
23057 @noindent
23058 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
23059 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
23060 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
23061 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
23062 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
23063 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
23064
23065 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
23066 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
23067 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
23068 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
23069
23070 @example
23071 nnimap-split-fancy
23072 '(|
23073 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
23074 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23075 (any "ding" "ding")
23076 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
23077 (: spam-split)
23078 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23079 "mail")
23080 @end example
23081
23082 @noindent
23083 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
23084 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
23085 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
23086 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
23087 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
23088 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
23089 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
23090
23091 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
23092 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
23093 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
23094 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
23095
23096 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
23097 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
23098 @c don't.}
23099
23100 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
23101 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
23102
23103 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
23104 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
23105 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
23106 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
23107
23108 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
23109 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
23110 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
23111 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
23112
23113 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
23114 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
23115 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
23116
23117 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
23118 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
23119 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
23120 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
23121 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
23122 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
23123 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
23124
23125 @node Spam and Ham Processors
23126 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
23127 @cindex spam filtering
23128 @cindex spam filtering variables
23129 @cindex spam variables
23130 @cindex spam
23131
23132 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
23133 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
23134 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
23135 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
23136 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
23137 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
23138 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
23139
23140 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
23141 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
23142 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
23143 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
23144
23145 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23146 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
23147 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
23148 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
23149 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
23150 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
23151 by customizing the corresponding variable
23152 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
23153 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
23154 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
23155 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
23156 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
23157 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
23158 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
23159 default.
23160
23161 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
23162 @cindex $
23163 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
23164 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
23165 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
23166 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
23167 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
23168 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
23169 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
23170 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
23171 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
23172 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
23173 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
23174 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
23175 processor which will study them as spam samples.
23176
23177 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
23178 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
23179 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
23180 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
23181 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
23182 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
23183 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
23184 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
23185
23186 @defvar ham-marks
23187 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23188 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
23189 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
23190 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
23191 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
23192 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
23193 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
23194 happy for you.
23195 @end defvar
23196
23197 @defvar spam-marks
23198 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23199 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
23200 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
23201 you really want to.
23202 @end defvar
23203
23204 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
23205 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
23206 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
23207 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
23208 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
23209 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
23210 and nothing else.
23211
23212 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23213 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
23214 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
23215 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
23216 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
23217 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
23218 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
23219 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
23220 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
23221 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
23222 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
23223 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
23224 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
23225 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
23226 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
23227
23228 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23229 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23230
23231 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23232 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
23233 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
23234
23235 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
23236 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
23237
23238 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
23239 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
23240 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
23241 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
23242 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
23243
23244 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
23245 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
23246 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
23247 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
23248 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23249 it there.
23250
23251 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23252 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23253 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23254 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23255 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23256 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23257 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23258 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23259 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23260 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23261 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23262 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23263 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23264
23265 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23266 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23267
23268 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23269 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23270 training} groups.
23271
23272 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23273 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23274 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23275 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23276 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23277 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23278 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23279
23280 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23281 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23282 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23283 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23284
23285 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23286 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23287 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23288 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23289 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23290 from the mail server.
23291
23292 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23293 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23294 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23295 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23296
23297 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
23298 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
23299 @cindex spam filtering
23300 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23301 @cindex spam configuration examples
23302 @cindex spam
23303
23304 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23305
23306 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23307 @example
23308 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23309 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23310 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23311 (spam-initialize)
23312
23313 ;; @r{I like @kbd{C-s} for marking spam}
23314 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map "\C-s" 'gnus-summary-mark-as-spam)
23315
23316 (setq
23317 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23318 spam-use-BBDB t
23319 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23320 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23321 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23322 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23323 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23324 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23325 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23326 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23327 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23328 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23329 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23330 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23331 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23332 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23333 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23334 (any "ding" "ding")
23335 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23336 (: spam-split)
23337 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23338 "mail"))
23339
23340 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23341
23342 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23343 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23344 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23345 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23346
23347 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23348
23349 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23350 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23351 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23352 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23353 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23354
23355 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23356 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23357
23358 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23359
23360 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23361 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23362
23363 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23364 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23365 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23366
23367 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23368
23369 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
23370 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
23371
23372 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23373 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23374 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
23375 (ham-marks
23376 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23377 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
23378 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
23379 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23380
23381 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
23382 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
23383 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
23384
23385 @end example
23386
23387 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23388 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23389
23390 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23391 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
23392 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
23393 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
23394 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
23395 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
23396 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
23397 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
23398 @samp{training.spam} folders.
23399
23400 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
23401 does most of the job for me:
23402
23403 @lisp
23404 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
23405 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
23406 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
23407 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23408 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
23409 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
23410 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
23411 @end lisp
23412
23413 @itemize
23414
23415 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
23416
23417 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
23418 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
23419 bogofilter or DCC).
23420
23421 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
23422 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
23423 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
23424 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
23425 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
23426 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
23427 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
23428
23429 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
23430 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
23431 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
23432 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
23433 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
23434 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
23435
23436 @item @b{Ham folders:}
23437
23438 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
23439 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
23440 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
23441 @samp{training.ham}.
23442 @end itemize
23443
23444 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
23445
23446 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23447
23448 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
23449 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
23450 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
23451
23452 @lisp
23453 ("^gmane\\."
23454 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
23455 @end lisp
23456
23457 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
23458 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
23459 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
23460 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
23461 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
23462
23463 @node Spam Back Ends
23464 @subsection Spam Back Ends
23465 @cindex spam back ends
23466
23467 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
23468 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
23469 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
23470 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
23471 Processors}).
23472
23473 @menu
23474 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
23475 * BBDB Whitelists::
23476 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
23477 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
23478 * Blackholes::
23479 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
23480 * Bogofilter::
23481 * ifile spam filtering::
23482 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
23483 * SpamOracle::
23484 @end menu
23485
23486 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
23487 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
23488 @cindex spam filtering
23489 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
23490 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
23491 @cindex spam
23492
23493 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
23494
23495 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
23496 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
23497 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
23498 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
23499 be spammers.
23500
23501 @end defvar
23502
23503 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
23504
23505 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
23506 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
23507 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23508 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
23509 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23510
23511 @end defvar
23512
23513 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
23514
23515 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
23516 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23517 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
23518
23519 @end defvar
23520
23521 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
23522
23523 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23524 customizing the group parameters or the
23525 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23526 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23527 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
23528
23529 @emph{WARNING}
23530
23531 Instead of the obsolete
23532 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
23533 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
23534 the same way, we promise.
23535
23536 @end defvar
23537
23538 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
23539
23540 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23541 customizing the group parameters or the
23542 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23543 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23544 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23545 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23546 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23547
23548 @emph{WARNING}
23549
23550 Instead of the obsolete
23551 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
23552 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
23553 the same way, we promise.
23554
23555 @end defvar
23556
23557 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
23558 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
23559 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
23560 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
23561 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
23562
23563 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
23564 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
23565 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
23566 Emacs regular expression syntax.
23567
23568 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
23569 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
23570 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
23571 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
23572 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
23573 @file{blacklist} respectively.
23574
23575 @node BBDB Whitelists
23576 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
23577 @cindex spam filtering
23578 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
23579 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
23580 @cindex spam
23581
23582 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
23583
23584 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23585 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
23586 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
23587 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
23588 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
23589 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
23590 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
23591
23592 @end defvar
23593
23594 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
23595
23596 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
23597 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
23598 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
23599 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
23600 classified as spammers.
23601
23602 @end defvar
23603
23604 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
23605
23606 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23607 customizing the group parameters or the
23608 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23609 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
23610 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
23611 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
23612 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23613
23614 @emph{WARNING}
23615
23616 Instead of the obsolete
23617 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
23618 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
23619 the same way, we promise.
23620
23621 @end defvar
23622
23623 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
23624 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
23625 @cindex spam reporting
23626 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23627 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
23628 @cindex spam
23629
23630 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
23631
23632 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23633 customizing the group parameters or the
23634 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23635 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23636 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
23637 HTTP request.
23638
23639 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
23640
23641 @emph{WARNING}
23642
23643 Instead of the obsolete
23644 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
23645 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
23646 same way, we promise.
23647
23648 @end defvar
23649
23650 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
23651
23652 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
23653 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
23654 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
23655 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
23656 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
23657 Gmane provides.
23658
23659 @end defvar
23660
23661 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23662 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
23663 @cindex spam filtering
23664 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
23665 @cindex spam
23666
23667 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
23668
23669 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
23670 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
23671 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
23672 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
23673 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
23674 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
23675 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
23676 ham.
23677
23678 @end defvar
23679
23680 @node Blackholes
23681 @subsubsection Blackholes
23682 @cindex spam filtering
23683 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
23684 @cindex spam
23685
23686 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
23687
23688 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
23689 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
23690 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
23691 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
23692 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
23693 contains outdated servers.
23694
23695 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
23696 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
23697 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
23698 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
23699 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
23700 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
23701
23702 @end defvar
23703
23704 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
23705
23706 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
23707
23708 @end defvar
23709
23710 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
23711
23712 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
23713 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
23714
23715 @end defvar
23716
23717 @defvar spam-use-dig
23718
23719 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
23720 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
23721
23722 @end defvar
23723
23724 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
23725 ham processor for blackholes.
23726
23727 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
23728 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
23729 @cindex spam filtering
23730 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
23731 @cindex spam
23732
23733 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
23734
23735 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
23736 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
23737 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
23738 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
23739 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
23740 message is spam or ham, respectively.
23741
23742 @end defvar
23743
23744 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
23745
23746 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23747 the message, positively identify it as spam.
23748
23749 @end defvar
23750
23751 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
23752
23753 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
23754 the message, positively identify it as ham.
23755
23756 @end defvar
23757
23758 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
23759 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
23760
23761 @node Bogofilter
23762 @subsubsection Bogofilter
23763 @cindex spam filtering
23764 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
23765 @cindex spam
23766
23767 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
23768
23769 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23770 speedy Bogofilter.
23771
23772 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
23773 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
23774 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
23775 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
23776 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
23777 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
23778
23779 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
23780 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
23781 documentation.
23782
23783 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
23784 processing will be turned off.
23785
23786 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
23787
23788 @end defvar
23789
23790 @table @kbd
23791 @item M s t
23792 @itemx S t
23793 @kindex M s t
23794 @kindex S t
23795 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
23796 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
23797 @end table
23798
23799 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
23800
23801 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
23802 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
23803 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
23804 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
23805 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
23806 installation documents for details.
23807
23808 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
23809
23810 @end defvar
23811
23812 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
23813 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23814 customizing the group parameters or the
23815 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23816 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
23817 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
23818
23819 @emph{WARNING}
23820
23821 Instead of the obsolete
23822 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23823 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23824 the same way, we promise.
23825 @end defvar
23826
23827 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
23828 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23829 customizing the group parameters or the
23830 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23831 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23832 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
23833 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23834 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23835
23836 @emph{WARNING}
23837
23838 Instead of the obsolete
23839 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
23840 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
23841 the same way, we promise.
23842 @end defvar
23843
23844 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
23845
23846 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
23847 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
23848 database directory.
23849
23850 @end defvar
23851
23852 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
23853 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23854 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
23855 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
23856 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
23857 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
23858
23859 @node ifile spam filtering
23860 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
23861 @cindex spam filtering
23862 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
23863 @cindex spam
23864
23865 @defvar spam-use-ifile
23866
23867 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
23868 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
23869
23870 @end defvar
23871
23872 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
23873
23874 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
23875 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
23876 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
23877
23878 @end defvar
23879
23880 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
23881
23882 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
23883 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
23884 the default value of @samp{spam}.
23885 @end defvar
23886
23887 @defvar spam-ifile-database-path
23888
23889 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
23890 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
23891
23892 @end defvar
23893
23894 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
23895 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
23896 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
23897 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
23898 functionality.
23899
23900 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
23901 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
23902 @cindex spam filtering
23903 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
23904 @cindex spam-stat
23905 @cindex spam
23906
23907 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
23908 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
23909 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
23910 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
23911 spam-stat dictionary}.
23912
23913 @defvar spam-use-stat
23914
23915 @end defvar
23916
23917 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
23918 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23919 customizing the group parameters or the
23920 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23921 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
23922 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
23923
23924 @emph{WARNING}
23925
23926 Instead of the obsolete
23927 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23928 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23929 the same way, we promise.
23930 @end defvar
23931
23932 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
23933 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
23934 customizing the group parameters or the
23935 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
23936 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
23937 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
23938 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
23939 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
23940
23941 @emph{WARNING}
23942
23943 Instead of the obsolete
23944 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
23945 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
23946 the same way, we promise.
23947 @end defvar
23948
23949 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
23950 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
23951 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
23952 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
23953 @code{spam-split} are provided.
23954
23955 @node SpamOracle
23956 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
23957 @cindex spam filtering
23958 @cindex SpamOracle
23959 @cindex spam
23960
23961 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
23962 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
23963 installed separately.
23964
23965 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
23966 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
23967 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
23968 mail as a spam mail or not.
23969
23970 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
23971 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
23972 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
23973
23974 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
23975 call SpamOracle.
23976
23977 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
23978 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
23979 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
23980 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
23981 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
23982 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
23983 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
23984 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
23985
23986 @example
23987 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
23988 spam-split-group "Junk"
23989 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
23990 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23991 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
23992 @end example
23993
23994 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
23995 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
23996 SpamOracle.
23997 @end defvar
23998
23999 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
24000 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
24001 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
24002 can be customized.
24003 @end defvar
24004
24005 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
24006 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
24007 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
24008 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
24009 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
24010 database to live somewhere special, set
24011 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
24012 @end defvar
24013
24014 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
24015 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
24016 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
24017 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
24018 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
24019 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
24020 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
24021 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
24022 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
24023 @xref{Spam Package}.
24024
24025 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
24026 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24027 customizing the group parameter or the
24028 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
24029 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
24030 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
24031
24032 @emph{WARNING}
24033
24034 Instead of the obsolete
24035 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
24036 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
24037 the same way, we promise.
24038 @end defvar
24039
24040 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
24041 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24042 customizing the group parameter or the
24043 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
24044 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
24045 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
24046 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
24047 @emph{unclassified} groups.
24048
24049 @emph{WARNING}
24050
24051 Instead of the obsolete
24052 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
24053 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
24054 the same way, we promise.
24055 @end defvar
24056
24057 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
24058 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
24059 messages.
24060 @example
24061 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
24062 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
24063 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
24064 @end example
24065 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
24066 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
24067 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
24068 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
24069 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
24070 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
24071
24072 @node Extending the Spam package
24073 @subsection Extending the Spam package
24074 @cindex spam filtering
24075 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
24076 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
24077
24078 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
24079 incoming mail, provide the following:
24080
24081 @enumerate
24082
24083 @item
24084 Code
24085
24086 @lisp
24087 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
24088 "True if blackbox should be used.")
24089 @end lisp
24090
24091 Add
24092 @lisp
24093 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
24094 @end lisp
24095 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
24096
24097 Add
24098 @lisp
24099 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
24100 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
24101 @end lisp
24102
24103 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
24104
24105 Add
24106 @lisp
24107 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
24108 nil
24109 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
24110 nil)
24111 @end lisp
24112
24113 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
24114 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
24115 start, or other register/unregister routines more appropriate to
24116 Blackbox.
24117
24118 @item
24119 Functionality
24120
24121 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
24122 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
24123 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
24124 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
24125 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
24126
24127 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
24128 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
24129 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
24130
24131 @end enumerate
24132
24133 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
24134
24135 @enumerate
24136
24137 @item
24138 Code
24139
24140 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
24141 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
24142
24143 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
24144 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
24145 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
24146 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
24147
24148 @lisp
24149 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
24150 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
24151 Only applicable to spam groups.")
24152
24153 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
24154 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
24155 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
24156
24157 @end lisp
24158
24159 @item
24160 Gnus parameters
24161
24162 Add
24163 @lisp
24164 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
24165 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
24166 @end lisp
24167 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
24168 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
24169 variable customization.
24170
24171 Add
24172 @lisp
24173 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
24174 @end lisp
24175 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
24176 @code{gnus.el}.
24177
24178 @end enumerate
24179
24180 @node Spam Statistics Package
24181 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
24182 @cindex Paul Graham
24183 @cindex Graham, Paul
24184 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
24185 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
24186 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
24187
24188 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
24189 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
24190 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
24191 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
24192 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
24193 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
24194 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
24195 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
24196 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
24197 or not.
24198
24199 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
24200 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
24201 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
24202 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
24203 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
24204 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
24205 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
24206 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
24207
24208 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
24209 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
24210 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
24211
24212 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
24213 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
24214 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
24215 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
24216 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
24217
24218 @menu
24219 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
24220 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
24221 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
24222 @end menu
24223
24224 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24225 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24226
24227 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
24228 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
24229 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
24230 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
24231 need several hundred emails in both collections.
24232
24233 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
24234 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
24235 per mail. Use the following:
24236
24237 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
24238 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
24239 is treated as one spam mail.
24240 @end defun
24241
24242 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
24243 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
24244 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
24245 @end defun
24246
24247 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
24248 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds
24249 the the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
24250 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
24251 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds the the group
24252 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
24253
24254 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
24255 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
24256 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
24257 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
24258 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
24259
24260 @defvar spam-stat
24261 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
24262 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
24263 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
24264 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
24265 @end defvar
24266
24267 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
24268 reset the dictionary.
24269
24270 @defun spam-stat-reset
24271 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
24272 @end defun
24273
24274 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
24275 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
24276 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
24277 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
24278 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
24279 only non-spam mails.
24280
24281 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
24282 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
24283 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24284 @end defun
24285
24286 @defun spam-stat-save
24287 Save the dictionary.
24288 @end defun
24289
24290 @defvar spam-stat-file
24291 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24292 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24293 @end defvar
24294
24295 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24296 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24297
24298 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
24299 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
24300
24301 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24302
24303 @lisp
24304 (require 'spam-stat)
24305 (spam-stat-load)
24306 @end lisp
24307
24308 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24309 created.
24310
24311 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24312 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24313 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24314 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24315
24316 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24317 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24318 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24319 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24320
24321 @lisp
24322 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24323 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24324 "mail.misc"))
24325 @end lisp
24326
24327 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24328 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24329 @end defvar
24330
24331 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24332 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24333 expression are considered potential spam.
24334
24335 @lisp
24336 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24337 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24338 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24339 "mail.misc"))
24340 @end lisp
24341
24342 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24343 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24344 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24345 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24346 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24347
24348 @lisp
24349 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24350 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24351 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24352 "mail.misc"))
24353 @end lisp
24354
24355 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24356 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24357 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24358 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24359 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24360 dictionary!
24361
24362 @lisp
24363 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24364 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24365 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24366 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24367 "mail.misc"))
24368 @end lisp
24369
24370
24371 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24372 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24373
24374 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24375
24376 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24377 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24378 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24379 @end defun
24380
24381 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24382 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24383 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24384 @end defun
24385
24386 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24387 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24388 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24389 already been processed as non-spam.
24390 @end defun
24391
24392 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
24393 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
24394 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
24395 been processed as spam.
24396 @end defun
24397
24398 @defun spam-stat-save
24399 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
24400 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24401 @end defun
24402
24403 @defun spam-stat-load
24404 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
24405 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24406 @end defun
24407
24408 @defun spam-stat-score-word
24409 Return the spam score for a word.
24410 @end defun
24411
24412 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
24413 Return the spam score for a buffer.
24414 @end defun
24415
24416 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
24417 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
24418 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24419 @end defun
24420
24421 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
24422 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24423
24424 @lisp
24425 (require 'spam-stat)
24426 (spam-stat-load)
24427 @end lisp
24428
24429 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
24430
24431 @smallexample
24432 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24433 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24434 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24435 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24436 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24437 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24438 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24439 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24440 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24441 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24442 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
24443 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
24444 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24445 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24446 @end smallexample
24447
24448 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
24449
24450 @smallexample
24451 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24452 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24453 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24454 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
24455 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
24456 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24457 @end smallexample
24458
24459 @node Other modes
24460 @section Interaction with other modes
24461
24462 @subsection Dired
24463 @cindex dired
24464
24465 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provided some useful functions for dired
24466 buffers. It is enabled with
24467 @lisp
24468 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
24469 @end lisp
24470
24471 @table @kbd
24472 @item C-c C-m C-a
24473 @findex gnus-dired-attach
24474 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
24475 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
24476
24477 @item C-c C-m C-l
24478 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
24479 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
24480 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
24481 buffer.
24482
24483 @item C-c C-m C-p
24484 @findex gnus-dired-print
24485 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
24486 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
24487 @end table
24488
24489 @node Various Various
24490 @section Various Various
24491 @cindex mode lines
24492 @cindex highlights
24493
24494 @table @code
24495
24496 @item gnus-home-directory
24497 @vindex gnus-home-directory
24498 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
24499 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
24500
24501 @item gnus-directory
24502 @vindex gnus-directory
24503 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
24504 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
24505 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
24506
24507 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
24508 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
24509 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
24510 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
24511
24512 @item gnus-default-directory
24513 @vindex gnus-default-directory
24514 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
24515 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
24516 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
24517 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
24518 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
24519 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
24520
24521 @item gnus-verbose
24522 @vindex gnus-verbose
24523 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
24524 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
24525 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
24526 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
24527 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
24528
24529 @item gnus-verbose-backends
24530 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
24531 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
24532 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
24533
24534 @item nnheader-max-head-length
24535 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
24536 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
24537 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
24538 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
24539 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
24540 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
24541 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
24542 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
24543 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
24544
24545 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
24546 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
24547 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
24548 read when doing the operation described above.
24549
24550 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24551 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24552 @cindex file names
24553 @cindex invalid characters in file names
24554 @cindex characters in file names
24555 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
24556 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
24557 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
24558
24559 @lisp
24560 @group
24561 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
24562 '((?: . ?_)))
24563 @end group
24564 @end lisp
24565
24566 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
24567 Windows (phooey) systems.
24568
24569 @item gnus-hidden-properties
24570 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
24571 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
24572 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
24573 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
24574
24575 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
24576 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
24577 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
24578 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
24579 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
24580
24581 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
24582 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
24583 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
24584
24585 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24586 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
24587
24588 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
24589 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
24590 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
24591 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
24592 group).
24593
24594 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
24595
24596
24597 @end table
24598
24599 @node The End
24600 @chapter The End
24601
24602 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
24603 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
24604
24605 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
24606
24607 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
24608
24609 @quotation
24610 @strong{Te Deum}
24611
24612 @sp 1
24613 Not because of victories @*
24614 I sing,@*
24615 having none,@*
24616 but for the common sunshine,@*
24617 the breeze,@*
24618 the largess of the spring.
24619
24620 @sp 1
24621 Not for victory@*
24622 but for the day's work done@*
24623 as well as I was able;@*
24624 not for a seat upon the dais@*
24625 but at the common table.@*
24626 @end quotation
24627
24628
24629 @node Appendices
24630 @chapter Appendices
24631
24632 @menu
24633 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
24634 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
24635 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
24636 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
24637 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
24638 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
24639 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
24640 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
24641 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
24642 @end menu
24643
24644
24645 @node XEmacs
24646 @section XEmacs
24647 @cindex XEmacs
24648 @cindex installing under XEmacs
24649
24650 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
24651 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
24652 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
24653 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
24654 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
24655 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
24656
24657
24658 @node History
24659 @section History
24660
24661 @cindex history
24662 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
24663 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
24664
24665 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
24666 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
24667 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
24668 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
24669 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
24670
24671 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
24672 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
24673 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
24674 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
24675 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
24676 appropriate name, don't you think?)
24677
24678 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
24679 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
24680 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
24681 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
24682
24683 @menu
24684 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
24685 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
24686 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
24687 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
24688 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
24689 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
24690 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
24691 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
24692 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
24693 @end menu
24694
24695
24696 @node Gnus Versions
24697 @subsection Gnus Versions
24698 @cindex ding Gnus
24699 @cindex September Gnus
24700 @cindex Red Gnus
24701 @cindex Quassia Gnus
24702 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
24703 @cindex Oort Gnus
24704 @cindex No Gnus
24705 @cindex Gnus versions
24706
24707 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
24708 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
24709 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
24710
24711 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
24712 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
24713
24714 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
24715 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
24716
24717 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
24718 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
24719
24720 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
24721 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
24722 1999.
24723
24724 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
24725 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
24726
24727 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
24728
24729 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
24730 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
24731 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'' -- don't panic.
24732 Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever
24733 you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach.
24734 Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
24735
24736
24737 @node Other Gnus Versions
24738 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
24739 @cindex Semi-gnus
24740
24741 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
24742 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
24743 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
24744 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
24745
24746 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
24747 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
24748 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
24749 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
24750 Japanese users.
24751
24752
24753 @node Why?
24754 @subsection Why?
24755
24756 What's the point of Gnus?
24757
24758 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
24759 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
24760 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
24761 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
24762 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
24763 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
24764 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
24765 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
24766 keep track of millions of people who post?
24767
24768 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
24769 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
24770 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
24771 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
24772 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
24773 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
24774 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
24775 every one of you to explore and invent.
24776
24777 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
24778 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
24779
24780
24781 @node Compatibility
24782 @subsection Compatibility
24783
24784 @cindex compatibility
24785 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
24786 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
24787 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
24788
24789 Our motto is:
24790 @quotation
24791 @cartouche
24792 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
24793 @end cartouche
24794 @end quotation
24795
24796 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
24797 their names.
24798
24799 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
24800 Articles}.
24801
24802 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
24803 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
24804 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
24805 important variables have their values copied into their global
24806 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
24807 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
24808
24809 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
24810 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
24811 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
24812 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
24813 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
24814 peculiar results.
24815
24816 @cindex hilit19
24817 @cindex highlighting
24818 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
24819 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
24820 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
24821 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
24822 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
24823 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
24824 Away!
24825
24826 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
24827 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
24828 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
24829 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
24830
24831 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
24832 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
24833 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
24834 to stop doing it the old way.
24835
24836 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
24837
24838 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
24839 @findex gnus-bug
24840 @cindex reporting bugs
24841 @cindex bugs
24842 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
24843 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
24844 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
24845
24846 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
24847 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
24848 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
24849 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
24850 up at you.
24851
24852
24853 @node Conformity
24854 @subsection Conformity
24855
24856 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
24857 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
24858 with, of course.
24859
24860 @table @strong
24861
24862 @item RFC (2)822
24863 @cindex RFC 822
24864 @cindex RFC 2822
24865 There are no known breaches of this standard.
24866
24867 @item RFC 1036
24868 @cindex RFC 1036
24869 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
24870
24871 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
24872 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
24873 We do have some breaches to this one.
24874
24875 @table @emph
24876
24877 @item X-Newsreader
24878 @itemx User-Agent
24879 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
24880 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
24881 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
24882 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
24883 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
24884 @end table
24885
24886 @item USEFOR
24887 @cindex USEFOR
24888 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
24889 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
24890 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
24891 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
24892
24893 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
24894 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
24895 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
24896
24897 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
24898 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
24899
24900 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
24901 @cindex RFC 1991
24902 @cindex RFC 2440
24903 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
24904 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
24905 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
24906 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
24907 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
24908 decryption).
24909
24910 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
24911 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
24912 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
24913 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
24914
24915 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
24916 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
24917
24918 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
24919 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
24920 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
24921 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
24922 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
24923 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
24924 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
24925 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
24926
24927 @end table
24928
24929 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
24930 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
24931 know.
24932
24933
24934 @node Emacsen
24935 @subsection Emacsen
24936 @cindex Emacsen
24937 @cindex XEmacs
24938 @cindex Mule
24939 @cindex Emacs
24940
24941 Gnus should work on:
24942
24943 @itemize @bullet
24944
24945 @item
24946 Emacs 21.1 and up.
24947
24948 @item
24949 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
24950
24951 @end itemize
24952
24953 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
24954 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
24955 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
24956 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
24957
24958 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
24959 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
24960 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
24961 Emacsen.
24962
24963
24964 @node Gnus Development
24965 @subsection Gnus Development
24966
24967 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
24968 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
24969 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
24970 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
24971 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
24972 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
24973 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
24974 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
24975
24976 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
24977 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
24978 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
24979 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
24980 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
24981
24982 @cindex Incoming*
24983 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
24984 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
24985 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
24986 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
24987 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
24988
24989 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
24990 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
24991 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
24992 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
24993 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
24994 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
24995 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
24996 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
24997 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
24998 can't be assumed to do so.
24999
25000
25001
25002 @node Contributors
25003 @subsection Contributors
25004 @cindex contributors
25005
25006 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
25007 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
25008 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
25009 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
25010 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
25011 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
25012 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
25013 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
25014 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
25015 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
25016
25017 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
25018 wrong show.
25019
25020 @itemize @bullet
25021
25022 @item
25023 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
25024
25025 @item
25026 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
25027 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
25028 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
25029 functionality and stuff.
25030
25031 @item
25032 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
25033 well as numerous other things).
25034
25035 @item
25036 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
25037
25038 @item
25039 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
25040
25041 @item
25042 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
25043
25044 @item
25045 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
25046
25047 @item
25048 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
25049 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
25050
25051 @item
25052 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
25053
25054 @item
25055 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
25056 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25057
25058 @item
25059 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
25060
25061 @item
25062 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
25063
25064 @item
25065 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
25066
25067 @item
25068 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
25069
25070 @item
25071 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
25072 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
25073
25074 @item
25075 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
25076
25077 @item
25078 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
25079
25080 @item
25081 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
25082
25083 @item
25084 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
25085 .newsrc files.
25086
25087 @item
25088 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
25089
25090 @item
25091 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
25092
25093 @item
25094 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
25095
25096 @item
25097 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
25098 well as autoconf support.
25099
25100 @end itemize
25101
25102 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
25103 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
25104
25105 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
25106
25107 Christopher Davis,
25108 Andrew Eskilsson,
25109 Kai Grossjohann,
25110 Kevin Greiner,
25111 Jesper Harder,
25112 Paul Jarc,
25113 Simon Josefsson,
25114 David KÃ¥gedal,
25115 Richard Pieri,
25116 Fabrice Popineau,
25117 Daniel Quinlan,
25118 Michael Shields,
25119 Reiner Steib,
25120 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
25121 Jack Vinson,
25122 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
25123 and
25124 Teodor Zlatanov.
25125
25126 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
25127
25128 Jari Aalto,
25129 Adrian Aichner,
25130 Vladimir Alexiev,
25131 Russ Allbery,
25132 Peter Arius,
25133 Matt Armstrong,
25134 Marc Auslander,
25135 Miles Bader,
25136 Alexei V. Barantsev,
25137 Frank Bennett,
25138 Robert Bihlmeyer,
25139 Chris Bone,
25140 Mark Borges,
25141 Mark Boyns,
25142 Lance A. Brown,
25143 Rob Browning,
25144 Kees de Bruin,
25145 Martin Buchholz,
25146 Joe Buehler,
25147 Kevin Buhr,
25148 Alastair Burt,
25149 Joao Cachopo,
25150 Zlatko Calusic,
25151 Massimo Campostrini,
25152 Castor,
25153 David Charlap,
25154 Dan Christensen,
25155 Kevin Christian,
25156 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
25157 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
25158 Laura Conrad,
25159 Michael R. Cook,
25160 Glenn Coombs,
25161 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
25162 Neil Crellin,
25163 Frank D. Cringle,
25164 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
25165 Andre Deparade,
25166 Ulrik Dickow,
25167 Dave Disser,
25168 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
25169 Joev Dubach,
25170 Michael Welsh Duggan,
25171 Dave Edmondson,
25172 Paul Eggert,
25173 Mark W. Eichin,
25174 Karl Eichwalder,
25175 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
25176 Michael Ernst,
25177 Luc Van Eycken,
25178 Sam Falkner,
25179 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
25180 Sigbjorn Finne,
25181 Sven Fischer,
25182 Paul Fisher,
25183 Decklin Foster,
25184 Gary D. Foster,
25185 Paul Franklin,
25186 Guy Geens,
25187 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
25188 David S. Goldberg,
25189 Michelangelo Grigni,
25190 Dale Hagglund,
25191 D. Hall,
25192 Magnus Hammerin,
25193 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
25194 Raja R. Harinath,
25195 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
25196 P. E. Jareth Hein,
25197 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
25198 Scott Hofmann,
25199 Marc Horowitz,
25200 Gunnar Horrigmo,
25201 Richard Hoskins,
25202 Brad Howes,
25203 Miguel de Icaza,
25204 François Felix Ingrand,
25205 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
25206 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
25207 Lee Iverson,
25208 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
25209 Rajappa Iyer,
25210 Andreas Jaeger,
25211 Adam P. Jenkins,
25212 Randell Jesup,
25213 Fred Johansen,
25214 Gareth Jones,
25215 Greg Klanderman,
25216 Karl Kleinpaste,
25217 Michael Klingbeil,
25218 Peter Skov Knudsen,
25219 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
25220 Petr Konecny,
25221 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
25222 Thor Kristoffersen,
25223 Jens Lautenbacher,
25224 Martin Larose,
25225 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
25226 Joerg Lenneis,
25227 Carsten Leonhardt,
25228 James LewisMoss,
25229 Christian Limpach,
25230 Markus Linnala,
25231 Dave Love,
25232 Mike McEwan,
25233 Tonny Madsen,
25234 Shlomo Mahlab,
25235 Nat Makarevitch,
25236 Istvan Marko,
25237 David Martin,
25238 Jason R. Mastaler,
25239 Gordon Matzigkeit,
25240 Timo Metzemakers,
25241 Richard Mlynarik,
25242 Lantz Moore,
25243 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
25244 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
25245 Hrvoje Niksic,
25246 Andy Norman,
25247 Fred Oberhauser,
25248 C. R. Oldham,
25249 Alexandre Oliva,
25250 Ken Olstad,
25251 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
25252 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
25253 Ettore Perazzoli,
25254 William Perry,
25255 Stephen Peters,
25256 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
25257 Ulrich Pfeifer,
25258 Matt Pharr,
25259 Andy Piper,
25260 John McClary Prevost,
25261 Bill Pringlemeir,
25262 Mike Pullen,
25263 Jim Radford,
25264 Colin Rafferty,
25265 Lasse Rasinen,
25266 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
25267 Joe Reiss,
25268 Renaud Rioboo,
25269 Roland B. Roberts,
25270 Bart Robinson,
25271 Christian von Roques,
25272 Markus Rost,
25273 Jason Rumney,
25274 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
25275 Jay Sachs,
25276 Dewey M. Sasser,
25277 Conrad Sauerwald,
25278 Loren Schall,
25279 Dan Schmidt,
25280 Ralph Schleicher,
25281 Philippe Schnoebelen,
25282 Andreas Schwab,
25283 Randal L. Schwartz,
25284 Danny Siu,
25285 Matt Simmons,
25286 Paul D. Smith,
25287 Jeff Sparkes,
25288 Toby Speight,
25289 Michael Sperber,
25290 Darren Stalder,
25291 Richard Stallman,
25292 Greg Stark,
25293 Sam Steingold,
25294 Paul Stevenson,
25295 Jonas Steverud,
25296 Paul Stodghill,
25297 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25298 Kurt Swanson,
25299 Samuel Tardieu,
25300 Teddy,
25301 Chuck Thompson,
25302 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25303 Philippe Troin,
25304 James Troup,
25305 Trung Tran-Duc,
25306 Jack Twilley,
25307 Aaron M. Ucko,
25308 Aki Vehtari,
25309 Didier Verna,
25310 Vladimir Volovich,
25311 Jan Vroonhof,
25312 Stefan Waldherr,
25313 Pete Ware,
25314 Barry A. Warsaw,
25315 Christoph Wedler,
25316 Joe Wells,
25317 Lee Willis,
25318 and
25319 Lloyd Zusman.
25320
25321
25322 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25323 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25324 (550kB and counting).
25325
25326 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25327 sure.
25328
25329 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25330 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25331
25332
25333 @node New Features
25334 @subsection New Features
25335 @cindex new features
25336
25337 @menu
25338 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25339 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25340 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25341 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25342 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25343 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
25344 @end menu
25345
25346 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25347 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25348 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25349
25350 @node ding Gnus
25351 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25352
25353 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25354
25355 @itemize @bullet
25356
25357 @item
25358 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25359 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25360
25361 @item
25362 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25363 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25364
25365 @item
25366 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25367
25368 @item
25369 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25370 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25371 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25372
25373 @item
25374 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25375 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25376 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25377 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25378
25379 @item
25380 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25381 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25382
25383 @item
25384 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25385 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25386 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25387
25388 @item
25389 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25390 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
25391
25392 @item
25393 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
25394 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
25395 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25396
25397 @item
25398 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
25399 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
25400 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
25401
25402 @item
25403 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
25404 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
25405
25406 @item
25407 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
25408 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
25409
25410 @item
25411 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
25412 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
25413
25414 @item
25415 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
25416 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25417
25418 @item
25419 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
25420 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
25421
25422 @item
25423 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
25424 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25425
25426 @item
25427 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
25428
25429 @item
25430 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
25431 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
25432
25433 @item
25434 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
25435 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
25436
25437 @item
25438 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
25439 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25440
25441 @item
25442 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
25443
25444 @item
25445 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
25446 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25447
25448 @item
25449 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
25450 Articles}).
25451
25452 @item
25453 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
25454 Buttons}).
25455
25456 @item
25457 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
25458 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
25459
25460 @item
25461 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
25462 (@pxref{Buttons}).
25463
25464 @end itemize
25465
25466
25467 @node September Gnus
25468 @subsubsection September Gnus
25469
25470 @iftex
25471 @iflatex
25472 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
25473 @end iflatex
25474 @end iftex
25475
25476 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
25477
25478 @itemize @bullet
25479
25480 @item
25481 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
25482 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
25483 now obsolete.
25484
25485 @item
25486 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
25487 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
25488 Threading}).
25489
25490 @lisp
25491 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
25492 @end lisp
25493
25494 @item
25495 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
25496 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
25497
25498 @item
25499 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
25500 referred.
25501
25502 @item
25503 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25504
25505 @item
25506 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
25507
25508 @item
25509 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
25510
25511 @lisp
25512 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
25513 @end lisp
25514
25515 @item
25516 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
25517 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
25518
25519 @lisp
25520 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
25521 @end lisp
25522
25523 @item
25524 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
25525 Groups}).
25526
25527 @item
25528 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
25529 Topics}).
25530
25531 @lisp
25532 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
25533 @end lisp
25534
25535 @item
25536 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
25537
25538 @item
25539 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
25540 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
25541
25542 @lisp
25543 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
25544 @end lisp
25545
25546 @item
25547 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
25548 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
25549
25550 @item
25551 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
25552
25553 @item
25554 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
25555 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
25556 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
25557
25558 @item
25559 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
25560 (@pxref{SOUP}).
25561
25562 @item
25563 The Gnus cache is much faster.
25564
25565 @item
25566 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
25567 Groups}).
25568
25569 @item
25570 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
25571 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
25572
25573 @item
25574 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
25575 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
25576
25577 @item
25578 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
25579 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
25580
25581 @item
25582 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
25583 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
25584 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
25585
25586 @item
25587 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
25588 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
25589
25590 @item
25591 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
25592
25593 @item
25594 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25595
25596 @item
25597 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
25598
25599 @item
25600 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
25601
25602 @item
25603 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
25604 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
25605
25606 @item
25607 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
25608 Layout}).
25609
25610 @item
25611 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
25612 @iftex
25613 @iflatex
25614 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
25615 @end iflatex
25616 @end iftex
25617
25618 @item
25619 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
25620
25621 @lisp
25622 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
25623 @end lisp
25624
25625 @item
25626 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25627
25628 @lisp
25629 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
25630 @end lisp
25631
25632 @item
25633 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
25634
25635 @item
25636 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
25637
25638 @item
25639 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
25640 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25641
25642 @lisp
25643 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
25644 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
25645 @end lisp
25646
25647 @item
25648 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
25649 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
25650
25651 @lisp
25652 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
25653 @end lisp
25654
25655 @item
25656 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
25657 buffer to allow easier treatment.
25658
25659 @item
25660 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
25661
25662 @item
25663 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
25664 Articles}).
25665
25666 @lisp
25667 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
25668 @end lisp
25669
25670 @item
25671 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
25672 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
25673
25674 @lisp
25675 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
25676 @end lisp
25677
25678 @item
25679 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
25680 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
25681
25682 @item
25683 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
25684 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25685
25686 @lisp
25687 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
25688 @end lisp
25689
25690 @item
25691 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
25692
25693 @item
25694 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
25695
25696 @item
25697 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
25698
25699 @end itemize
25700
25701
25702 @node Red Gnus
25703 @subsubsection Red Gnus
25704
25705 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
25706
25707 @iftex
25708 @iflatex
25709 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
25710 @end iflatex
25711 @end iftex
25712
25713 @itemize @bullet
25714
25715 @item
25716 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
25717
25718 @item
25719 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
25720 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25721
25722 @item
25723 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
25724 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
25725 Scoring}).
25726
25727 @item
25728 Article washing status can be displayed in the
25729 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
25730
25731 @item
25732 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
25733
25734 @item
25735 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
25736 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
25737
25738 @lisp
25739 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
25740 @end lisp
25741
25742 @item
25743 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
25744 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
25745 been added.
25746
25747 @item
25748 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
25749 Server Internals}).
25750
25751 @item
25752 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
25753 Parameters}).
25754
25755 @item
25756 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
25757
25758 @item
25759 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
25760 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
25761
25762 @item
25763 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
25764 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
25765 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
25766
25767 @item
25768 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
25769 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25770
25771 @item
25772 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
25773 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
25774
25775 @item
25776 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
25777 (@pxref{Undo}).
25778
25779 @item
25780 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
25781 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25782
25783 @item
25784 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
25785 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25786
25787 @lisp
25788 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
25789 @end lisp
25790
25791 @item
25792 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
25793
25794 @lisp
25795 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
25796 @end lisp
25797
25798 @item
25799 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
25800 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
25801
25802 @item
25803 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
25804 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
25805
25806 @item
25807 A new command for reading collections of documents
25808 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
25809 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
25810
25811 @item
25812 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
25813 Marks}).
25814
25815 @item
25816 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
25817 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
25818
25819 @item
25820 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
25821 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
25822 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
25823
25824 @item
25825 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
25826 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
25827 Sorting}).
25828
25829 @item
25830 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
25831 Groups}).
25832
25833 @item
25834 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
25835 Commands}).
25836 @iftex
25837 @iflatex
25838 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
25839 @end iflatex
25840 @end iftex
25841
25842 @item
25843 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
25844 Variables}).
25845
25846 @item
25847 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
25848 Mail}).
25849
25850 @item
25851 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
25852 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
25853
25854 @item
25855 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
25856
25857 @end itemize
25858
25859
25860 @node Quassia Gnus
25861 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
25862
25863 New features in Gnus 5.6:
25864
25865 @itemize @bullet
25866
25867 @item
25868 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
25869 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
25870 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
25871
25872 @item
25873 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
25874 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
25875 group, which is created automatically.
25876
25877 @item
25878 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
25879 values.
25880
25881 @item
25882 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
25883
25884 @item
25885 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
25886 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
25887
25888 @item
25889 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
25890 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
25891
25892 @item
25893 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
25894
25895 @item
25896 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
25897 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
25898
25899 @item
25900 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
25901
25902 @item
25903 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
25904 details.
25905
25906 @item
25907 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
25908 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
25909
25910 @item
25911 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
25912 control over simplification.
25913
25914 @item
25915 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
25916
25917 @item
25918 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
25919 limit.
25920
25921 @item
25922 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
25923
25924 @item
25925 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
25926
25927 @item
25928 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
25929 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
25930 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
25931
25932 @item
25933 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
25934 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
25935
25936 @item
25937 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
25938 text---@kbd{W d}.
25939
25940 @item
25941 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
25942 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
25943
25944 @item
25945 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
25946 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
25947
25948 @item
25949 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
25950 has been added.
25951
25952 @item
25953 A history of where mails have been split is available.
25954
25955 @item
25956 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
25957
25958 @item
25959 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
25960 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
25961
25962 @item
25963 A new function for citing in Message has been
25964 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
25965
25966 @item
25967 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
25968
25969 @item
25970 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
25971 been added.
25972
25973 @item
25974 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
25975 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
25976
25977 @item
25978 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
25979 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
25980
25981 @item
25982 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
25983
25984 @item
25985 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
25986
25987 @end itemize
25988
25989 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
25990 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
25991
25992 New features in Gnus 5.8:
25993
25994 @itemize @bullet
25995
25996 @item
25997 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
25998 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
25999
26000 If you used procmail like in
26001
26002 @lisp
26003 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
26004 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
26005 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
26006 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
26007 @end lisp
26008
26009 this now has changed to
26010
26011 @lisp
26012 (setq mail-sources
26013 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
26014 :suffix ".in")))
26015 @end lisp
26016
26017 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
26018
26019 @item
26020 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
26021 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
26022
26023 @item
26024 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
26025 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
26026
26027 @item
26028 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
26029 called to position point.
26030
26031 @item
26032 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
26033 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
26034
26035 @item
26036 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
26037 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
26038
26039 @item
26040 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
26041 subtly different manner.
26042
26043 @item
26044 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
26045 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
26046 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
26047
26048 @item
26049 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
26050
26051 @end itemize
26052
26053 @node Oort Gnus
26054 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
26055 @cindex Oort Gnus
26056
26057 New features in Gnus 5.10:
26058
26059 @itemize @bullet
26060
26061 @item Installation changes
26062 @c ***********************
26063
26064 @itemize @bullet
26065 @item
26066 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
26067
26068 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
26069 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
26070 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
26071 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
26072 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
26073 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
26074 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
26075 isn't save in general.
26076
26077 @item
26078 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
26079
26080 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
26081 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
26082 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, iff you want
26083 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
26084 the second parameter.
26085
26086 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
26087 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
26088 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
26089 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
26090 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
26091 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
26092 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
26093 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
26094 cycle used under Unix systems.
26095
26096 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
26097 superfluous, so they have been removed.
26098
26099 @item
26100 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26101
26102 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26103 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26104 hierarchy.
26105
26106 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
26107 @c CVS. We should find a better place for this item.
26108 @item
26109 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26110
26111 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26112 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26113 lisp directory into load-path.
26114
26115 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26116 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26117
26118 @end itemize
26119
26120 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
26121 @c *****************************************
26122
26123 @itemize @bullet
26124
26125 @item
26126 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
26127 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
26128
26129 @item
26130 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
26131
26132 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
26133 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
26134 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
26135 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
26136
26137 @item
26138 Improved anti-spam features.
26139
26140 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26141 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26142 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26143 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26144 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26145 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
26146
26147 @item
26148 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26149
26150 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26151 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26152 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26153 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26154 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26155
26156 @end itemize
26157
26158 @item Changes in group mode
26159 @c ************************
26160
26161 @itemize @bullet
26162
26163 @item
26164 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
26165 using @kbd{G M}.
26166
26167 @item
26168 Retrieval of charters and control messages
26169
26170 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
26171 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
26172
26173 @item
26174 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
26175
26176 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
26177 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
26178 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
26179 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
26180 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
26181 parameters, a'la:
26182 @lisp
26183 (setq gnus-parameters
26184 '(("mail\\..*"
26185 (gnus-show-threads nil)
26186 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
26187 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
26188 (to-group . "\\1"))))
26189 @end lisp
26190
26191 @item
26192 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26193
26194 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26195 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26196 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26197 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26198 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26199 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26200 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26201 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26202 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26203
26204 @item
26205 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26206
26207 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26208 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26209 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26210
26211 @item
26212 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26213 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26214
26215 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26216 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26217 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26218 @lisp
26219 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26220 @end lisp
26221
26222 @end itemize
26223
26224 @item Changes in summary and article mode
26225 @c **************************************
26226
26227 @itemize @bullet
26228
26229 @item
26230 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
26231 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
26232 region if the region is active.
26233
26234 @item
26235 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
26236 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
26237
26238 @item
26239 Article Buttons
26240
26241 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
26242 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
26243 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
26244 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
26245
26246 @item
26247 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
26248
26249 @item
26250 Picons
26251
26252 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
26253 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
26254
26255 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
26256 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
26257 @xref{Picons}.
26258
26259 @item
26260 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
26261 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
26262
26263 @item
26264 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
26265
26266 @item
26267 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
26268 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
26269
26270 @item
26271 Warn about email replies to news
26272
26273 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
26274 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
26275 you.
26276
26277 @item
26278 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
26279 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
26280 built.
26281
26282 @item
26283 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
26284 opposed to old but unread messages).
26285
26286 @item
26287 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
26288 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
26289
26290 @item
26291 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
26292 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
26293
26294 @item
26295 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
26296 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
26297
26298 @item
26299 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
26300
26301 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
26302 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
26303 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
26304 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
26305 citations.
26306
26307 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
26308 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
26309 Outlook (Express) articles.
26310
26311 @item
26312 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
26313
26314 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
26315 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
26316 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
26317 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
26318
26319 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
26320 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
26321 message cited below.
26322
26323 @item
26324 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now displayed graphically in
26325 Emacs too.
26326
26327 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
26328 disable it.
26329
26330 @item
26331 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
26332
26333 @item
26334 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26335 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26336
26337 @item
26338 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26339
26340 @item
26341 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26342
26343 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26344 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26345 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26346 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26347 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26348 groups.
26349
26350 @item
26351 Deleting of attachments.
26352
26353 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26354 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26355 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26356 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26357 that support editing.
26358
26359 @item
26360 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26361
26362 The default value is determined from the
26363 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26364 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26365 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26366
26367 @item
26368 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26369
26370 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26371 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26372 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26373
26374 @item
26375 Extended format specs.
26376
26377 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26378 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26379 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26380 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26381 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26382 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
26383
26384 @item
26385 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
26386 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
26387
26388 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
26389 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
26390 out other articles.
26391
26392 @item
26393 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
26394
26395 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
26396 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
26397 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
26398 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
26399
26400 @item
26401 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
26402
26403 @end itemize
26404
26405 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
26406 @c ****************************************************
26407
26408 @itemize @bullet
26409
26410 @item
26411 Delayed articles
26412
26413 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
26414 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
26415 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
26416
26417 @item
26418 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
26419 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
26420
26421 @item
26422 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
26423 Gcc articles as read.
26424
26425 @item
26426 Externalizing of attachments
26427
26428 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
26429 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
26430 local files as external parts.
26431
26432 @item
26433 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
26434 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
26435
26436 @item
26437 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
26438
26439 Earlier it was generated iff the user configurable email address was
26440 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
26441 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
26442 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
26443 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
26444 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
26445 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
26446 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
26447 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
26448
26449 @item
26450 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
26451
26452 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
26453 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
26454 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
26455 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
26456 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
26457 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
26458
26459 @item
26460 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
26461 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
26462 @code{nil}.
26463
26464 @item
26465 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
26466
26467 @item
26468 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
26469
26470 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
26471 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
26472 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
26473 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
26474 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
26475 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
26476 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
26477 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
26478 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
26479 was inserted directly.
26480
26481 @item
26482 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
26483
26484 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
26485 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
26486 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
26487 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
26488
26489 @item
26490 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
26491
26492 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
26493 @lisp
26494 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
26495 'bbdb-complete-name)
26496 @end lisp
26497
26498 @item
26499 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
26500
26501 Add a new format of match like
26502 @lisp
26503 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
26504 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26505 @end lisp
26506 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
26507 @lisp
26508 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
26509 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
26510 @end lisp
26511
26512 @item
26513 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
26514
26515 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
26516 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
26517 need add those two headers too.
26518
26519 @item
26520 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
26521 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
26522 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
26523 versions.
26524
26525 @item
26526 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
26527 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
26528 inline PGP signed messages. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
26529
26530 @item
26531 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
26532
26533 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
26534
26535 @item
26536 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
26537
26538 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
26539 the valid values.
26540
26541 @item
26542 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
26543
26544 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
26545 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
26546 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
26547 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
26548 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
26549 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
26550 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
26551 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
26552
26553 @item
26554 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
26555 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
26556
26557 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
26558 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
26559 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
26560 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
26561
26562 @item
26563 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
26564 C-m}.
26565
26566 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
26567 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
26568
26569 @item
26570 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
26571 @code{best}.
26572
26573 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
26574 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
26575 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
26576 invalidate the digital signature.
26577
26578 @item
26579 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
26580 decompressed when activated.
26581 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
26582
26583 @item
26584 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
26585
26586 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
26587 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
26588 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
26589 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
26590 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
26591 controls this.
26592
26593 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
26594 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
26595 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
26596 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11
26597
26598 @end itemize
26599
26600 @item Changes in back ends
26601 @c ***********************
26602
26603 @itemize @bullet
26604 @item
26605 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
26606
26607 @item
26608 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
26609
26610 @item
26611 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
26612
26613 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
26614
26615 @item
26616 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
26617
26618 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
26619 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
26620 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
26621 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
26622 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
26623 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
26624 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
26625 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
26626 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
26627 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
26628 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
26629
26630 @end itemize
26631
26632 @item Appearance
26633 @c *************
26634
26635 @itemize @bullet
26636
26637 @item
26638 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
26639 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
26640
26641 @item
26642 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
26643 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
26644 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
26645 message, Message Manual}).
26646
26647 @item
26648 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
26649 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars. This is a new
26650 feature in Gnus 5.10.9. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
26651
26652 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
26653 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
26654 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
26655 in Gnus 5.10.9.
26656 @end itemize
26657
26658
26659 @item Miscellaneous changes
26660 @c ************************
26661
26662 @itemize @bullet
26663
26664 @item
26665 @code{gnus-agent}
26666
26667 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
26668 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
26669 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
26670 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
26671 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
26672 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
26673 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
26674 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
26675 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
26676 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
26677 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
26678 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
26679 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
26680 is not needed any more.
26681
26682 @item
26683 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
26684
26685 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
26686 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
26687 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
26688
26689 @item
26690 Dired integration
26691
26692 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
26693 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
26694 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
26695 entry.
26696
26697 @item
26698 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
26699
26700 @item
26701 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
26702
26703 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
26704
26705 @end itemize
26706
26707 @end itemize
26708
26709 @iftex
26710
26711 @page
26712 @node The Manual
26713 @section The Manual
26714 @cindex colophon
26715 @cindex manual
26716
26717 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
26718 either @code{texi2dvi}
26719 @iflatex
26720 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
26721 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
26722 @end iflatex
26723 to get what you hold in your hands now.
26724
26725 The following conventions have been used:
26726
26727 @enumerate
26728
26729 @item
26730 This is a @samp{string}
26731
26732 @item
26733 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
26734
26735 @item
26736 This is a @file{file}
26737
26738 @item
26739 This is a @code{symbol}
26740
26741 @end enumerate
26742
26743 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
26744 mean:
26745
26746 @lisp
26747 (setq flargnoze "yes")
26748 @end lisp
26749
26750 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
26751
26752 @lisp
26753 (setq flumphel 'yes)
26754 @end lisp
26755
26756 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
26757 ever get them confused.
26758
26759 @iflatex
26760 @c @head
26761 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
26762 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
26763 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
26764 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
26765 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
26766 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
26767 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
26768 @end iflatex
26769
26770 @end iftex
26771
26772
26773 @node On Writing Manuals
26774 @section On Writing Manuals
26775
26776 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
26777 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
26778 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
26779 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
26780 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
26781 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
26782 hand in hand.
26783
26784 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
26785 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
26786 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
26787 started with Gnus.
26788
26789 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
26790 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
26791
26792
26793 @page
26794 @node Terminology
26795 @section Terminology
26796
26797 @cindex terminology
26798 @table @dfn
26799
26800 @item news
26801 @cindex news
26802 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
26803 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
26804 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
26805 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
26806 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
26807
26808 @item mail
26809 @cindex mail
26810 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
26811 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
26812 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
26813 not posting, and replying is not following up.
26814
26815 @item reply
26816 @cindex reply
26817 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
26818
26819 @item follow up
26820 @cindex follow up
26821 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
26822 are reading.
26823
26824 @item back end
26825 @cindex back end
26826 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
26827 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
26828 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
26829 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
26830 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
26831 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
26832 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
26833 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
26834 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
26835 number 4711''.
26836
26837 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
26838 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
26839 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
26840 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
26841 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
26842 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
26843
26844 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
26845 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
26846 access the articles.
26847
26848 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
26849 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
26850 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
26851 confusing.
26852
26853 @item native
26854 @cindex native
26855 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
26856 default, way of getting news.
26857
26858 @item foreign
26859 @cindex foreign
26860 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
26861 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
26862 news.
26863
26864 @item secondary
26865 @cindex secondary
26866 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
26867 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
26868
26869 @item article
26870 @cindex article
26871 A message that has been posted as news.
26872
26873 @item mail message
26874 @cindex mail message
26875 A message that has been mailed.
26876
26877 @item message
26878 @cindex message
26879 A mail message or news article
26880
26881 @item head
26882 @cindex head
26883 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
26884 put.
26885
26886 @item body
26887 @cindex body
26888 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
26889 body.
26890
26891 @item header
26892 @cindex header
26893 A line from the head of an article.
26894
26895 @item headers
26896 @cindex headers
26897 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
26898 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
26899
26900 @item @acronym{NOV}
26901 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
26902 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
26903 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
26904 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
26905 normal @sc{head} format.
26906
26907 @item level
26908 @cindex levels
26909 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
26910 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
26911 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
26912 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
26913 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
26914 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
26915
26916 @item killed groups
26917 @cindex killed groups
26918 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
26919 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
26920
26921 @item zombie groups
26922 @cindex zombie groups
26923 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
26924
26925 @item active file
26926 @cindex active file
26927 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
26928 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
26929 is rather large, as you might surmise.
26930
26931 @item bogus groups
26932 @cindex bogus groups
26933 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
26934 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
26935 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
26936
26937 @item activating
26938 @cindex activating groups
26939 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
26940 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
26941 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
26942
26943 @item spool
26944 @cindex spool
26945 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
26946 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
26947 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
26948
26949 @item server
26950 @cindex server
26951 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
26952
26953 @item select method
26954 @cindex select method
26955 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
26956 server settings.
26957
26958 @item virtual server
26959 @cindex virtual server
26960 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
26961 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
26962 whole is a virtual server.
26963
26964 @item washing
26965 @cindex washing
26966 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
26967 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
26968 original.
26969
26970 @item ephemeral groups
26971 @cindex ephemeral groups
26972 @cindex temporary groups
26973 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
26974 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
26975 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
26976
26977 @item solid groups
26978 @cindex solid groups
26979 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
26980 group buffer are solid groups.
26981
26982 @item sparse articles
26983 @cindex sparse articles
26984 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
26985 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
26986
26987 @item threading
26988 @cindex threading
26989 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
26990 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
26991
26992 @item root
26993 @cindex root
26994 @cindex thread root
26995 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
26996 articles in the thread.
26997
26998 @item parent
26999 @cindex parent
27000 An article that has responses.
27001
27002 @item child
27003 @cindex child
27004 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
27005
27006 @item digest
27007 @cindex digest
27008 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
27009 specified by RFC 1153.
27010
27011 @item splitting
27012 @cindex splitting, terminology
27013 @cindex mail sorting
27014 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
27015 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
27016 incorrectly called mail filtering.
27017
27018 @end table
27019
27020
27021 @page
27022 @node Customization
27023 @section Customization
27024 @cindex general customization
27025
27026 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
27027 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
27028 for some quite common situations.
27029
27030 @menu
27031 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
27032 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
27033 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
27034 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
27035 @end menu
27036
27037
27038 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
27039 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
27040
27041 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
27042 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
27043 Gnus has to get from the @acronym{NNTP} server.
27044
27045 @table @code
27046
27047 @item gnus-read-active-file
27048 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
27049 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
27050 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
27051 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
27052 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
27053
27054 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
27055 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
27056 the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast. Not all @acronym{NNTP} servers
27057 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
27058 @end table
27059
27060
27061 @node Slow Terminal Connection
27062 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
27063
27064 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
27065 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
27066 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
27067
27068 @table @code
27069
27070 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
27071 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
27072 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
27073 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
27074 horizontal and vertical recentering.
27075
27076 @item gnus-visible-headers
27077 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
27078 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
27079 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
27080 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
27081
27082 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
27083 @lisp
27084 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
27085 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
27086 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
27087 @end lisp
27088
27089 @item gnus-use-full-window
27090 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
27091 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
27092 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
27093 want to read them anyway.
27094
27095 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
27096 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
27097 hidden initially.
27098
27099
27100 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
27101 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
27102 lines, which might save some time.
27103 @end table
27104
27105
27106 @node Little Disk Space
27107 @subsection Little Disk Space
27108 @cindex disk space
27109
27110 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
27111 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
27112
27113 @table @code
27114
27115 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
27116 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
27117 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
27118 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
27119 default.
27120
27121 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
27122 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
27123 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
27124 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
27125 default.
27126
27127 @item gnus-save-killed-list
27128 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
27129 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
27130 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
27131 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
27132
27133 @end table
27134
27135
27136 @node Slow Machine
27137 @subsection Slow Machine
27138 @cindex slow machine
27139
27140 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
27141 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
27142
27143 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
27144 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
27145
27146 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
27147 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
27148 summary buffer faster.
27149
27150
27151 @page
27152 @node Troubleshooting
27153 @section Troubleshooting
27154 @cindex troubleshooting
27155
27156 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
27157 problems, really.
27158
27159 Ahem.
27160
27161 @enumerate
27162
27163 @item
27164 Make sure your computer is switched on.
27165
27166 @item
27167 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
27168 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
27169 Gnus will work.
27170
27171 @item
27172 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
27173 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
27174 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
27175
27176 @item
27177 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
27178 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
27179
27180 @item
27181 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
27182 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
27183 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
27184 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
27185 something like that.
27186 @end enumerate
27187
27188 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
27189
27190 @cindex bugs
27191 @cindex reporting bugs
27192
27193 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
27194 @findex gnus-bug
27195 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
27196 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
27197 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
27198 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
27199
27200 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
27201 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
27202 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
27203 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
27204 time.
27205
27206 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
27207 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
27208 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
27209 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
27210 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
27211 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
27212
27213 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
27214 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
27215 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
27216 the bug report.
27217
27218 @cindex patches
27219 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
27220 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
27221
27222 @cindex edebug
27223 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
27224 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
27225 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
27226 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
27227 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
27228 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
27229 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
27230 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
27231 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
27232 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
27233 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
27234 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
27235 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
27236 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
27237
27238 @cindex elp
27239 @cindex profile
27240 @cindex slow
27241 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
27242 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
27243 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
27244 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
27245 helps isolating the real problem areas).
27246
27247 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
27248 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
27249 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
27250 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
27251 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
27252 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
27253 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
27254 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
27255 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
27256 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
27257 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
27258 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
27259 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
27260 work perfectly.
27261
27262 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
27263 @cindex ding mailing list
27264 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
27265 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
27266 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
27267 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
27268
27269
27270 @page
27271 @node Gnus Reference Guide
27272 @section Gnus Reference Guide
27273
27274 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
27275 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
27276 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
27277 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
27278 it.
27279
27280 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
27281 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
27282 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
27283 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
27284 and general methods of operation.
27285
27286 @menu
27287 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
27288 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
27289 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
27290 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
27291 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
27292 * Group Info:: The group info format.
27293 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
27294 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
27295 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
27296 @end menu
27297
27298
27299 @node Gnus Utility Functions
27300 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
27301 @cindex Gnus utility functions
27302 @cindex utility functions
27303 @cindex functions
27304 @cindex internal variables
27305
27306 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
27307 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
27308 Below is a list of the most common ones.
27309
27310 @table @code
27311
27312 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
27313 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
27314 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
27315
27316 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
27317 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
27318 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
27319
27320 @item gnus-group-real-name
27321 @findex gnus-group-real-name
27322 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
27323 name.
27324
27325 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
27326 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
27327 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
27328 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
27329
27330 @item gnus-get-info
27331 @findex gnus-get-info
27332 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
27333
27334 @item gnus-group-unread
27335 @findex gnus-group-unread
27336 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
27337 unknown.
27338
27339 @item gnus-active
27340 @findex gnus-active
27341 The active entry for @var{group}.
27342
27343 @item gnus-set-active
27344 @findex gnus-set-active
27345 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
27346
27347 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27348 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27349 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
27350 exit.
27351
27352 @item gnus-continuum-version
27353 @findex gnus-continuum-version
27354 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
27355 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
27356 versions.
27357
27358 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
27359 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
27360 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
27361
27362 @item gnus-news-group-p
27363 @findex gnus-news-group-p
27364 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
27365
27366 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27367 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27368 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
27369
27370 @item gnus-server-to-method
27371 @findex gnus-server-to-method
27372 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
27373
27374 @item gnus-server-equal
27375 @findex gnus-server-equal
27376 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
27377
27378 @item gnus-group-native-p
27379 @findex gnus-group-native-p
27380 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
27381
27382 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
27383 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
27384 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
27385
27386 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
27387 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
27388 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
27389
27390 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
27391 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
27392 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
27393 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
27394
27395 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
27396 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
27397 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
27398
27399 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
27400 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
27401 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
27402
27403 @item gnus-check-backend-function
27404 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
27405 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
27406 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
27407
27408 @lisp
27409 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
27410 @result{} t
27411 @end lisp
27412
27413 @item gnus-read-method
27414 @findex gnus-read-method
27415 Prompts the user for a select method.
27416
27417 @end table
27418
27419
27420 @node Back End Interface
27421 @subsection Back End Interface
27422
27423 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
27424 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
27425 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
27426 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
27427 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
27428 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
27429
27430 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
27431 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
27432 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
27433 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
27434 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
27435 been opened, the function should fail.
27436
27437 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
27438 name. Take this example:
27439
27440 @lisp
27441 (nntp "odd-one"
27442 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
27443 (nntp-port-number 4324))
27444 @end lisp
27445
27446 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
27447 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
27448
27449 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
27450 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
27451 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
27452
27453 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
27454 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
27455 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
27456
27457 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
27458 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
27459 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
27460 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
27461 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
27462 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
27463 return value.
27464
27465 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
27466 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
27467 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
27468 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
27469 more.
27470
27471 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
27472 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
27473 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
27474 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
27475 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
27476 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
27477 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
27478 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
27479 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
27480 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
27481
27482 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
27483 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
27484 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
27485 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
27486 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
27487 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
27488 of numbers as long as possible.
27489
27490 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
27491 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
27492 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
27493
27494 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
27495 @code{nnchoke}.
27496
27497 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
27498
27499 @menu
27500 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
27501 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
27502 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
27503 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
27504 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
27505 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
27506 @end menu
27507
27508
27509 @node Required Back End Functions
27510 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
27511
27512 @table @code
27513
27514 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
27515
27516 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
27517 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
27518 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
27519 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
27520
27521 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
27522 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
27523 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
27524 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
27525
27526 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
27527 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
27528 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
27529 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
27530 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
27531 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
27532 number, do maximum fetches.
27533
27534 Here's an example HEAD:
27535
27536 @example
27537 221 1056 Article retrieved.
27538 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
27539 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
27540 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
27541 Subject: Re: Something very droll
27542 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
27543 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
27544 Lines: 26
27545 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
27546 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
27547 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
27548 .
27549 @end example
27550
27551 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
27552 these in the data buffer.
27553
27554 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
27555
27556 @example
27557 headers = *head
27558 head = error / valid-head
27559 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
27560 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
27561 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
27562 header = <text> eol
27563 @end example
27564
27565 @cindex BNF
27566 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
27567
27568 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
27569 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
27570 separated by tabs.
27571
27572 @example
27573 nov-buffer = *nov-line
27574 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
27575 field = <text except TAB>
27576 @end example
27577
27578 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
27579 @pxref{Headers}.
27580
27581
27582 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
27583
27584 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
27585 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
27586
27587 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
27588 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
27589 server. In fact, it should do so.
27590
27591 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
27592 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
27593
27594
27595 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
27596
27597 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
27598 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
27599 reason.
27600
27601 There should be no data returned.
27602
27603
27604 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
27605
27606 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
27607 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
27608 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
27609 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
27610
27611 There should be no data returned.
27612
27613
27614 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
27615
27616 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
27617 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
27618 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
27619 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
27620
27621 There should be no data returned.
27622
27623
27624 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
27625
27626 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
27627
27628 There should be no data returned.
27629
27630
27631 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
27632
27633 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
27634 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
27635 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
27636 it would be nice if that were possible.
27637
27638 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
27639 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
27640 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
27641 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
27642 into its article buffer.
27643
27644 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
27645 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
27646 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
27647 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
27648 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
27649 on successful article retrieval.
27650
27651
27652 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
27653
27654 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
27655 making @var{group} the current group.
27656
27657 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
27658 the current group.
27659
27660 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
27661
27662 @example
27663 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
27664 @end example
27665
27666 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
27667 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
27668 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
27669 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
27670 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
27671 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
27672 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
27673 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
27674 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
27675 highest as 0.
27676
27677 @example
27678 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
27679 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
27680 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
27681 @end example
27682
27683
27684 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27685
27686 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
27687 a no-op on most back ends.
27688
27689 There should be no data returned.
27690
27691
27692 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
27693
27694 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
27695 @emph{all}.
27696
27697 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
27698
27699 @example
27700 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
27701 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
27702 @end example
27703
27704 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
27705 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
27706 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
27707 and the highest as 0.
27708
27709 @example
27710 active-file = *active-line
27711 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
27712 name = <string>
27713 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
27714 @end example
27715
27716 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
27717 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
27718 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
27719
27720
27721 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
27722
27723 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
27724 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
27725 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
27726 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
27727 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
27728 clear if the posting could not be completed.
27729
27730 There should be no result data from this function.
27731
27732 @end table
27733
27734
27735 @node Optional Back End Functions
27736 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
27737
27738 @table @code
27739
27740 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
27741
27742 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
27743 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
27744 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
27745
27746 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
27747 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
27748 former is in the same format as the data from
27749 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
27750 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
27751
27752 @example
27753 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
27754 @end example
27755
27756
27757 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
27758
27759 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
27760 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
27761 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
27762 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
27763 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
27764
27765 There should be no result data from this function.
27766
27767
27768 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
27769
27770 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
27771 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
27772 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
27773 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
27774 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
27775 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
27776 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
27777 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
27778
27779 There should be no result data from this function.
27780
27781
27782 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
27783
27784 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
27785 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
27786 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
27787 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
27788 propagate the mark information to the server.
27789
27790 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
27791
27792 @example
27793 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
27794 @end example
27795
27796 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
27797 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
27798 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
27799 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
27800 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
27801 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
27802 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
27803 possible, not limit itself to these.
27804
27805 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
27806 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
27807 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
27808 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
27809
27810 An example action list:
27811
27812 @example
27813 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
27814 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
27815 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
27816 @end example
27817
27818 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
27819 mark on (currently not used for anything).
27820
27821 There should be no result data from this function.
27822
27823 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
27824
27825 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
27826 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
27827 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
27828 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
27829 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
27830
27831 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
27832 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
27833 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
27834 expirable.
27835
27836 There should be no result data from this function.
27837
27838
27839 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
27840
27841 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
27842 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
27843 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
27844 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
27845 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
27846 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
27847 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
27848 local if that's practical.
27849
27850 There should be no result data from this function.
27851
27852
27853 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
27854
27855 The result data from this function should be a description of
27856 @var{group}.
27857
27858 @example
27859 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
27860 name = <string>
27861 description = <text>
27862 @end example
27863
27864 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
27865
27866 The result data from this function should be the description of all
27867 groups available on the server.
27868
27869 @example
27870 description-buffer = *description-line
27871 @end example
27872
27873
27874 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
27875
27876 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
27877 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
27878 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
27879 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
27880 in the active buffer format.
27881
27882 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
27883 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
27884 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
27885 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
27886 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
27887 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
27888 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
27889
27890
27891 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
27892
27893 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
27894
27895 There should be no return data.
27896
27897
27898 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
27899
27900 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
27901 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
27902 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
27903 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
27904 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
27905 they are.
27906
27907 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
27908 able to delete.
27909
27910 There should be no result data returned.
27911
27912
27913 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
27914
27915 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
27916 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
27917
27918 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
27919 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
27920 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
27921 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
27922 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
27923 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
27924
27925 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
27926 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
27927 optimizations.
27928
27929 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27930 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27931
27932 There should be no data returned.
27933
27934
27935 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
27936
27937 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
27938 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
27939 this function in short order.
27940
27941 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
27942 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
27943
27944 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
27945 article for that group.
27946
27947 There should be no data returned.
27948
27949
27950 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
27951
27952 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
27953 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
27954
27955 There should be no data returned.
27956
27957
27958 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
27959
27960 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
27961 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
27962 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
27963
27964 There should be no data returned.
27965
27966
27967 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
27968
27969 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
27970 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
27971
27972 There should be no data returned.
27973
27974 @end table
27975
27976
27977 @node Error Messaging
27978 @subsubsection Error Messaging
27979
27980 @findex nnheader-report
27981 @findex nnheader-get-report
27982 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
27983 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
27984 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
27985 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
27986 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
27987 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
27988
27989 @lisp
27990 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
27991
27992 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
27993 @end lisp
27994
27995 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
27996 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
27997 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
27998 takes one argument---the server symbol.
27999
28000 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
28001 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
28002 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
28003
28004
28005 @node Writing New Back Ends
28006 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
28007
28008 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
28009 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
28010 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
28011 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
28012 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
28013 editing articles.
28014
28015 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
28016 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
28017 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
28018
28019 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
28020 package called @code{nnoo}.
28021
28022 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
28023 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
28024 following macros:
28025
28026 @table @code
28027
28028 @item nnoo-declare
28029 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
28030 parameters. For instance:
28031
28032 @lisp
28033 (nnoo-declare nndir
28034 nnml nnmh)
28035 @end lisp
28036
28037 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
28038 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
28039
28040 @item defvoo
28041 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
28042 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
28043 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
28044
28045 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
28046 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
28047 a function in those back ends.
28048
28049 @lisp
28050 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
28051 "Where nndir will look for groups."
28052 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
28053 @end lisp
28054
28055 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
28056 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
28057 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
28058
28059 @item nnoo-define-basics
28060 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
28061 have.
28062
28063 @lisp
28064 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
28065 @end lisp
28066
28067 @item deffoo
28068 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
28069 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
28070 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
28071
28072 @item nnoo-map-functions
28073 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
28074 functions from the parent back ends.
28075
28076 @lisp
28077 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
28078 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28079 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
28080 @end lisp
28081
28082 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
28083 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
28084 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
28085 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
28086
28087 @item nnoo-import
28088 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
28089 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
28090 haven't already been defined.
28091
28092 @lisp
28093 (nnoo-import nndir
28094 (nnmh
28095 nnmh-request-list
28096 nnmh-request-newgroups)
28097 (nnml))
28098 @end lisp
28099
28100 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
28101 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
28102 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
28103 defined now.
28104
28105 @end table
28106
28107 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
28108
28109 @lisp
28110 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
28111 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
28112
28113 ;;; @r{Code:}
28114
28115 (require 'nnheader)
28116 (require 'nnmh)
28117 (require 'nnml)
28118 (require 'nnoo)
28119 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
28120
28121 (nnoo-declare nndir
28122 nnml nnmh)
28123
28124 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
28125 "Where nndir will look for groups."
28126 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
28127
28128 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
28129 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
28130 nnml-nov-is-evil)
28131
28132 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
28133 nil
28134 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
28135 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
28136 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
28137
28138 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
28139 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
28140
28141 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
28142
28143 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
28144
28145 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
28146 (setq nndir-directory
28147 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
28148 server))
28149 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
28150 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
28151 (push `(nndir-current-group
28152 ,(file-name-nondirectory
28153 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
28154 defs)
28155 (push `(nndir-top-directory
28156 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
28157 defs)
28158 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
28159
28160 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
28161 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28162 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28163 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
28164 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
28165
28166 (nnoo-import nndir
28167 (nnmh
28168 nnmh-status-message
28169 nnmh-request-list
28170 nnmh-request-newgroups))
28171
28172 (provide 'nndir)
28173 @end lisp
28174
28175
28176 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
28177 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
28178
28179 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
28180 @findex gnus-declare-backend
28181 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
28182 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
28183 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
28184
28185 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
28186 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
28187
28188 Here's an example:
28189
28190 @lisp
28191 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
28192 @end lisp
28193
28194 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
28195
28196 The abilities can be:
28197
28198 @table @code
28199 @item mail
28200 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
28201 @item post
28202 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
28203 @item post-mail
28204 This back end supports both mail and news.
28205 @item none
28206 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
28207 different.
28208 @item respool
28209 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
28210 articles and groups.
28211 @item address
28212 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
28213 true for almost all back ends.
28214 @item prompt-address
28215 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
28216 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
28217 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
28218 @end table
28219
28220
28221 @node Mail-like Back Ends
28222 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
28223
28224 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
28225 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
28226 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
28227 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
28228
28229 @lisp
28230 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
28231 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
28232 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
28233 @end lisp
28234
28235 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
28236 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
28237 mail.
28238
28239 This function takes four parameters.
28240
28241 @table @var
28242 @item method
28243 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
28244 the call.
28245
28246 @item exit-function
28247 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
28248
28249 @item temp-directory
28250 Where the temporary files should be stored.
28251
28252 @item group
28253 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
28254 performed for one group only.
28255 @end table
28256
28257 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
28258 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
28259 find the article number assigned to this article.
28260
28261 The function also uses the following variables:
28262 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
28263 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
28264 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
28265 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
28266 this:
28267
28268 @example
28269 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
28270 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
28271 @end example
28272
28273
28274 @node Score File Syntax
28275 @subsection Score File Syntax
28276
28277 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
28278 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
28279 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
28280
28281 Here's a typical score file:
28282
28283 @lisp
28284 (("summary"
28285 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
28286 ("Gnus"))
28287 ("from"
28288 ("Lars" -1000))
28289 (mark -100))
28290 @end lisp
28291
28292 BNF definition of a score file:
28293
28294 @example
28295 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
28296 element = rule / atom
28297 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
28298 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
28299 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
28300 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
28301 quote = <ascii 34>
28302 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
28303 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
28304 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
28305 date-header = "date"
28306 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28307 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28308 score = "nil" / <integer>
28309 date = "nil" / <natural number>
28310 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
28311 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
28312 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
28313 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
28314 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28315 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28316 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
28317 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28318 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
28319 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
28320 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
28321 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
28322 exclude-files / read-only / touched
28323 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
28324 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
28325 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
28326 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
28327 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
28328 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
28329 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
28330 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
28331 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
28332 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
28333 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
28334 eval = "eval" space <form>
28335 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
28336 @end example
28337
28338 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
28339 discarded.
28340
28341 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
28342 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
28343 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
28344 one looong line, then that's ok.
28345
28346 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
28347 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
28348
28349
28350 @node Headers
28351 @subsection Headers
28352
28353 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
28354 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
28355 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
28356 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
28357
28358 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
28359 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
28360 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
28361 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
28362 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
28363 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
28364 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
28365
28366 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
28367 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
28368 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
28369 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
28370 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
28371
28372 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
28373 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
28374
28375
28376 @node Ranges
28377 @subsection Ranges
28378
28379 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
28380 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
28381
28382 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
28383 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
28384 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
28385 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
28386
28387 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
28388 sequence.
28389
28390 @example
28391 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
28392 @end example
28393
28394 is transformed into
28395
28396 @example
28397 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
28398 @end example
28399
28400 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
28401 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
28402
28403 @example
28404 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
28405 @end example
28406
28407 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
28408 is slightly tricky:
28409
28410 @example
28411 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
28412 @end example
28413
28414 and
28415
28416 @example
28417 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
28418 @end example
28419
28420 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
28421
28422 @example
28423 (1 2 3 4 5)
28424 @end example
28425
28426 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
28427 also valid:
28428
28429 @example
28430 (1 . 5)
28431 @end example
28432
28433 and is equal to the previous range.
28434
28435 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
28436 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
28437 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
28438 range handling.)
28439
28440 @example
28441 range = simple-range / normal-range
28442 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
28443 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
28444 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
28445 number *[ " " contents ]
28446 @end example
28447
28448 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
28449 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
28450 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
28451 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
28452 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
28453 sequences.)
28454
28455
28456 @node Group Info
28457 @subsection Group Info
28458
28459 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
28460 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
28461 describes the group.
28462
28463 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
28464 second is a more complex one:
28465
28466 @example
28467 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
28468
28469 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
28470 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
28471 (nnml "")
28472 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
28473 @end example
28474
28475 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
28476 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
28477 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
28478 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
28479 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
28480 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
28481 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
28482 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
28483 this section is about.
28484
28485 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
28486 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
28487 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
28488
28489 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
28490
28491 @example
28492 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
28493 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
28494 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28495 group = quote <string> quote
28496 ralevel = rank / level
28497 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28498 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
28499 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
28500 read = range
28501 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
28502 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
28503 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
28504 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
28505 @end example
28506
28507 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
28508 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
28509 in pseudo-BNF.
28510
28511 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
28512 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
28513
28514 @table @code
28515 @item gnus-info-group
28516 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
28517 @findex gnus-info-group
28518 @findex gnus-info-set-group
28519 Get/set the group name.
28520
28521 @item gnus-info-rank
28522 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
28523 @findex gnus-info-rank
28524 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
28525 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
28526
28527 @item gnus-info-level
28528 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
28529 @findex gnus-info-level
28530 @findex gnus-info-set-level
28531 Get/set the group level.
28532
28533 @item gnus-info-score
28534 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
28535 @findex gnus-info-score
28536 @findex gnus-info-set-score
28537 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
28538
28539 @item gnus-info-read
28540 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
28541 @findex gnus-info-read
28542 @findex gnus-info-set-read
28543 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
28544
28545 @item gnus-info-marks
28546 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
28547 @findex gnus-info-marks
28548 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
28549 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
28550
28551 @item gnus-info-method
28552 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
28553 @findex gnus-info-method
28554 @findex gnus-info-set-method
28555 Get/set the group select method.
28556
28557 @item gnus-info-params
28558 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
28559 @findex gnus-info-params
28560 @findex gnus-info-set-params
28561 Get/set the group parameters.
28562 @end table
28563
28564 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
28565 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
28566
28567 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
28568 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
28569 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
28570 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
28571
28572
28573 @node Extended Interactive
28574 @subsection Extended Interactive
28575 @cindex interactive
28576 @findex gnus-interactive
28577
28578 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
28579 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
28580 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
28581
28582 @lisp
28583 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
28584 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
28585 ...
28586 )
28587 @end lisp
28588
28589 The best thing to do would have been to implement
28590 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
28591 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
28592 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
28593 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
28594 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
28595 @code{interactive}.
28596
28597 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
28598 adds a few more.
28599
28600 @table @samp
28601 @item y
28602 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
28603 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
28604 variable.
28605
28606 @item Y
28607 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
28608 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
28609 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
28610
28611 @item A
28612 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
28613 function.
28614
28615 @item H
28616 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
28617 function.
28618
28619 @item g
28620 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
28621 function.
28622
28623 @end table
28624
28625
28626 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
28627 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
28628 @cindex XEmacs
28629 @cindex Emacsen
28630
28631 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
28632 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
28633 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
28634
28635 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
28636 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
28637 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
28638 Gnus, that's very useful.
28639
28640 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
28641 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
28642 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
28643 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
28644 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
28645 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
28646 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
28647 following function:
28648
28649 @lisp
28650 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
28651 (start-itimer
28652 "gnus-run-at-time"
28653 `(lambda ()
28654 (,function ,@@args))
28655 time repeat))
28656 @end lisp
28657
28658 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
28659 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
28660 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
28661 all over.
28662
28663 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
28664 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
28665 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
28666
28667 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
28668 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
28669 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
28670
28671
28672 @node Various File Formats
28673 @subsection Various File Formats
28674
28675 @menu
28676 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
28677 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
28678 @end menu
28679
28680
28681 @node Active File Format
28682 @subsubsection Active File Format
28683
28684 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
28685 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
28686 in each group.
28687
28688 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
28689
28690 @example
28691 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
28692 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
28693 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
28694 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
28695 no.general 1000 900 y
28696 @end example
28697
28698 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
28699
28700 @example
28701 active = *group-line
28702 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
28703 group = <non-white-space string>
28704 spc = " "
28705 high-number = <non-negative integer>
28706 low-number = <positive integer>
28707 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
28708 @end example
28709
28710 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
28711 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
28712
28713
28714 @node Newsgroups File Format
28715 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
28716
28717 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
28718 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
28719 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
28720 the user.
28721
28722 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
28723 Here's the definition:
28724
28725 @example
28726 newsgroups = *line
28727 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
28728 group = <non-white-space string>
28729 tab = <TAB>
28730 description = <string>
28731 @end example
28732
28733
28734 @page
28735 @node Emacs for Heathens
28736 @section Emacs for Heathens
28737
28738 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
28739 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
28740 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
28741 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
28742 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
28743 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
28744 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
28745 cat instead.
28746
28747 @menu
28748 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
28749 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
28750 @end menu
28751
28752
28753 @node Keystrokes
28754 @subsection Keystrokes
28755
28756 @itemize @bullet
28757 @item
28758 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
28759
28760 @item
28761 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
28762 @end itemize
28763
28764 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
28765 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
28766 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
28767 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
28768 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
28769 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
28770
28771 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
28772 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
28773 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
28774 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
28775 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
28776 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
28777 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
28778
28779 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
28780 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
28781 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
28782 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
28783 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
28784 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
28785 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
28786
28787 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
28788 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
28789 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
28790 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
28791 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
28792 it.
28793
28794
28795
28796 @node Emacs Lisp
28797 @subsection Emacs Lisp
28798
28799 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
28800 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
28801 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
28802 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
28803
28804 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
28805 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
28806 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
28807 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
28808 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
28809 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
28810 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
28811 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
28812 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
28813 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
28814
28815 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
28816 write the following:
28817
28818 @lisp
28819 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
28820 @end lisp
28821
28822 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
28823 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
28824 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
28825 change how Gnus works.
28826
28827 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
28828 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
28829 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
28830 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
28831 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
28832
28833 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
28834 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
28835 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
28836
28837 Some pitfalls:
28838
28839 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
28840 that means:
28841
28842 @lisp
28843 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
28844 @end lisp
28845
28846 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
28847 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
28848
28849 @lisp
28850 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
28851 @end lisp
28852
28853 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
28854 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
28855
28856 @page
28857 @include gnus-faq.texi
28858
28859 @node Index
28860 @chapter Index
28861 @printindex cp
28862
28863 @node Key Index
28864 @chapter Key Index
28865 @printindex ky
28866
28867 @summarycontents
28868 @contents
28869 @bye
28870
28871 @iftex
28872 @iflatex
28873 \end{document}
28874 @end iflatex
28875 @end iftex
28876
28877 @c Local Variables:
28878 @c mode: texinfo
28879 @c coding: iso-8859-1
28880 @c End:
28881
28882 @ignore
28883 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
28884 @end ignore